Toshiba Vfp7-4370p
Toshiba Vfp7-4370p
Toshiba Vfp7-4370p
APPLICATIONS
Instruction Manual
The new generation
high-performance inverter
TOSVERT VF-P7
NOTICE
1. Make sure that this instruction manual is delivered to the end user of
the inverter unit.
2. Read this manual before installing or operating the inverter unit, and
store it in a safe place for reference.
Toshiba Schneider Inverter Corporation 2001
All Rights Reserved.
200V class 18.5 110kW
400V class 18.5 315kW
II
I
1
3
2
5
4
7
6
9
8
11
10
13
12
14
15
Preface
Safety
precautions
Contents
Operating
the inverter
Connection
Basic
parameters
Basic
Operation
Operation
with external
signal
Peripheral
units
Monitoring
operation
status
Specification
Table of
parameters
Regular
inspection and
maintenance
Prior to
service call
Warranty
Precautions
of disposal
Extended
parameters
Read this
section first
TM
1
Safety precautions
The labels on the inverter and this instruction manual contain important instructions for the
prevention of possible injury to the user and other persons and damage to property, as
well as for the safe use of the inverter. Please gain a good understanding of the following
pictorial symbols before reading this manual and strictly observe the instructions that
follow each symbols.
Marking
Symbols Meaning
Danger
Means that improper use or handling could cause the risk of death or serious
injury
Warning
Means that improper use or handling could cause injury to persons(*1) or
damage to property(*2).
(*1)injury to persons refer to injuries, burns, electric shocks, and so on, that do not oblige the injured person to
be hospitalized or go to a hospital for a long period of time for medical treatment.
(*2)damage to property includes all kinds of losses resulting from it.
Symbols Meaning
Represents prohibition(what you must not do)
What you must not do is described in or near this symbol by a picture or words
Represents mandatory items(what you must do)
What you must do is described in or near this symbol by a picture or word
Represents danger
What is dangerous is described in or near this symbol by a picture or word
Represents warning
What the warning should be applied is described in or near this symbol by a picture or word
Limited applications
This inverter is designed to control the speed of three-phase induction motors for general industry.
When using our inverters for equipment such as nuclear power control
equipment, aviation and space flight control equipment, traffic equipment, and
safety equipment, and there is a risk that any failure or malfunction of the
inverter could directly endanger human life or cause injury, please contact our
headquarters, branch, or office printed on the front and back covers of this
catalogue. Such applications must be studied carefully.
When using inverters for critical equipment, even though the inverters
are manufactured under strict quality control always fit your equipment
with safety devices to prevent serious accident or loss should the
inverter fail(such as failure to issue an inverter trouble signal)
Do not use our inverters for any load other than three phase induction
motors.
Precautions
2
Handling in general
Danger
Reference
Never
Disassemble
Never disassemble, modify or repair the inverter. Its disassembly could
cause an electric shock, afire or an injury. Request your TOSHIBA dealer
for repair.
2.
Prohibited
-Never open the front cover of the inverter(or the door of the cabinet in
which the inverter is installed) when the inverter is energized, or you
could get a shock since a high voltage is applied to certain portions of it.
-Do not put your fingers into the panel through a wiring opening or an
opening in the cooling fan cover, or you could get a shock or an injury.
-Do not put or insert anything(e.g., electric cable, bar or steel wire) into the
inverter, or the inverter could cause a shock or fire.
-Do not splash water over the inverter, or the inverter could cause a shock
or a fire.
2.
2.
2.
2.
Mandatory
-Do not turn on the power before attaching the front cover (or closing the
door of the cabinet in which the inverter is installed), or you could get a
shock.
-Turn off the power immediately in case the inverter smokes, smells of
smoke, or produce abnormal noise. Failure to do so could lead to a fire.
In such a case, request your TOSHIBA dealer for repair.
-Due to the possibility of contaminants entering the drive, disconnect the
input power if the drive will be unused for extended periods.
The leakage current caused by the contamination may result in fire.
2.
3.
3.
3.
Warning
Reference
Never touch
Do not touch any heat sink or braking resistor, or you could get a burn
since they become very hot.
3.
Prohibited
-Do not install the inverter where any of the unallowable chemicals
solvents listed below can be sprayed, or its plastic front cover could
come off or a plastic unit could fall off although damage sustained by
plastic parts depends on their shapes. If you intend to install the inverter
where a chemical or solvent other than those listed below is used, consult
your TOSHIBA dealer in advance.
Note) The above instances are for tolerance of changing shape of plastic cover,
not of ignition or explosiveness.
1.4.4
(Table1)
Allowable chemicals and solvents
Chemical Solvent
Hydrochloric acid
(concentration of less
than 10%)
Methanol
Sulfuric acid
(concentration of less
than 10%)
Ethanol
Nitric acid
(concentration of less
than 10%)
Triol
Caustic soda Mesopropanol
Ammonia Glycerin
Sodium chloride
(Table 2)
Unallowable chemicals and solvents
Chemical Solvent
Phenol Gasoline,
Kerosene,
light oil
Turpentine oil
Benzol
Benzene
sulfonic acid
Thinner
4
TransportationInstallation
Danger
Reference
Prohibited
-Do not install or operate the inverter if it is damaged or any part is missing
from it. Operating the inverter in a defective condition could lead to a
shock or a fire. Request your Toshiba dealer for repair.
-Do not put any inflammable material near the inverter, or it could catch a
fire if the inverter sparks because of a breakdown, etc.
-Do not install the inverter where it can be splashed with water, etc., or it
could cause a shock or a fire.
2.
1.4.4
2.
Mandatory
-Use the inverter under environmental conditions specified by this
instruction manual, or it could break down.
-Install the inverter on a non-combustible board, for example, a steel plate.
Installing it on a inflammable board or wall could lead to a fire because its
back is heated up during operation.
-Do not use the inverter with the front cover detached, or it could cause a
shock.
-Install an emergency shutdown device which matches the system (for
example, a switch interlocked with the brake of the machine). Failure to
do so could lead to injury to persons since it has no emergency stop
function.
-Do not use any optional devices other than those designated by our
company.
The use of improper devices could lead to accidents.
1.4.4
1.4.4
1.4.4
1.4.4
1.4.4
Warning
Reference
Prohibited
-Do not hold the front cover to carry the inverter, or the cover could come
off and cause the main unit to fall, thus causing you to get an injury.
-Do not install the inverter in any place subject to vibration, or it could fall,
causing injury to persons.
2.
1.4.4
Mandatory
-For a model (20 kg or more in weight) designed for 30kW motors or larger,
carry it at least in a twosome, or it could fall and cause you to get an
injury.
-Handle large capacity model using a crane. Lifting heavy inverter causes
injury to persons. Taking care of safety for users, carefully handle in order
not to damage to the inverter.
Carefully lift up the inverter, hanging wires on the hanging bolts or halls
on the top or bottom of the inverter.
-Four points and perpendicular lifting is recommended. Even if
perpendicular lifting is impossible, respect the condition described in the
following figure. A crack may be attached to the product body when not
performing perpendicular lifting. Please be careful.
-Install the main unit on a wall, or the like, which is strong enough to
withstand its weight, or it could fall and cause injury to persons.
-Install a mechanical brake whenever the motor requires a brake (device
which retains the motor shaft). Failure to do so could lead to injury to
persons because the inverter itself has no function of mechanically
retaining the brake shaft.
2.
1.4.4
1.4.4
60 Max.
60 Max.
5
Wiring
Danger
Reference
Prohibited
-Do not connect the power cable to any output terminal (U/T1, V/T2 or W/T3
on the motor side), or the inverter could break down and cause a fire.
-Do not connect a resistor to any D.C. terminal (between PA and PC or PO
and PC), or the inverter could cause a fire.
To install external braking resistor, refer to 6.13.4.
-Dont touch the connector terminals and cables of the devices(MCCB) on
he input side of the inverter within 10 minutes after shutting down the
power source
2.2
2.2
6.13.4
2.2
Mandatory
-Entrust all electrical work to an experienced specialist. Wiring by an
inexperienced person could result in a fire or an electric shock.
-Connect the output terminals (on the motor side) correctly. Incorrect
connection of the terminals causes the motor to rotate in a wrong
direction, and thus could result in injury to persons.
-Perform wiring always after installing the inverter, or you could get a
shock or an injury.
-Be sure to perform the following preparatory work before proceeding to
wiring.
(1) Turn off the power.
(2) 10 minutes or more after turning off the power, make sure that charge
lamp is extinct.
(3) Using a circuit tester with a D.C. voltage measuring capacity of more
than 800V, check to be sure that the voltage remaining in the D.C.
main circuit (between PA and PC) is below 45V.
Failure to do so could lead to an electric shock.
-Tighten the terminal board fixing screws at the specified torque. Failure to
do so could lead to a fire.
-Make sure that the supply voltage is within +10%/-15% (during continuous
operation or within 10% under full load) of the inverter's rated voltage
specified on its rating label. Supplying a voltage exceeding the above
range could lead to a breakdown, an electric shock or a fire.
2.
2.
2.
2.
2.
1.4.4
Be Grounded
-Connect grounding wires correctly and securely. Otherwise, a breakdown
or electric leakage could lead to an electric shock or a fire.
2.
2.2
9.
Warning
Charged capacitors can present a shock hazard
even after source power is removed
Drives with EMI filters will retain a charge on the input terminals for up to 10 min. after the power has
been removed. To avoid electrical shock, dont touch the connector terminals and uninsulated
source cables at either the main circuit disconnect or the drive until the capacitive charge has
dissipated.
6
About operation
Danger
Reference
Prohibited
-Do not touch any inverter's terminal when it is energized even if the motor
is standstill, or you could get a shock.
-Do not operate switches with a wet hand or not put a wet cloth on the
inverter, or you could get a shock.
-Do not get near the alarm-stopped motor when the system is in retry
mode, or you could get an injury.
Take safety measures, for example, attaching a cover to the motor, to
protect persons against accidents when the motor unexpectedly restarts.
-Don't set the motor constant 3 (exciting inductance:) as 1/2 or less
value of default setting value. If the motor constant 3 (exciting
inductance :) is set as extremely small value, the stole prevention
function
will incorrect-operate and will raise output frequency.
-Don't set the stole prevention level() as extremely small value.
When the stole prevention level() is set as motor no-load current
or value lower than it, the stole prevention function always operates. And
if it is judged as regeneration mode, frequency will be raised.
Please do not set the stole prevention level() to 30% or less in
the usual usage.
3.
3.
3.
6.21
6.25.2
Mandatory
-Do not turn on the power before attaching the front cover. When the
inverter is installed in a cabinet with the inverter's front panel detached,
always close the door of the cabinet before turning on the power.
Turning on the power with the cover or the door left opened could lead to
an electric shock.
-Turn off the operation signal before resetting the inverter after trouble, or
the motor unexpectedly restarts, causing injury to persons.
3.
9.
3.
Warning
Reference
Mandatory
-Operate the motor always within the allowable operation range. (Refer to
the motors instruction manual for the allowable operation range.)
Failure to do so could cause injury to persons.
3.
When selecting the sequence that automatically restarts the motor after
recovery from a momentary power failure (Applicable to inverters)
Warning
Reference
Mandatory
-Do not get near the motor or the machine.
The motor and the machine unexpectedly restart after recovery from a
momentary power failure.
-Stick caution labels to the inverter, the motor and the machine, to prevent
accidents due to an unexpected restart of them after recovery from a
momentary power failure.
6.13.1
7
When selecting the retry mode (Applicable to inverters)
Warning
Reference
Mandatory
-Do not get near the motor.
When the retry mode is selected, the motor and machine that stopped
after an alarm restart unexpectedly after the selected time has passed,
thus causing injury to persons.
-Stick caution labels to the inverter, the motor and the machine, to prevent
accidents due to an unexpected restart of them in retry mode.
6.13.3
About inspection and maintenance
Danger
Reference
Prohibited
-Do not replace any part yourself, or you could get a shock or an injury, or
cause a fire. Request your Toshiba dealer for replacement of parts.
13.2
Mandatory
-Carry out inspection and maintenance on a daily basis. Failure to do so to
find defects in the inverter could lead to accidents.
-Be sure to perform the following preparatory work before proceeding to
inspection.
(1) Turn off the power.
(2) 10 minutes or more after turning off the power, make sure that charge
lamp is extinct.
(3) Using a circuit tester with a D.C. voltage measuring capacity of more
than 800V, check to be sure that the voltage remaining in the D.C.
main circuit (between PA and PC) is below 45V.
Failure to do so could lead to an electric shock.
13.
13.
13.2
About disposal of inverters
Reference
Mandatory
-When you throw away the inverter, have it done by a specialist in
industrial waste disposal*.
If the collection, transport and disposal of industrial waste is dune by
someone who is not licensed, it is punishable as a violation of the law.
(Laws in regard to disposal and cleaning of waste.)
(*)People who specialize in the processing of waste and are known
as "industrial waste collectors and transporters" or "industrial
waste disposal specialists".
15.
Sticking warning labels
Here are examples of caution labels designed to prevent accidents caused by an inverter, a motor or
a machine. When selecting the automatic restart function or the retry function, stick the applicable
label to a conspicuous position.
Warning
Please stick this label to a conspicuous
position when selecting the sequence that
automatically restarts the machine after
recovery from a mini power failure.(An example
of the restart caution label)
Do not get near the motor or the machine. The
motor and the machine which stopped.
Because of a mini power failure, unexpectedly
restart after the preset time has passed.
Warning (automatic restart function enabled)
Please stick this label to a conspicuous
position when selecting the retry function.
(An example of the retry caution label)
Do not get near the motor or the machine. The
motor and the machine which stopped after
an alarm, unexpectedly restart after thepreset
time has passed.
Warning (Retry function enabled)
8
Preface
Thank you for purchasing the fan and pump uses inverter "TOSVERT VF-P7".
Features
1. " VF-P7" complies with global standard
1)" VF-P7" complies with the European CE marking requirements.
2)" VF-P7" complies with the UL/cUL standard.
2. Excellent torque control performance
1) High torque even at a frequency of 0.5 Hz(with vector control)
The speed control ratio is 1 :150.
2) Torque limit function
3. A wide range of applications from simple speed control to system control
1) Auto-tuning function
All you have to do make the " VF-P7" ready for start is to connect it to the motor and the power
supply unit; the " VF-P7" does not require cumbersome parameter setting to start it.
2) High flexibility and system expendability
" VF-P7" has a number of functions, including torque control, sensor (or sensorless) vector
control, drooping function, commercial power/inverter switching function and various
communication functions, which allow the inverter to be used as part of a system.
3) Torque control
In addition to speed control by the frequency command, " VF-P7" is capable of speed control by
the torque command, which is best suited to winding control.
4. Options that widen the range of application
Extended terminal board
Communication devices
(RS485, RS232C, TOSLINE-F10M/S20, DEVICE NET(*1), PROFI BUS(*1))
Add-on cassettes compatible with sensor vector control
(Speed feedback, torque control and positioning control, etc... )
Sensor vector control-compatible board
(Speed feedback, torque control)
Extension panelParameter writer
Other optional devices common to all models
Control power supply unit
Heat-sink attachment
(*1): Planned
This inverter has a "Ver. 312"CPU.
Please refer to "10. Table of parameters" for the functions available for the inverter
with a CPU in this version.
The CPU version will be frequently upgraded.
8
Contents sheet
Safety precautions 1
Preface
Contents sheet
7
8
Read this section first A-1
.Checking the purchase A-1
.Contents of the product code A-1
.Names and functions A-2
..Panel description A-2
..Main circuit, control power supply and control circuit terminal boards A-4
..Detaching the terminal board front cover A-7
.Notes on the application of inverters A-8
..Notes on motors combined with inverters A-8
..Notes on inverters A-10
..Influences of leakage currents and measures against it A-11
..Notes on installation A-13
Basic explanation
Connection B-1
.Cautions as to wiring B-1
.Standard connection B-3
.Explanation of terminals B-6
..Main circuit terminals B-6
..Control circuit terminals (sink logic(minus common))
..Serial RS485 communication connector
B-8
B-11
Operating the inverter C-1
.Control modes of the VF-P7 inverter C-2
.Simple operation of the VF-P7 [1] [Speed control mode] C-3
..Operation from the terminal (external signals) C-3
..Operation from the control panelControl panel operation C-6
.Operation of the VF-P7 [2] C-8
..The outline of PID control C-8
..Settings of PID control C-9
..Adjustment of PID control C-11
Basic operation of the VF-P7 D-1
.Setting parameters D-1
..How to set basic parameters D-2
..How to set extended parameters D-4
..Searching for changed parameters and changing their settings again D-5
..Parameters that cannot be changed during operation D-7
..Resetting all parameters to the factory default settings at a time D-7
9
Explanation of the basic parameters E-1
.Setting the acceleration and deceleration times E-1
..Automatic acceleration/deceleration E-1
..Manually setting the acceleration and deceleration times E-2
.Increasing starting torque/ energy-saving operation mode E-3
.Selecting an operation mode E-6
.Setting and calibrating meters E-10
.Factory default setting E-13
.Forward/reverse run selection (for the panel control only) E-15
.Maximum frequency E-15
.Upper and lower limit frequencies E-16
.Base frequency E-16
.Control mode selection E-17
.Switching between speed control and torque control E-22
.Manual torque boost - Increasing the torque produced at low speeds E-24
.Setting the electronic thermal protective function E-24
.Preset-speed operation (15 speeds) E-28
Application explanation
.Extended parameters F-1
..Frequency signals F-1
...Low-speed signal F-1
...Putting out signals of arbitrary frequencies F-2
..Selection of input signals F-3
...Changing standby signal function F-3
...Priority selection (both F-CC, R-CC are ON) F-3
...Assigning priority to the terminal board in panel operation mode F-4
...Binary/BCD signal selection(Expansion TB option unit) F-6
..Selection of terminal functions F-7
...Keeping an input terminal function always active (ON) F-7
...Changing input terminal functions F-7
...Signal on completion of acceleration/deceleration (OUT 2) F-7
...Changing output terminal functions F-8
...Response times of input/output terminals F-8
..Basic parameters #2 F-9
...Switching among V/f characteristics #1, #2, #3 and #4 from input terminal F-9
..V/f 5-point setting F-10
Speed/torque command gain and bias F-11
...Using two types of frequency (speed) commands F-11
...Setting frequency command characteristics F-13
...Setting torque reference characteristics F-13
..Operation frequency F-14
...Start-up frequency and End frequency F-14
...Operating by means of reference signals F-14
...0Hz dead band frequency F-14
..DC injection braking F-15
...DC injection braking F-15
...Motor shaft fixing control F-16
...Zero-speed stop mode selection F-17
10
..Jog run F-18
..Jump frequency - Jumping resonant frequencies F-19
..Preset-speed #8 15 F-19
..PWM carrier frequency F-20
..Trip-less enhancement F-20
...Auto-restart (restart during free-run (coast)) F-20
...Regenerative power ride-through control / Deceleration stop F-23
...Retry function F-24
...Dynamic (regenerative) braking - To urgently stop the motor F-25
...Avoiding over-voltage trip F-28
...Adjusting the output voltage and voltage compensation F-28
...Prohibiting the reverse operation F-29
..Drooping control F-30
..Function for crane/hoist F-31
..Commercial power/inverter switching F-31
..PID control F-33
..Speed feedback/positioning control F-33
..Preset speed operation mode F-33
..Setting motor constants F-34
..Torque control F-39
...Torque reference F-39
...Torque reference filter F-40
...Speed limits in torque control mode F-41
...Torque bias and load sharing gain F-42
..Torque limit F-44
..Secondary acceleration/deceleration F-49
...Acceleration and deceleration patterns F-49
...Switching of acceleration/deceleration #1, 2, 3 and 4 F-50
...Minimum acceleration/deceleration times F-52
..Pattern run F-53
..Protection functions F-56
...Motor over road protection level adjust / motor types F-56
...Setting of current stall F-56
...Inverter trip holding F-56
...Emergency stop F-57
...Overload reduction start-up frequency F-57
...Motor's 150%-overload time limit F-57
...Action at low currents F-58
...Detection of output phase failure F-58
...Over-torque trip F-58
..10.Cooling fan control mode selection F-59
..11.Cumulative operation time alarm F-59
..12.Over-voltage stall protection level F-60
..13.Under-voltage trip F-60
..14.UV stall level F-60
..15.System-supporting sequence (B-timer) F-60
..Special analog input F-61
..Over-ride F-62
11
..Meter output F-64
...Setting of meter outputs F-64
...Setting of optional meter outputs F-64
...Pulse output to meters F-64
..Control panel parameters F-65
...Prohibiting the change of parameter settings F-65
...Changing the units of display F-65
...Display the motor speed and the load speed F-66
...Column number below decimal point of Frequency, Acc/dec time F-66
...Changing items displayed in status monitor mode F-67
...Switching basic parameters F-67
...Selecting a control panel stop pattern F-68
...Resetting the inverter from the control panel F-68
...Selecting a torque limit in control panel operation mode F-68
..10.Canceling PID control in panel operation mode F-69
..11.Setting a torque command in panel operation mode F-69
..12.Drooping control in panel operation mode F-69
..13.Override in panel operation mode F-69
..14.Restricting or prohibiting key operation F-70
..Communication function (RS485/common serial) F-71
...Common serial optional F-71
...Using the RS485 port fitted as standard F-73
For designing a system
OPERATION WITH EXTERNAL SIGNAL G-1
.External Operation G-1
.Applied operation with input and output signals (operation by the terminal board) G-2
..Functions of input terminals (in case of sink logic) G-2
..Functions of output terminals (in case of sink logic) G-5
..Setup of input/output terminal operation time G-9
.Setup of external speed command (analog signal) G-10
..Setup by analog input signals (RR terminal) G-11
..Setup by analog input signals (VI/II terminal) G-12
..Setup by analog input signals (RX terminal) G-13
Monitoring operation status H-1
.Status monitor mode H-1
.Changing status monitor function H-4
.Indication in trip status H-6
.Indication of alarm, pre-alarm, etc... H-8
Selection of peripheral devices I-1
.Selection of wiring equipment I-1
.Installation of electromagnetic contactor I-3
.Installation of overload relay I-4
.Application and functions of options I-5
.Optional add-on cassettes I-10
.Board options I-12
.Before installing optional add-on cassette or board option I-13
..Case 1 I-13
..Case 2 I-14
..Case 3 I-14
12
Table of parameters J-1
Specifications by types K-1
.Standard specifications by types K-1
.External dimensions and mass K-5
Prior to service call Trip information and counter measures L-1
.Cause of trip, warning indication (in detail and countermeasures) L-1
.Method of resetting causes of trip L-5
.In the case motor does not run in spite of no trip message appearing ... L-6
.How to check other troubles L-7
Regular inspection and maintenance M-1
.Regular inspection M-1
.Periodical inspection M-2
.When making a service call M-4
.When retaining the inverter out of operation M-4
Warranty N-1
When disposing the inverter O-1
A-1
1.1 Checking the purchase
Make sure that the inverter delivered is exactly what you ordered.
Applicable motor label Inverter main unit
Package Name plate
1.2Contents of the product code
Special
Type Form specification code
-
Model name Input voltage Applicable motor capacity Operating panel
Additional
functions
Special
specification code
P :Provided
TOSVERT
VF-P7 series
2:200V 230V
4:380V 460V
A :Special
spec. code
( is a
number)
18. 5kW: 185
22kW: 220
30kW: 300
37kW: 370
45kW: 450
55kW: 550
75kW: 750
90kW: 900
110kW: 110K
132kW: 132K
160kW: 160K
200kW: 200K
220kW: 220K
280kW: 280K
315kW: 315K
F :External
heat sink
N :with dynamic
braking circuit
NF :External
heat sink
with dynamic
braking circuit
Y :Others
(non-standard)
Z :Explosion proof
Note) Turn off the power in advance when checking the rating of the inverter installed in a cabinet.
Read this section first
Type indication
Warning label
Power supply Motor capacity
Pet name
200V-18.5kW
Use an inverter which matches the input power rating of your three-phase induction motor.
The use of an inverter unsuitable for your motor can cause it to rotate in a wrong
direction, and thus lead to grave accidents, including its burning due to overheating.
Warning
Mandatory
A-3
(*1) Using scissors or a cutter, cut the rubber bush in the wiring hole as shown below.(Models for 22kW
motor or smaller)
Rubber bush
Cut
Cooling fin
Ventilation slits
Wiring hole (*1)
Rating label
Connectors for optional
add-on module/board
[Side view] [Bottom view]
Warning label on the top
A-4
1.3.2 Main circuit, control power supply and control circuit terminal boards
Main circuit terminal board
Grounding terminal
VFP7-2300P,
VFP7-4300P, 4370P
VFP7-2185P, 2220P
VFP7-4185P, 4220P
VFP7-4450P, 4550P
A-5
VFP7-2750P
VFP7-4110KP 4160KP
VFP7-2900P, 2110KP
VFP7-4200KP 4315KP
VFP7-2370P 2550P
VFP7-4750P, 4900P
A-6
Control power supply terminal board
Note)To use R0,S0 terminal on 22kW model or smaller, you need a Control power supply
unit option.(Refer to 9.4)
(*1)Refer to 2.2 for the connection of control power
cables by voltage(R46,R41 and S0 terminals).
VFP7-2185P 2220P
VFP7-4185P 4220P
VFP7-2300P
VFP7-4300P, 4370P
VFP7-2370P 2110KP VFP7-4450P 4315KP
Control power
supply inputs Control power Power supply
supply inputs(*1) for control circuit
A-7
Control circuit terminal
The control circuit terminal board is common to all models.
Refer to section 2.3.2 for the functions of terminals.
1.3.3Detaching the terminal board front cover
Detach the front lower cover for wiring, following the steps below.
Less than 22kW
* For a 30kW model or larger, detach the whole front cover for wiring.
Remove the two screws
at the lower part of the
front cover.
To detach the cover, draw
the terminal board cover
toward you while
swinging it up a little.
Hooked
F ST C C C C R R R FM O U T 1 P2 4 P P
R ES S2 S3 S4
R X S 1 FP O U T 2 A M
FLA FLB FLC
ST-CC shorting bar
Screw sizeM3
A-8
1.4 Notes on the application of inverters
1.4.1Notes on motors combined with inverters
Keep in mind the following notes when using the VF-P7 in combination with a motor.
Comparison with commercial power operation
The VF-P7 inverter uses a sinusoidal PWM control system. However, the waveforms of
electric currents passing through the main and control circuits are not perfectly sinusoidal but
slightly distorted though they are very close to perfect sine waves. For this reason, a motor
produces more heat, larger noise and larger vibration when operated by means of the inverter
than when operated directly by commercial power.
Operation in low speed ranges
Operating a general-purpose motor by means of the inverter causes a decrease in the cooling
efficiency of the motor. So, reduce the motor's output below the rated load when operating it
in a low speed range.
If you wish to operate a motor continuously at the rated torque, then use a Toshiba VF motor
designed specially for use in conjunction with an inverter. When the inverter is combined with
a VF motor, its overload protection level needs to be changed to "VF motor" ( setting).
Adjustment of overload protection level
The VF-P7 inverter has an overload detection circuit (electronic thermal detection) to protect
the motor from overload. The reference current for the electronic thermal detection is set to
the rated current of the inverter at the factory, and it needs to be adjusted to the rated current
of the general-purpose motor combined with it.
High-speed operation at a frequency of 60 Hz or over
When a motor is operated at a frequency of 60 Hz or over, it produces larger noise and larger
vibration, which can exceed a limit that the motor or its bearings can withstand. Contact the
motor maker if you wish to operate the motor at such a high frequency.
Load of an oil lubrication type
When a speed reducer or a gear motor of an oil lubrication type is operated by the inverter, its
oil lubrication efficiency decreases in low speed ranges. Inquire of the speed reducer maker
about the allowable speed reduction range.
Extremely light load or load producing a very small moment of inertia
When a motor is operated under an extremely light load (e.g., at a load factor of less than
50%) or it drives a load which produces a very small moment of inertia, it sometimes becomes
unstable, for example, it produces abnormal vibration or trips because of an over-current. In
such a case, lower the carrier frequency to cope with this problem.
Unstable operation
When the inverter is used in combination with one of the following motors or loads, it
sometimes makes the operation of the motor or load unstable.
A motor with a rated capacity that exceeds the motor capacity recommended for the inverter
A special type of motor, for example, an explosion-proof motor
When using the inverter for such motors, lower the inverter's carrier frequency to stabilize
the operation. (In vector control mode, do not lower it below 2.2 kHz.)
A motor with a large backlash, which is coupled with a load
In this case, use the S-pattern acceleration/deceleration function, or in vector control
mode, adjust the response time (setting of moment of inertia) or switch to V/f control
mode to stabilize the operation.
Use an inverter which matches the input power rating of your three-phase induction motor.
The use of an inverter unsuitable for your motor can cause it to rotate in a wrong direction,
and thus lead to serious accidents, including its burning due to overheating.
Warning
Mandatory
A-9
A load, e.g., a reciprocating load, which requires a frequent change in the rotating speed
In this case, if the inverter is in vector control mode, adjust the response time (setting of
moment of inertia) or switch to V/f control mode to stabilize the operation.
Braking of a motor after power shutoff
If the power is shut off while the motor is still rotating, the motor keeps rotating (or coasting) for
a while before it comes to a complete stop. If you wish to stop it soon after turning off the
power, equip the motor with an auxiliary braking system. There are several types of braking
systems available, for example, mechanical and electrical types. Select a braking system
which matches your system.
Load producing negative torque
When the inverter is combined with a load producing negative torque, the over-voltage or
over-current protective function of the inverter sometimes works and causes the motor to trip.
In this case, it is necessary to install a dynamic braking resistor, etc., suitable for the load.
Motor with a braking system
When a brake-equipped motor is connected directly with the inverter, the brake cannot be
released at start-up because of an insufficient voltage. To avoid this, connect the brake cables
separately from the motor main cables.
(Non-exciting brake) (Non-exciting brake)
Circuit configuration 1 Circuit configuration 2
In circuit configuration 1, the brake is turned on and off by means of MC2 and MC3. If the
circuit is configured differently, the motor can trip because of a locked rotor current produced
during braking.
In circuit configuration 2, the brake is turned on and off by means of a low-speed signal
OUT1. However, for certain applications, it is recommended to use a low-speed detection
signal (function of terminal OUT1) to turn on and off the motor. Contact your Toshiba
dealer before designing a system.
MC1
MC3
MC1
MC3
Three-phase
power supply
MC2
B
IM
FLB FLC ST CC
MC2
MC3
MC1
Three-phase
power supply
LOW
MC3
MC2
B
IM
LOW
OUT1 P24
MC3
MC2
A-10
1.4.2 Notes on inverters
Over-current protective function
The inverter has an over-current protective function. The current for this protection is adjusted
to the maximum current rating of the applicable motors by default. Therefore, when the
inverter is used to control a motor with a relatively small capacity, it is necessary to readjust the
over-current protection level and the electronic thermal protective function. In such a case,
follow the procedure specified in 5.13 to readjust them.
Inverter capacity
An inverter with a small capacity (kVA) must not be used for a motor with a relatively large
capacity even if the motor is operated under a small load. If an inverter is used this way, the
output peak current rises high because of a current ripple, thus causing the motor to trip easily.
Power factor improving capacitor
No power factor improving capacitor should be connected on the output side of the inverter.
When the inverter is used for a motor equipped with a capacitor for power factor improvement,
remove the capacitor from the motor. Connecting such a capacitor causes the inverter to break
down and the motor to trip, or breaks the capacitor itself.
Use of an inverter at a voltage other than the rated one
There is a need to connect it to a power unit supplying a voltage different from the rated
voltage, increase or reduce the supply voltage to the inverter's rated voltage, using a
transformer, etc.
Use of a set of inverters, which requires circuit-breaking devices
Circuit-breaking of defective inverter
This series of inverters has no fuse in its main circuit. When two or more inverters are
connected to the same power line as shown above, it is necessary to select a circuit-breaking
characteristic ensuring that, for example, if a short circuit occurs in INV 1, only MCCB2 trips but
not MCCB1. If it is difficult to select a proper characteristic, then insert a breaking fuse between
MCCB2 and INV 1 in this case.
Note on the disposal of inverters
Be sure to dispose of inverters as industrial wastes, when they become unnecessary.
Remove the power factor improving
capacitor and the surge absorber, if any.
Power factor improving capacitor
U
V
W
Inverter
IM
M C C B 1
M C C B n
M C C B 3
M C C B 2
IN V 1
IN V 2
IN V n
Breaking fuse)
A-11
1.4.3 Influences of leakage currents and measures against it
(1) Influences of a current leaking into other systems via the ground
An electric current can leak not only into other circuits of an inverter but also into other
inverters through grounding wires. Such a leakage current can exerts influences on various
electronic devices, for example, malfunction of ground leakage breakers or relays, ground
relays, fire alarms, sensors, etc., noise on CRTs and display of incorrect current values on a
CRT screen.
Measures to be taken:
1. Lower the PWM carrier frequency.
Use parameter to lower the PWM carrier frequency.
2. Use high frequency-ready ground leakage breakers (e.g., Esper Mighty series(manufactured
by Toshiba Schneider Electric Ltd.)). When these ground leakage breakers are installed,
there is no need to lower the PWM carrier frequency.
3. If sensors and CRTs are affected, they can be restored by lowering the PWM carrier
frequency as described in 1 above. However, if lowering the PWM carrier frequency results
in an increase in magnetic noise, contact your Toshiba dealer.
(2) Influences of a current leaking from a cable into other cables
Thermal relay
If a current leaks from an output cable of an inverter to other cables because of its
insufficient capacitance, the high-frequency elements of the leakage current sometimes
increase the effective current value, and thus cause external relays to malfunction. For a
model with relatively long cables (longer than 50 m), the external thermal relays can
malfunction more easily because a leakage current can be too large as compared with the
current rating of the motor.
Warning
An electric current can leak through an input or output cable of the inverter because of its insufficient
capacitance and, sometimes, affects the peripheral systems. The amount of a leakage current depends
on the carrier frequency, the length of the input/output cable, etc. It is advisable to take the following
measures to prevent leakage currents.
IM Inverter
Power
supply
Inverter
IM
A-12
Measures to be taken:
1. Use the electronic thermal function provided for the inverter.
Use parameter , to set the electronic thermal function.
2. Lower the PWM carrier frequency, though this results in an increase in motor magnetic noise.
Use parameter to lower the PWM carrier frequency.
3. For improvement, connect film capacitors with capacitance of 0.1 to 0.5F-1000V to the
input and output terminals in each phase of the each thermal relay.
CT and ammeter
When a CT and an ammeter are installed externally to monitor the output current of the
inverter, the ammeter could be burned by the high-frequency elements of a leakage current.
For a model with relatively long cables (longer than 50 m), the ammeter can be burned more
easily by the high-frequency elements of a leakage current which flows into it through the
external CT because a leakage current can be too large as compared with the current rating of
the motor.
Measures to be taken:
1. For external meters, use the meter output terminals in the inverter's control circuit.
Output currents can also be output to the meter output terminals (AM). Use a 1 mAdc full-
scale ammeter or a 7.5 Vdc-1 mA full-scale voltmeter.
2. Use the monitor function provided for the inverter.
Use the monitor function provided for the inverter to check the output current.
Power
supply
Inverter
IM
A
IM
U/T1
V/T2
W/T3
A-13
1.4.4 Notes on installation
Installation environment
The VF-P7 inverter is an electronic control device. Therefore, due consideration should be given
to its installation environment.
Danger
Prohibited
-Do not put any inflammable material near the inverter, or it could catch a fire
if the inverter sparks because of trouble.
Mandatory
-Use the inverter under environmental conditions specified by this instruction
manual, or it could break down.
Warning
Prohibited
-Do not install the inverter in any place subject to vibration, or it could fall and cause
injury to persons.
Mandatory
Make sure that the supply voltage is within +10%/-15% (within 10% during
continuous operation under full load) of the inverter's rated voltage specified on its
rating label.
Supplying a voltage exceeding the above range could lead to a breakdown, an
electric shock or a fire.
Warning
Prohibited
(Table1)
Allowable chemicals and solvents
Chemical Solvent
Hydrochloric acid
(concentration of less
than 10%)
Methanol
Sulfuric acid
(concentration of less
than 10%)
Ethanol
Nitric acid
(concentration of less
than 10%)
Triol
Caustic soda
Mesopropano
l
Ammonia Glycerin
Sodium chloride
(Table 2)
Unallowable chemicals and solvents
Chemical Solvent
Phenol Gasoline,
Kerosene,
light oil
Benzene
sulfonic acid
Turpentine oil
Benzol
Thinner
-Do not install the inverter where any of the unallowable chemicals or solvents listed
below can be sprayed, or its plastic front cover could come off or a plastic unit
could fall off, though damage sustained by plastic parts depends on their shapes.
If you intend to install the inverter where a chemical or solvent other than those
listed below is used, consult your Toshiba dealer in advance.
A-14
Avoid installing the inverter in a hot, damp, or dusty
place, a place subject to freezing or water splash, or
a place full of metal chips.
Do not install the inverter in a place exposed to
corrosive gas or coolant for grinding.
Use the inverter at ambient temperatures of -10 to 50.
Note) The inverter produces heat. When installing it in a cabinet, consider its ventilating
condition and internal space. The VF-P7 can be used at ambient temperatures of up to
50.
Do not install the inverter in any place subject to vibration.
Note) If you intend to install it in a place subject to
vibration, you should take measures to protect it
from vibration. In such a case, contact your
Toshiba dealer in advance.
If installing the inverter close to any of the following appliances or devices, take necessary
measures to prevent them from malfunctioning.
Solenoid ... Connect a surge suppressor to the coil.
Brake ... Connect a surge suppressor to the coil.
Magnetic contactor ... Connect a surge suppressor to the
coil.
Fluorescent lamp ... Connect a surge suppressor to the coil.
Resistor ... Move it away from the inverter.
Resistor
Measuring position
Measuring position
50
A-15
Installation
Danger
Prohibited
- Do not install or operate the inverter if it is damaged or any part is missing from it.
Operating the inverter in a defective condition could lead to a shock or a fire.
Request your Toshiba dealer for repair.
Mandatory
- Install the inverter on a non-combustible board, such as a steel plate. Installing it
on an inflammable wall or board could lead to a fire because its back is heated up
during operation.
- Do not use the inverter with the front cover detached, or it could cause a shock.
- Install an emergency shutdown device which matches the system (for example, a
switch interlocked with the brake of the machine). Failure to do so could lead to
injury to persons since it has no emergency stop function.
- Do not use any optional devices other than those designated by Toshiba. The use
of improper devices could lead to accidents.
Warning
Prohibited
- Install the main unit on a wall, or the like, which is strong enough to withstand its
weight, or it could fall and cause injury to persons.
- Install a mechanical brake whenever the motor requires a brake (device which
retains the motor shaft). Failure to do so could lead to injury to persons because
the inverter itself has no function of mechanically retaining the brake shaft.
Installation place
Install the inverter vertically on a flat steel wall in a well-ventilated place. When installing two or
more inverters, leave a clearance of at least 10 cm between inverters placed side by side.
The clearances indicated above are minimum clearances to be secured. Every air-cooling type
model is equipped with a cooling fan. For this type of inverter, therefore, leave as large
clearances as possible above and under the inverter.
For a model designed for 37kW motors or larger, leave a clearance of at least 20 cm above and
under it for easy installation of wires and possible replacement of the fan.
Note) Do not install the inverter in a hot, damp, or dusty place, or a place full of metal chips.
When you intend to install in a critical environment, consult your Toshiba dealer in
advance.
above 5cm
above 5cm
above 10cm
above 10cm
A-16
Calorific values of inverters and amount of air to be ventilated
The VF-P7 series of inverter loses about 5% of energy when switching electric currents from AC,
DC, then to AC. To limit a temperature rise due to this energy loss, it is necessary to forcefully
ventilate and cool down the cabinet in which the inverter is installed.
The table below lists the amounts of air to be ventilated forcefully and the heat radiation areas
required for closed-type cabinets containing an inverter.
Voltage
class
Applicable
motor
(kW)
Calorific value
of inverter
(W)
Amount of air to be
ventilated forcefully
(m
3
/min.)
Heat radiation area required
for closed-type cabinet
(m
2
)
18.5 940 5.4 18.8
22 1110 6.3 22.2
30 1490 8.5 29.8
37 1530 8.7 30.6
45 1850 10.5 37.0
55 2250 12.8 45.0
75 3050 17.4 61.0
90 3650 20.8 73.0
200V
110 4450 25.4 89.0
18.5 800 4.6 16.0
22 940 5.4 18.8
30 1270 7.2 25.4
37 1570 8.9 31.4
45 1570 8.9 31.4
55 1810 10.3 36.2
75 2300 13.1 46.0
90 2750 15.7 55.0
110 3350 19.1 67.0
132 4010 22.9 80.2
160 4850 27.6 97.0
220 6050 34.5 121.0
220 6650 37.9 133.0
280 8450 48.2 169.0
400V
315 9500 54.2 190.0
Note)The calorific values in the above table do not include those of optional external devices
(such as input reactors, DC reactors and radio noise filters).
A-17
Control panel designed in consideration of possible influences of noise
Inverters produce high-frequency noise. To avoid influences of noise, measures must be taken
in designing a control panel. Here are some examples of measures against noise.
Separately install the wires of the main circuit and those of the control circuit. Do not install
their wires in the same duct or in parallel with each other, and do not bind them together.
Use shielded wires or twisted wires for the control circuit.
Separate the input wires (on power supply side) of the main circuit from the output wires (on
motor side). Do not install them in the same duct or in parallel with each other, and do not bind
them together.
Be sure to ground the grounding terminal (G/E) of the inverter.
Be sure to connect a surge suppressor to every electromagnetic contactor and every relay
installed near the inverter.
Install noise filters, as required.
Notes on the installation of two or more inverters in a single cabinet
When installing two or more inverters in a single cabinet, take the following precautions:
Leave a clearance of at least 10 cm between inverters placed side by side.
Leave a clearance of at least 20 cm between inverters placed one above another.
Install a deflector, etc., to prevent the upper inverter from being affected by heat produced and
being exhausted by the lower one.
Deflector
Inverter
Inverter
Cooling fun
Installation of Cooling fun
A-18
Heat-sink going out attachment(simple type)
To install a standard VF-P7 designed for 200V-37kW motor or larger or 400V-45kW motor or
larger, you can choose a one from next two forms.
(1) Normal attachment (Whole the inverter is in the cabinet)
(2) Heat-sink going out (the cabinet) attachment(simple type)
Heat-sink going out attachment reduces the generation of heat inside the cabinet.
When you carry out heat-sink going out attachment, please change the position of the
attachment ornaments (hanging hole) of the inverter according to the following figure.
(*1) Metallic ornaments with the hanging hole are attached only in the following models.
200V class: Applicable motor capacity is 75kW or larger
400V class: Applicable motor capacity is 110kW or larger
(1) Normal attachment (2) Heat-sink going out attachment
(simple type)
Take this ornament
off (*1)
Change the position
Change the position
Change the position
Change the
position
Take this ornament
off (*1)
B-1
Danger
Disassemble
Never disassemble, modify or repair the inverter. Its disassembly could cause an
electric shock, a fire or an injury. Request your Toshiba dealer for repair.
Prohibited
Do not put or insert anything (e.g., an electric cable, a bar or a steel wire) into the
inverter, or the inverter could cause a shock or a fire.
Do not splash water over the inverter, or the inverter could cause a shock or a fire.
Warning
Prohibited
Do not hold the front cover to carry the inverter, or the cover could come off and
cause the main unit to fall, thus causing you to get an injury.
Mandatory
For models designed for 30kW motor or larger, carry it at least in a twosome, or it
could fall and cause you to get an injury.
2.1 Cautions as to wiring
Danger
Prohibited
Never open the front cover of the inverter (or the door of the cabinet in which the
inverter is installed) when the inverter is energized, or you could get a shock since a
high voltage is applied to certain portions of it.
Mandatory
Do not turn on the power before attaching the front cover (or closing the door of the
cabinet if the inverter is installed in it). Turning on the power with the cover or the
door left opened could lead to an electric shock.
Entrust all electrical work to an experienced specialist. Wiring by an inexperienced
person could result in a fire or an electric shock.
Connect the output terminals (on the motor side) correctly. connection of the
terminals causes the motor to rotate in a wrong direction, and thus could result in
injury to persons.
Perform wiring always after installing the inverter, or you could get a shock or an
injury.
Be sure to perform the following preparatory work before proceeding to wiring.
(1) Turn off the power.
(2) Wait more than 10 minutes, and make sure that the charge lamp is extinct.
(3) Using a circuit tester with a D.C. voltage measuring capacity of more than 800 V,
check to be sure that the voltage remaining in the D.C. main circuit (between PA and
PC) is below 45 V to do so could lead to an electric shock.
Tighten the terminal board fixing screws at the specified torque. Failure to do so could
lead to a fire.
Be Grounded
Connect grounding wires correctly and securely. Failure to do so could cause an
electric shock or a fire if current leakage occurs or the inverter breaks down.
2. Connection
B-2
Warning
Prohibited
Do not connect any device or unit with a built-in capacitor (noise filter, surge
suppressor, etc.) to output terminals (on the motor side), or it could cause the risk of
a fire.
Prevention of radio noise
Prevent interference, such as radio noise, separately install and bind cables connected to the
power supply-side terminals (R/L1, S/L2 and T/L3) of the main circuit and those connected to the
motor-side terminals (U/T1, V/T2 and W/T3).
Power supply to the control and main circuits (for the 22kW and smaller models)
You want to keep the control circuit alive when the main circuit shuts off because of trouble or
tripping, you can use an optional power supply unit to supply power to the control circuit
separately from the main circuit.
Notes on wiring
When connecting wires to the main circuit terminals, use crimp contacts because there is no
large space between terminals, and attach them in order so that they do not come into contact
with each other.
Be sure to ground the inverter by connecting wires of the following size or larger to the
grounding terminal G/E.
Voltage
class
Applicable motor
Grounding wire size
AWG(cross-section[mm
2
])
18.5 22kW 4(22)
30 37kW 2(38)
45kW 2/0(60)
200V
55 110kW 4/0(100)
18.5kW 8(8)
22 30kW 6(14)
37 55kW 4(22)
75 132kW 2/0(60)
160 220kW 4/0(100)
400V
280 315kW 300(150)
MCCB
Voltmeter or ammeter
R0
S0
Note
Connector for
common serial
communication
RS485 connector
for serial
communication
SINK
SOURCE
Common
CN21
* When using a separate power source
for the control circuit
For the 22kW and smaller models,
power is supplied to the control circuit
from the main circuit. An optional device
is required to
supply from
another source.
(though
terminals only
are provided.)
CN21
Control circuit
DC reactor (DCL)
*2 (Optional)
*1: The control power supply terminals
RO and SO are optionally
available for the 22kW and
smaller models. Though terminals
RO and SO are fitted as
standard for the 22kW and
smaller models as well, they
are not connected internally.
*2: The inverter is shipped with
the terminals PO and PA
shorted with a bar. Remove
this shorting bar when installing
a DC reactor (DCL).
Option
Factory
default
settings
Dynamic braking resistor
(Optional)
B-4
[Standard connection diagram for sink logic(minus common)]
200V class: 30 55kW
400V class: 30 90kW
Main circuit power supply
200V class30 55kW
3-phase 200 220V-50Hz
200 230V-60Hz
400V class30 90kW
3-phese 380 440V-50Hz
380 460V-60Hz
Control
circuit
Motor
IM
FL
G/E
CC RX V I RR PP
F
RES
CC
R/L1
S/L2
T/L3
U/T1
V/T2
W/T3
Control panel
FLC
FLB
FLA
Voltage signal-10 +10V
Voltage signal0 10V
Forward
Preset
speed 1
S1
Preset
speed 4
ST
R
S2
S3
S4
OUT2
P24
OUT1
R y
R y
AM FM FP
Ammeter
Frequency
meter
Digital
voltmeter
PO PC PB PA
Main circuit
Reverse
Standby
Reset
Preset
speed 3
Preset
speed 2
Current signal
4 20mA
MCCB
R0
S0
Connector for
common serial
communication
RS485 connector
for serial
communication
S IN K
S O U R C E
Common
External potentiometer
(or voltage signal between RR and CC: 0 10V)
(R20)
(S20)
*1: Connect a power source for
the control circuit.
*2: The inverter is shipped with
the terminals PO and PA
shorted with a bar. Remove
this shorting bar when
installing a DC reactor (DCL).
*3: Power output for the control
circuit, which is provided
only for the 400V 45kW
and larger models.
Single-phase
207.5 220V-50Hz
207.5 230V-60Hz
(10VA)
Voltmeter or ammeter
Control
circuit
R46
S0
R20
S20
Single-phase 415 440V-50Hz
415 460V-60Hz
R41
Control
circuit
R46
S0
R20
S20
Single-phase 380 415V-50/60Hz
R41
*4: Connections of control power cables by voltage for the
400V 45kW and larger models.
DC reactor (DCL)
*2 (Optional)
Braking unit PB3
(Optional)
MCCB
Ammeter
Frequency
meter
Digital
voltmeter
R0
S0
Connector for
common serial
communication
RS485 connector
for serial
communication
S IN K
S O U R C E
Common
External potentiometer
(or voltage signal between RR and CC: 0 10V)
(R20)
(S20)
Voltmeter or ammeter
4 2 0 m A
DC reactor (DCL)
*2 (Optional)
Dynamic braking resistor
(Optional)
M C
R U N
Surge suppressor
O F F
O N
R U N
b-contact of
overload relay
R U N
PC
MC
Factory
default
settings
B-6
2.3 Explanation of terminals
2.3.1 Main circuit terminals
Figure below shows an example of the wiring of the main circuit. Use optional devices, as required.
Connecting a power source and a motor
Connecting peripheral devices
Main circuit
Terminal symbol Function
G/E Grounding terminal for the inverter's enclosure.
R/L1S/L2T/L3
200V class:
18.5 55kW: 3-phase 200 220V-50Hz,200 230V-60Hz
75 110kW: 3-phase 200 230V-50/60Hz
400V class:
18.5 22, 110 315kW: 3-phase 380 460V-50/60Hz
30 90kW: 3-phase 380 440V-50Hz,380 460V-60Hz
U/T1V/T2W/T3 Used to connect a motor (3-phase inductive motor)
R0S0
(R46, R41)
Used to connect a power source for the control circuit (Optional for the 22kW and
smaller models, though these terminals are provided for them)
200V class:
18.5 55kW: Single-phase 200 230V-50/60Hz
75 110kW: Single-phase 200 220V-50Hz,200 230V-60Hz
400V class:
18.5 22, 110 315kW: 3-phase 380 460V-50/60Hz
30 90kW: 3-phase 380 440V-50Hz,380 460V-60Hz
Between R46-S0: Single-phase 415 440V-50Hz, 415 460V-60Hz
Between R41-S0: Single-phase 380 415V-50Hz, 380 415V-60Hz
*Maximum allowable output of control power source:
200V class: 18.5 30kW50VA, 37 110kW60VA
400V class: 18.5 37kW50VA, 45 90kW150VA,
110 160kW200VA, 200 315kW350VA
PA, PB
Used to connect a dynamic braking resistor (For the optional dynamic braking unit,
connect it between PA and PC.)the settings of the parameters I_(H, I_(( and/or
I_(_, as required, when connecting an external resistor.
Motor
Zero-phase
reactor
Power
source
Inverter
DC reactor
Surge suppressing filter
Dynamic braking resistor(See Note.)
Simplified radio noise filter
Radio noise
reduction filter
(high-attenuation)
Input
reactor
Magnetic
contactor
Non-fuse
breaker
/L1
/L2
/L3
PA P0 PA PB
/T2
/T3
/T1
Note) Connect a dynamic
braking unit between
the terminals PA and
PC, if necessary.
IM
Power source
R/L1 S/L2 T/L3
Motor
No-fuse
breaker
Connect the power
source to the terminals
R, S and T.
Connect the motor
cables to the terminals
U, V and W.
VF-P7
E
U/T1 V/T2 W/T3 G/E
B-7
Terminal symbol Function
PC
A negative potential terminal of the internal dc main circuit. This terminal can be used to
connect a dc common power source in conjunction with the terminal PA (positive
potential).
PO, PA
Used to connect a DC reactor (DCL: external option). The inverter is shipped with these
terminals shorted. So, remove the shorting bar when connecting a DCL.
R20, S20
Used to connect the control output cables. Provided only for the 400V class 45kW and
larger models. (10VA)
400V 45 90kW: Single-phase 207.5 220V 50Hz, 207.5 230V-60Hz
110 315kW: Single-phase 207.5 230V-50/60Hz
Terminal symbol Inverter internal circuit
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3
G/E
R0, S0
(R46, R41, R20,
S20)
Fig.1: 200V class 18.5 22kW
400V class 18.5 22kW
Fig.2: 200V class 30 110kW
400V class 30,37kW
Fig.3: 400V class 45 315kW
P0, PA, PB, PC,
(*1) 18.5 and 22kW models contain rush-current prevention circuit in the
rectifier-circuit part.
(*2) The dynamic-braking circuit of 30kW model or larger are served as option
correspondence.
R/L1
S/L2
T/L3
R46
R41
S0
R20
S20
U/T1
V/T2
W/T3
R/L1
S.L2
T/L3
G/E
n
o
i
s
e
b
y
-
p
a
s
s
c
i
r
c
u
i
t
Fig.3
R/L1
S/L2
T/L3
R0
S0
/
/
/
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
I
R
C
U
I
T
Fig.1 Fig.2
CN21
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
I
R
C
U
I
T
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
I
R
C
U
I
T
PB
PA
PO
PC
Dynamic braking resistor
(*1)
(*2)
B-8
2.3.2 Control circuit terminals (sink logic(minus common))
Terminal
symbol
Input /
output
Function
Electrical
specification
Inverter internal
circuit
F Input
The motor rotates in forward direction if F and
CC are connected, while it slows down to a stop
if this Connection is broken. ( ST and CC are
connected).
R Input
The motor rotates in reverse direction if R and
CC are connected, while it slows down to a stop
if this connection is broken. (ST and CC are
connected ).
ST Input
The motor is on standby if ST and CC are
connected. It coasts to a stop (free-run stop) if
this connection is broken. This terminal can be
used for interlocking.
RES Input
This inverter protective function is disabled if
RES are CC is connected. Shorting RES and
CC has no effect when the inverter is in a
normal condition.
S1 Input
The motor rotates at a preset speed if S1 and
CC are connected.
S2 Input
The motor rotates at a preset speed if S2 and
CC are connected.
S3 Input
The motor rotates at a preset speed if S3 and
CC are connected.
S4 Input
*
The motor rotates at a preset speed if S4 and
CC are connected.
No-voltage
contact input
24Vdc 5mA and less
Sink logic/
source logic
switchable
Sink input
ON :5Vdc or less
OFF:11Vdc or more
Source input
ON:11Vdc or more
OFF:5Vdc or less
PP Output
Analog input setting power output.
10Vdc
Allowable load
current: 10mAdc)
RR Input
Multifunction programmable analog input.
Factory default setting: 0 to 10Vdc input sets 0 to
80Hz frequency range.
10Vdc
(Internal impedance:
33k)
VI
Multifunction programmable analog input.
Factory default setting: 2 to 10Vdc input sets 0 to
80Hz frequency range.
10Vdc
(Internal impedance
:33k)
I I
Input
Multifunction programmable analog input.
Factory default setting: 4 to 20mAdc input sets 0 to
80Hz frequency range.
4-20mA
(Internal impedance
:500)
RX Output
Multifunction programmable analog input.
Factory default setting: 0 to +/-10Vdc input sets 0
to +/-80Hz frequency range.
10Vdc
(Internal impedance
:69k)
*Multifunction programmable contact input
F S T C C C C
R R R F M O U T 1 P 2 4 P P
R E S S 2 S 3 S 4 R X S 1 F P O U T 2 A M
F L A F L B F L C
ST-CC shorting bar
P 5
1 0 k
3 .9 k 0 .1
1 5 k
4 .7 k
P 2 4
When using
contacts, choose
weak current
contacts to
avoid poor
contact.
P 2 4
0 .1
0 .4 7 Vol tage
transfer
i it
P 5
0 .1
1 8 k
1 5 k
1 0 k
0 .1
5 6 0
0 .1
0 .1
1 0 k
P 5
1 5 k 3 3 k
6 8 k 1 k
N 5
0 .1
P 5
1 0 k
1 5 k
1 8 k 5 6 0
0 .1
7 5 7 5 7 5 9 1 9 1 9 1
B-9
Terminal
symbol
Input /
output
Function
Electrical
specification
Inverter internal
circuit
FM Output
Multifunction programmable analog output. Factory
default setting: Operation frequency command.
Connect a 1mAdc full-scale ammeter or a
7.5Vdc(10Vdc)-1mA full-scale voltmeter.
1mA full-scale dc
ammeter or
7.5Vdc-1mA full-
scale dc voltmeter
AM Output
Multifunction programmable analog output. Factory
default setting: Output current. Connect a 1mAdc
full-scale ammeter or a 7.5Vdc(10Vdc)-1mA full-
scale voltmeter.
1mA full-scale dc
ammeter or
7.5Vdc-1mA full-
scale dc voltmeter
FP Output
Multifunction open collector output. This terminal
outputs pulses at 1.00 kHz to 43.20 kHz. Factory
default setting: 3.84kHz.
Max. 50 mA
CC
Common
to I/O
Common terminal of the control circuit.
P24 Output
24Vdc power output (power for control of the
inverter).
24Vdc-100mA
OUT1
Multifunction programmable open collector output.
The terminal has been set by default so as to detect
and output low-speed signal output frequencies.
OUT2
Output Multifunction programmable open collector output.
The terminal has been set by default so as to detect
and outputs signals indicating the completion of
acceleration/ deceleration.
Open collector
output:
24Vdc-50mA
*Sink logic/
source logic
switchable
FLA
FLB
FLC
Output
Relay contact output. Contact rating: 250 Vac = -2
A (cos= 1), 30 Vdc-1 A and 250 Vac-1A (cos =
0.4). Used to detect the activation of the inverter's
protective function. If the protective function is
activated, FLA-FLC circuit is closed, while FLB-FLC
circuit is opened .
250Vac-2A
30Vdc-1A
:resistor load
250Vac-1A
:cos=0.4
0 .1
4 .7 k
3 3 k
0 .0 1
1 0 0 k 1 8 k
4 7 0 p
1 0 k
0 .0 1
1 5 k
P 2 4
F U S E
0 .1 6 8 k
P 5
1 0 1 0
1 5 0 F U S E
F L
1 0 k
7 k
P 2 4
P 5
1 0 k
3 .9
B-10
Sink logic (minus common)/source logic (plus common)
... Switching I/O terminal
The input terminals of most control circuits are designed so that they turn on when a current flows out.
This type of logic is referred to as the "sink logic" (default setting). In Europe, however, the "source
logic" is widely adopted, in which the input terminals of control circuits turn on when a current passes
into them.
Switching logic
Before proceeding to wiring, switch logic without supplying power to the inverter. Switching between
the sink logic and the source logic at start-up or when the inverter is energized causes the inverter to
trip. In such a case, before resetting the inverter, make sure that the logic have been switched
correctly.
After switching logic, be sure to
attach the switch cover to
prevent the logic from being
switched by mistake.
If the error message (( (sink/source switching error) is displayed, check to be sure that the
sequence is normal, then reset the inverter.
C C
O U T 1
Sink logic
Inverter
F
C C
Programmable
controller
common
common
output
input
input
2 4 V
D C
2 4 V
D C
output
C C
O U T 1
Source logic
Inverter
P 2 4
Programmable
controller
common
common
output
input
input
2 4 V
D C
2 4 V
D C
output
Detach the cover
sink source
S
I
N
K
S
O
U
R
C
E
Detach the switch cover
Switch between the sink
logic and the source logic.
Attach the
switch cover
(Push the mark and make
the cover slide to the right.)
B-11
2.3.3 Serial RS485 communication connector
Figure of serial RS485 communication connector
To use the serial RS485 connector, detach the cover
for serial RS485 connector.
Signal name Pin number content
RXA 4 Same phase reception data(positive line)
RXB 5 Anti-phase reception data(positive line)
TXA 3 Same phase transmitting data(positive line)
TXB 6 Anti-phase transmitting data(positive line)
SG 2,8 Ground line of signal data
This table shows signal line of inverter side.
(Example: RXA signal is received by inverter.)
Never use pin-1(24Vdc) and pin-7(5Vdc).
Connecting diagrams for RS485 communication
Note
Please detach a communication line and the main circuit wiring 20cm or more.
Please do not connect pin-1(24Vdc) and pin-7(5Vdc).
Please twist the lines between RXA and RXB, between TXA and TXB by the twist pair cable.
Please connect terminus resistance at the terminal (both ends) of a transmission way.
When you use it by 2 line type, please short-circuit between RXB and TXB, between RXA and TXA.
Master side reception(pin-4,pin-5) / slave side transmitting(pin-3,pin-6) lines may not connect at the time
of communication between inverters.
Terminal resistor
120-1/2W
VF-P7(slave)
Upper computer
or VF-P7(master)
R X A
R X B
T X A
T X B
S G
R X A
R X B
T X A
T X B
S G
R X A
R X B
T X A
T X B
S G
R X A
R X B
T X A
T X B
S G
cross each other straight straight
VF-P7(slave) VF-P7(slave)
Pin-8 Pin-1
C-1
Danger
Prohibited
Do not touch any inverter's terminal when the inverter is energized even if the
motor is at a standstill, or you could get a shock.
Do not operate switches with a wet hand or not wipe it with a wet cloth, or you
could get a shock.
Do to get near the alarm-stopped motor when the inverter is in retry mode, or you
could get an injury. Safety measures, for example, attach a cover to the motor, to
protect persons from accidents when the motor unexpectedly restarts.
Mandatory
Do not turn on the power before attaching the front cover (or closing the do or of
the cabinet in which the inverter is installed), or you could get a shock.
Turn off the power immediately in case the inverter smokes, smells strangely, or
produce abnormal noise. Failure to do so could lead to a fire. If any defect is found,
request your Toshiba dealer for repair.
Turn off the power before leaving the inverter out of operation for a long period of
time.
Do not turn on the power before attaching the front cover. When the inverter is
installed in a cabinet with the inverter's front panel detached, always close the
door of the cabinet before turning on the power. Turning on the power with the
cover or the door left opened could lead to an electric shock.
Turn off the operation signal before resetting the inverter after trouble, or the
motor unexpectedly restarts, causing injury to persons.
Warning
Never touch
Do not touch any heat radiating fin or heat radiating resistor, or you could get a
burn since they become very hot during operation.
Mandatory
Operate the motor always within the allowable operation range. (Refer to the
motor's instruction manual for its allowable operation range.) Failure to do so
could cause injury to persons.
3. Operating the inverter
C-2
3.1 Control modes of the VF-P7 inverter
[Speed control mode] : The motor runs at the speed specified by a frequency
command.
(1) V/f control - V/f constant (constant torque characteristic) ... [default setting]
For loads, such as belt conveyors and cranes, that require, even in low speed ranges, the
same torque as that produced at their respective rated speeds.
(2) V/f control - Square reduction torque
For loads, such as fans, pumps and blowers, the torque of which are proportional to the
squares of their respective rotating speeds.
(3) Automatic torque boost mode.
In this mode, the inverter automatically adjusts the supply voltage to ensure that the motor
produces constant torque in any speed range.
(4) Sensor-less vector control mode,
In this mode, the inverter controls the motor so that it produces sufficiently large torque
even in an extremely low speed range and it keeps its rotating speed constant even if the
load torque fluctuates. This mode of operation is best suited to transportation, lifting and
winding equipment.
(5) Automatic energy-saving mode.
In this mode, the inverter monitors the output voltage and passes an output current
commensurate with the load. This mode of operation is used in conjunction with the above
mode (3) or (4).
[Torque control mode] : The motor torque is controlled by torque command signals.
The motor's rotating speed is determined by the
relationship between the load torque and the torque
produced by the motor.
Sensor vector control (Optional)
When combined with a sensor-equipped motor, the inverter controls the motor with a
higher accuracy.
[Speed control mode] : The motor's rotating speed is controlled with a higher
accuracy, even in low speed ranges, by feedback
signals.
[Torque control mode] : The motor torque can be controlled in this mode. The
motor speed is determined by the relation ship between
the load torque and the motor torque. The accuracy in
controlling regenerative torque and power-running
torque at extremely low speeds is improved by feedback
signals.
[Position command mode] : Positioning control is carried out by means of pulses.
Pre-operation check the following check again before starting operation
Pre-operation check the following check again before starting operation.
1) Are all wires and cables connected correctly?
2) Does the supply voltage agree with the rated input voltage?
C-3
3.2 Simple operation of the VF-P7 [1] [Speed control mode]
A speed control mode can be selected from among three: control panel operation, terminal board
operation and combination of both. (Refer to 5.3 for other modes of operation.)
[Terminal operation] : Operation by means of external signals
[Panel operation] : Operation by means of keys on the control panel
[Panel + terminal operation] : Frequency, start and stop signals can be sent individually
from the control panel and the terminal board.
3.2.1Operation from the terminal(external signals) Terminal operation
Start/Stop Operation command mode selection (I(_([Default setting]
and closed : Forward run
and open : Slowdown stop
(When terminals and are electrically
connected.
Example of typical connection
Forward run if ON
Deceleration stop if OFF
Reverse run if ON,
Slowdown stop if OFF
Stand-by if ON,
free-run stop if OFF
C-4
Frequency setting
Setting the operation frequency with an external volume control
By default, the VF-P7 inverter has been set to a mode in which an external volume
control can be used for setting the operation frequency.
[Parameter setting]
Speed setting mode selection parameter II(_ at _.
(There is no need to set this parameter before the first use after purchase.)
Setting the frequency by voltage signals (0 to 10 V)
[Parameter setting]
Speed setting mode selection parameter II(_ at _.
(There is no need to set this parameter before the first use after purchase.)
Setting the frequency by a current signal (4 to 20 mA)
[Parameter setting]
Speed setting mode selection parameter II(_ at .
This setting cannot be made when the terminal VI is used.
Frequency setting
with potentiometer
Volume control
The operation frequency by potentiometer (1 to
10k1/4 W) for setting
Refer to 7.3 for details of adjustment.
M IN
M A X
Frequency
80Hz
0
MIN MAX
80Hz
Frequency
0
4mAdc 20mAdc
Current signal
Current signals (4 to 20 mA) for setting the
operation frequency.
Refer to 7.3 for details of adjustment.
Voltage signal
Voltage signals (0 to 10 V) for setting t
he operation frequency
Refer to 7.3 for details of adjustment.
80Hz
0
0Vdc 10Vdc
Frequency
C-5
Setting the frequency by voltage signals (0 to 10 Vdc)
[Parameter setting]
Speed setting mode selection parameter II(_ at .
This setting cannot be made when the terminal II is used.
Setting the frequency by voltage signals (0 to +/-10Vdc)
The direction can be changed by switching between positive and negative signals.
[Parameter setting]
Speed setting mode selection parameter II(_ at _.
Note)Set reference priority selection I_(( at ((II(_, Default setting). Changing the
settings of two speed command parameters at a time, refer to 6.6.
[Ex.: To set the frequency by current signal (4 to 20 mAdc) through the terminal]
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The running frequency is displayed. (Make this setting when the
motor is out of operation.) (If the monitor display mode setting
parameter I( is set at ( [Running frequency])
H(
Press the [MON] key to call up the first basic parameter H(
(automatic acceleration/deceleration).
II(_
Select II(_ by pressing the or key.
_
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting (set value).
(Default setting: _)
Voltage signal
Voltage signals (0 to +/-10 V) for setting the
operation frequency Refer to 7.3 for details
of adjustment.
-10Vdc
+10Vdc
Forward run
80Hz
80Hz
Reverse run
Frequency
80Hz
0
0Vdc 10Vdc
Voltage signal
Voltage signals (0 to 10 V) for setting the
operation frequency Refer to 7.3 for details of
adjustment.
MON
ENT
ENT
Necessary to change the VI/II input point 1 setting I_(.
C-6
3.2.2 Operation from the control panelControl panel operation
This section describes how to start/stop the motor, and set the operation frequency with the operating panel.
Set the operation freq.
Start the motor
Stop the motor.
(Deceleration stop)
Change the settings of the following two parameters first from the operating panel.
(I(_Control panel: Parameter determining the operation mode
II(__Control panel: Parameter determining the input mode of speed reference
[Setting procedure]
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The running frequency is displayed. (Make this setting when the
motor is out of operation.)(If the monitor display mode setting
parameter I( is set at ( [Running frequency].)
H(
Press the [MON] key to call up the first basic parameter H(
(automatic acceleration/deceleration).
(I(_ Select (I(_ by pressing the or key.
(
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting.
(Default setting: ()
ENT
ENT
ENT
ENT
RUN
ENT
STOP
C-8
3.3Operation of the VF-P7 [2]
PID control function of VF-P7 enables process control such as wind regulation or flux regulation,
pressure regulation. Operation permission / prohibition
3.3.1 The outline of PID control
The outline block diagram of PID control becomes like the following figure.
Note) Jump frequency function is performed to either of the following.
Process amount
Output frequency (Motor speed)
Set up with parameter I_( for your application.
Block diagram of PID control system becomes like the following.
Over-ride
process
Jump frequency
process #1
(Process value)
Run frequency
process
An example of deviation
IH/(j
jj
Delay filter
Feedback amount
PID deviation
upper limit
PID deviation
lower limit
Integral gain
Proportional gain
Differential gain
Output
frequency
Reference of
process amount
Permission or
prohibition of
operation
IH/(j
jj
Acceleration/
deceleration
process
Jump frequency
process #1
(Output frequency)
PID controller
Fan, pump
and so on.
VF-P7
Reference of
process amount
Feedback amount
Output
frequency
Process amount
C-9
3.3.2 Settings of PID control
Parameters for PID control are following. Refer to Chapter 4 for how to set the parameters.
Item of setting Parameter Adjustment range
Default
setting
Reference
section
Maximum frequency IH _(.( H((.( [Hz] ((.( 5.7
Upper limit frequency (j (.( IH [Hz] ((.( 5.8
Lower limit frequency jj (.( (j [Hz] (.( 5.8
Input terminal of
feedback amount
I_((
(: PID control disabled, : VI/II,
_: RR, _: RX1, H: RX2
(
Only this
section
Process amount
reference setting
mode selection
II(_ (Refer to (4) for details) _ 5.3
Acceleration time H(( (. (((( [s]
Model
dependent
5.1.2
Deceleration time _(( (. (((( [s]
Model
dependent
5.1.2
Jump frequency
I_(
I__
I_H
(.( IH [Hz] (.( 6.10
Jump frequency
band
I_
I__
I__
(.( _( [Hz] (.( 6.10
Object of jump
frequency process
I_(
(: Process amount
: Output frequency
(
Only this
section
I((( ( ( 6.27
Over ride
I(( ( _ ( 6.27
I_H (.( IH [Hz] (.( 6.7.2
Run frequency
I_H_ (.( _(.( [Hz] (.( 6.7.2
(1) Maximum frequency
Set the maximum value of frequency range that the inverter outputs, with maximum frequency
(IH).
(2) Upper limit frequency / Lower limit frequency
Set the permissible maximum value of output frequency with upper limit frequency ((j) and
permissible minimum value of output frequency with lower limit frequency (jj).
Upper limit frequency and lower limit frequency are also effective to process amount. Upper limit
frequency and lower limit frequency limit process amount
(3) Input terminal for feedback amount
Set the input terminal for feedback amount with I_((.
Refer to 7.3 for the scaling adjustment of analog input. This adjustment is effective for the case
that input value of feedback amount is very small. Set the zero point of the feedback amount at
the 0Hz and the maximum value of the feedback amount at the maximum frequency (IH).
Example of setting 1) In case of 4 to 20mA feedback amount (use the I I terminal)
Note) Since feedback amount is treated as frequency value inside the inverter, the setting
shown in the above figure is needed. Maximum frequency (IH) limits the feedback
amount after the frequency conversion.
4mA 20mA
(0Hz)
(80Hz)
I_(_
I_(H
(100%) (20%)
I_(_ I_(
Maximum frequency (IH) is
assumed to be 80Hz.
C-10
The reverse characteristic is also possible by changing the setting.
Example of setting 2) In case of 4 to 20mA feedback amount (use the I I terminal)
(4) Process amount reference setting mode selection
Setting mode of reference of the process amount is set with II(_.
Title Adjustment range
II(_
: VI (voltage input)/II (current input), _: RR (volume/voltage input),
_: RX (voltage input), H: RX2 (voltage input) (optional), _: Operating panel input,
(: Binary/BCD input(optional), : Common serial communication option(FA01)
(: Serial communication RS485(FA05), _: Communication add-on cassette option(FA07)
(: Up-down frequency, : Pulse input #1 (optional)
Refer to 7.3 for the scaling adjustment of analog input.
Example of setting) In case of 0 to 10V feedback amount (use the RR terminal)
Note) Since reference of the process amount is treated as frequency value inside the inverter,
the setting shown in the above figure is needed. Maximum frequency (IH) limits the
reference of process amount after the frequency conversion. Upper limit frequency ((j)
and lower limit frequency (jj) also limit the reference of process amount after the
frequency conversion. (Refer to the block diagram in 3.3.1)
Two types of reference commands (refer to 6.6) or 15 preset speeds operation (refer to 5.14) are
also be available for reference of the amount of processes.
(5) Acceleration/deceleration time
Set the acceleration time (H(() and the deceleration time (_(() at a smallest value ((.).
The response of PID control becomes fast. However, when a trip occurs, make setting values of
these parameters larger.
(6) Jump frequency
Jump processing can be performed to the reference of the process amount. At this time, setting
of jump processing is effective to the value after frequency conversion.(Refer to Example of
setting in (4) above.) If you want to avoid resonance by the eigenoscillation frequency of the
mechanical system, set I_( at 1. Jump processing becomes effective to output frequency.
However in this case, since the jump frequency band turns into non-sensitive band and
hunching between upper and lower side of jump frequency band may occur, resonance is
completely unavoidable. Please be careful enough in use.
Note) Jump processing cannot be performed to both reference of process amount and output
frequency.
0V 10V
I_
I__
(100%) (0%)
I__ I_(
(0Hz)
(80Hz)
4mA 20mA
I_(H
I_(_
(100%) (20%)
I_(_ I_(
(0Hz)
(80Hz)
Maximum frequency (IH) is
assumed to be 80Hz.
C-11
(7) Over-ride
Over-ride function (I((( I(() is effective to the reference of process amount. Use this
function to tune the reference finely.
(8) Run frequency
Run frequency function (I_H I_H_) is effective to the process amount.
It is a function that the inverter will operate if the setup of the process amount becomes higher
than (I_H+I_H_), and the inverter will stop operation if becomes lower than (I_H-
I_H_).
(9) Change to the open loop control operation
When you change from PID operation (automatic operation) to open loop operation (manual
operation), assign PID control OFF selection function (36/37) to an input terminal (refer to 7.2.1
for details), or set the signal selection of PID control (I_(() at (. At this time, since
acceleration/deceleration times are set short as described in (5), cautions are required.
Acceleration/deceleration times can be changed as occasion. (Refer to 6.23.2 for details)
3.3.3 Adjustment of PID control
Adjust the PID control gain to process amount, feedback signal and control object.
[Parameter settings]
Title function Adjustment range Default setting
I_( Delay filter ( ___ (
I_(_ Proportional (P) gain (.( ((.( (.(
I_(_ Integral (I) gain (.( ((.( (.(
I_(H PID deviation upper limit ( _( [%] _(
I_(_ PID deviation lower limit ( _( [%] _(
I_(( Differential (D) gain (.(( _.__ (.((
(1) Proportional gain
Proportional (P) gain (I_(_) is proportional gain for PID control.
This gain is multiplied to deviation (difference between process amount and feedback amount)
and gives the amount of compensation that is proportional to deviation. Setting this parameter at
a large value gives a fast response, but too large value may result in an unstable phenomenon
like hunting.
I_(_ is small.
Slow response
I_(_ is large.
Fast response
Feedback amount
Time
Reference of
process amount
C-12
(2) Integral gain
Integral (I) gain (I_(_) is integral gain for PID control.
This gain acts to make the deviation which remains in proportional operation (remained
deviation offset) to zero. Setting this parameter at a large value gives smaller remained deviation
offset, but setting at a too large value may result in an unstable phenomenon like hunting.
(3) Differential gain
Differential (D) gain (I_(() is differential gain for PID control.
This gain acts to improve the response to sudden change of the deviation. Setting this
parameter at a too large value may result in an unstable phenomenon in which output frequency
is greatly unsteady.
(4) Delay filter
Delay filter (I_() acts to soften a rapid change of the deviation (linear delay function).
Usually, it is not necessary to change the setting. A small setting value makes processing fast, a
large setting value makes it slow.
(5) PID deviation upper limit
PID deviation upper limit (I_(H) is upper limit over positive deviation.
It limits the instantaneous value of deviation. Usually, it is not necessary to change the setting.
(6) PID deviation lower limit
PID deviation lower limit (I_(_) is upper limit over negative deviation.
It limits the instantaneous value of deviation. Usually, it is not necessary to change the setting.
I_(_is
large.
I_(_ is small.
Feedback amount
Time
Reference of process
amount
Remained deviation offset
I_(( is large.
I_(( is small.
Feedback amount
Time
The last deviation
This Time Deviation
Time
D-1
The VF-P7 inverter has the following three display modes:
[Normal monitor mode]Normal display mode. The inverter automatically enters this
display mode when it is turned on.
[Setting monitor mode] :In this mode, you can set inverter's operation parameters.
How to set parameters => Refer to 4.1.
[Status monitor mode]In this mode, you can monitor inverter's various statuses,
for example, the set frequency, the output voltage, the output
current and terminal information.
How to use the monitor => Refer to 8.1.
Press the key to switch to another display mode.
4.1 Setting parameters [Setting monitor mode]
The VF-P7 inverter is shipped with certain parameters factory-set by default. The para
meters are broadly classified under the following three groups. First, you need to select
the parameter you want to change or check.
[Basic parameter] : Parameters that you need to set before the first use after
purchase.
[Extended parameters] : Parameters used for detailed or particular settings
[User parameter] : Used to search for parameters the settings which have been
changed and are different from the factory default settlings.
Use this parameter to check parameter settings again after
confirmation or when changing parameter settings.(Parameter
code: (r.()
MON
4. Basic operation of the VF-P7
This mode enables you to monitor the output frequency and set frequency command
values. This mode is also used to display operation status alarm codes and error
messages if the inverter trips.
Frequency command setting => Refer to 3.2.1.
Status alarms
If something unusual occurs in the inverter, an alarm code and the output frequency
are displayed alternately on the LED display.
(: Indicates that a current exceeding the over-current stall limit is passed.
P: Indicates that an voltage exceeding the over-voltage stall limit is applied.
j: Indicates that the load exceeds 50% or more of the overload trip limit.
H: Indicates that the temperature in the inverter reaches the overheat protection
alarm level (about 85)
Status monitor mode Setting monitor mode
MON
MON
MON
[Speed control mode]
[Torque control mode]
Normal monitor mode
(For searching for parameters the settings of which have been changed).
D-2
ENT
ENT
The inverter is shipped with
certain parameters factory-set
by default.
Use "Parameter list" to select the
parameters you want to change.
If you feel puzzled about what to
do next during this operation,
press the Monitor key to return to
the first step ((.( is displayed).
MON
ENT
ENT
Press these keys to select the
parameter you want to change.
Press this key to display the
parameter setting.
Press this key to switch to setting
monitor mode.
Press these key to change the
parameter setting.
Press this key to save the change.
ENT
Press this key to
display the same
parameter setting.
MON
Press this key to
switch to status
monitor mode.
Press these keys
to call up other
parameters.
[Procedure for setting a basic parameter]
D-3
[Basic parameter list]
No. Title Function Adjustment range
Default
setting
Reference
section
1 H(
Automatic
acceleration/deceleration
(: Manual acceleration/deceleration
: Automatic acceleration/deceleration
( 5.1.1
2 H(_ Automatic V/f mode setting
(: (0 is always displayed.)
: Automatic torque boost + auto-tuning
_: Sensorless vector control (speed) + auto-tuning
_: Automatic energy-saving + auto-tuning
( 5.2
3 (I(_
Operation command mode
selection
(: Terminal block enabled
: Operating panel enabled
_: Common serial communication option enabled
_: Serial communication RS485 enabled
H: Communication add-on cassette option enabled
( 5.3
4 II(_
Speed setting mode
Selection
: VI (voltage input)/II (current input)
_: RR (volume/voltage input)
_: RX (voltage input)
H: RX2 (voltage input) (optional)
_: Operating panel input
(: Binary/BCD input(optional)
: Common serial communication option(FA01)
(: Serial communication RS485(FA05)
_: Communication add-on cassette option(FA07)
(: Up-down frequency
: Pulse input #1 (optional)
_ 5.3
5 II_j FM terminal meter selection ( _ ( 5.4
6 II
FM terminal meter
adjustment
5.4
7 j_P
Standard setting mode
selection
(:
: 50Hz standard setting
_: 60Hz standard setting
_: Factory default setting
H: Trip clear
_: Clearing accumulating operation time
(: Initialization of type form information
: Memorization of user-defined parameters
(: Reset of user-defined parameters
( 5.5
8 Ir
Forward/reverse selection
(At panel control only)
(: Forward,
: Reverse
( 5.6
9 H(( Acceleration time #1 (.(I_(() (((( [s] See J-28 5.1.2
10 _(( Deceleration time #1 (.(I_(() (((( [s] See J-28 5.1.2
11 IH Maximum frequency _(.( H(( [Hz] (( 5.7
12 (j Upper limit frequency (.( IH [Hz] (( 5.8
13 jj Lower limit frequency (.( (j [Hz] (.( 5.8
14 _j Base frequency #1 __.( H((.( [Hz] (( 5.9
15 Pj
Motor control mode
selection
(: Constant torque
: Variable torque mode
_: Automatic torque boost
_: Sensorless vector control (speed)
H: Automatic torque boost + automatic energy-saving
_: Sensorless vector control (speed) + automatic energy-saving
(: V/f 5-points setting
:Sensorless vector control (speed/torque switching)
(: PG feedback vector control (speed/torque switching)
_: PG feedback vector control (speed/position switching)
( 5.10
16 _j Manual torque boost ( _( [%] See J-28 5.12
Setting Type Overload protection Overload stall
( protect not stall
protect stall
_ not protect not stall
_
Standard
motor
not protect stall
H protect not stall
_ protect stall
( not protect not stall
17 (jI
Selection of electronic
thermal protection
characteristics
VF motor
(special
motor)
not protect stall
( 5.13
18 _r Preset-speed # 1 jj (j [Hz] (.(
19 _r_ Preset-speed # 2 jj (j [Hz] (.(
20 _r_ Preset-speed # 3 jj (j [Hz] (.(
21 _rH Preset-speed # 4 jj (j [Hz] (.(
22 _r_ Preset-speed # 5 jj (j [Hz] (.(
23 _r( Preset-speed # 6 jj (j [Hz] (.(
24 _r Preset-speed # 7 jj (j [Hz] (.(
5.14
25
I
I_
Extended parameter Setting of extended 4.1.2
26 (r.( Automatic edit function To search parameters different from default value. 4.1.2
D-4
4.1.2 How to set extended parameters
The VF-P7 inverter has extended parameters to allow you to make full use of its functions.
The code of every extended parameter is composed up of an and a 3-digit number.
[Procedure for setting an extended parameter]
You can return to the previous step by pressing the key
instead of the key.
Extended parameter
ENT
Press the Monitor key once, then press
the or key to select a parameter
(I I_) from among the basic
parameters.
Select the parameter you want to
change by pressing and
key, then press the Enter key to
display the parameter setting.
MON
MON
ENT
ENT
ENT
Press the Monitor key to switch to parameter setting
mode. (H( is displayed.)
Select the parameter (I I_) the code of which
is the closest to that of the parameter you want to change.
Press the Enter key to activate the selected parameter.
Select the parameter you want to change .
Press the Enter key to display the extended parameter
setting (value) you want to change.
Change the extended parameter setting (set value).
Press the Enter key to save the change.
MON
ENT
I
I_
I_
IH
I_
I(
I
I(
I_
I(( I__
I_(( I___
I_(( I___
IH(( IH__
I_(( I___
I((( I(__
I(( I__
I((( I(__
I_(( I___
D-5
Example of parameter setting
Follow the procedure below to set a parameter.
(Example of setting: Changing the positive torque limit parameter IHH from 150 to 100)
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The operation frequency is displayed. (Make this setting
when the motor is out of operation.)(If the monitor
display mode setting parameter I( is set at
([Running frequency])
H(
Press the [MON] key to call up the first basic parameter
H((Automatic acceleration/deceleration).
IH
Switch to the parameter group IH by pressing the
or key.
IH((
Press the Enter key to activate the selected parameter
group starting at IH((.
IHH
Press the key to switch to the power running torque
limit #1 IHH.
_(
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting
(set value).
((
Change the positive torque limit parameter from _(
to (( by pressing the key.
(( IHH
Press the Enter key to save the change. Then, the
parameter code and the set value are displayed
alternately.
4.1.3 Searching for changed parameters and changing their settings again
You can search for and display all parameters the settings of which have been changed
are different from their respective default settings, using the user parameter group (r.(.
With this parameter, you can also change their settings.
If you feel puzzled about what to do next during this operation, press the Monitor key
several times to return to the step H( and follow the above steps all over again.
Notes on operation
The user parameter group (r.( does not display changed parameters anymore if their
settings have been returned to their respective default settings.
It may take several seconds to display changed parameters because all data stored in the
user parameter group is checked against the factory default settings.
To cancel the parameter search in process, press the key. MON
MON
ENT
ENT
ENT
D-6
Searching for a parameter and changing its setting
Follow the procedure below to search for parameters and change their settings.
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The operation frequency is displayed. (Make this setting
when the motor is out of operation.)(If the monitor display
mode setting parameter I( is set at ([Running
frequency])
H(
Press the MON key to call up the first basic parameter
H( (Automatic acceleration/deceleration).
(r.(
Select the user group parameter (r.( by pressing the
or key.
(
Press the Enter key to enter the user parameter search
and change mode.
OR H((
The inverter searches for and displays parameters the
settings of which are different from their respective
default settings. Press the Enter key or key to switch
parameters displayed. (Press thekey to search for
parameters in reverse direction.)
(.(
Press the [MON] key to display the parameter setting
(set value).
_.(
Change the parameter setting by pressing or
key.
_(H((
Press the enter key to save the change. Then, the
parameter code and the set value are displayed
alternately.
() (I
((r)
Following the same steps as above, search for and
display other parameters you want to change, one by
one, by pressing the or key, to check or change
their settings.
() (
( is displayed again after completion of a
search for all changed parameters.
Parameter display
IrI
(.(
To cancel the parameter search in process, press the
Monitor key. Press the Monitor key once during search
to return to parameter setting mode. Then, press the
Monitor key to return to status monitor mode or normal
monitor mode (operation frequency display mode).
MON
ENT
ENT
ENT
If you feel puzzled about what to do next during this operation, press the Monitor key
several times to return to the step H( and follow the above steps all over again.
ENT
MON
MON
D-7
4.1.4Parameters that cannot be changed during operation
For safety, the following parameters are designed so that they cannot be changed when
the inverter is in operation. So, you need to stop the motor in advance to change these
parameters.
[Basic parameters]
H( (Automatic acceleration/deceleration)
H(_ (Automatic V/f mode setting)
(I(_ (Operation command mode selection)
II(_ (Speed setting mode selection)
IH (Maximum frequency)
j_P (Standard setting mode selection)
Pj (Motor control mode selection)
(jI (Selection of electronic thermal protection characteristics)
For the parameter used to write-protect of extended parameters during operation, refer to
Parameter list in 10.
4.1.5 Resetting all parameters to the factory default settings at a time
All changed parameters can be reset to their respective factory default settings at a
time by setting the standard setting mode selection parameter j_P at _.
Note) Refer to 5.5 for details of the standard setting mode selection parameter j_P.
Procedure for resetting all parameters to the factory default settings at a time
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The operation frequency is displayed. (Make this setting
when the motor is out of operation.)
H(
Press the [MON] key to call up the first basic parameter
H((automatic acceleration/deceleration).
j_P Switch to j_P by pressing or key.
(
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting (set
value). ("(" is always displayed when the parameter
j_P is called up.)
_
Change the parameter setting by pressing or
key. To return all parameters to the factory default
settings, change the parameter setting to _.
j
j is displayed while all parameters are being
reset to their respective default settings.
(.( The LED returns to the original display mode.
Note on operation
Setting the parameter j_P at _ causes all parameters to return to the factory default
settings. Therefore, it is advisable to note all changed settings before returning them to
the default settings.
MON
ENT
ENT
If you feel puzzled about what to do next during this operation, press the Monitor key
several times to return to the step H( and follow the above steps all over again.
D-8
Following parameters are designed considering maintenance that they cannot be reset to the
factory default setting even if you set the parameter j_P at _ (see 5.5). Moreover, x-marked
parameters are not displayed on the user parameter group (r.( (see 4.1.3) even if their settings
are different from their default settings. So please be careful.
Title Function
(r.(
display
Title Function
(r.(
display
II_j FM terminal meter selection IH( VI/II reference bias
II FM terminal meter adjustment
IH VI/II reference gain
I(( AM terminal meter selection IH_ RR reference bias
I( AM terminal meter adjustment
IH_ RR reference gain
I(_ Optional analog terminal #1 meter selection IHH RX reference bias
I(_ Optional analog terminal #1 meter adjustment
IH_ RX reference gain
I(H Optional analog terminal #2 meter selection IH( RX2 reference bias
I(_ Optional analog terminal #2 meter adjustment
IH RX2 reference gain
E-1
Basic parameters refer to parameters you need to set before the first use after purchase.
5.1 Setting the acceleration and deceleration times
H( Automatic acceleration/deceleration
H(( Acceleration time #1
_(( Deceleration time #1
5.1.1 Automatic acceleration/deceleration
In this mode, the acceleration and deceleration times are changed automatically
according to the load applied. H(
The acceleration and deceleration times are adjusted automatically within a range of
1/8 to 8 times longer than the times set with the H(( and the _((, respectively.
Set the parameter H((automatic acceleration/deceleration) at (enabled).
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
H(
Automatic acceleration/
deceleration
(: Manual acceleration/deceleration
: Enabled (automatic setting)
(
When the automatic acceleration/deceleration is selected (enabled), the acceleration/deceleration times
constantly change according to the load condition. So, use the manual setting(H((,_(() for machines
that need to be accelerated and decelerated always at constant rates.
Set manually the acceleration and deceleration times (H(() in the case that braking resistor or
braking unit is applied (I_(H).
Before setting this parameter, connect the inverter to the motor.
For a load that requires the inverter to be operated almost at its rated current, the motor may fail to reach
the specified speed within the specified time. In such a case, set manually the acceleration and
deceleration times (H(().
5. Explanation of the basic parameters
Function
1)The acceleration time parameter H(( is to set the time in which the inverter's output
frequency goes up from 0 Hz to the maximum frequency IH.
2)The deceleration time parameter _(( is to set the time in which the inverter's output
frequency goes down from the maximum frequency IH to 0 Hz.
Output frequency
[Hz]
Deceleration time Acceleration time
IH
Under a small load
Time [s]
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
H(( Acceleration time #1 (. (See note.) ~ (((( [s] Model dependent
_(( Deceleration time #1 (. (See note.) ~ (((( [s] Model dependent
Note) The minimum setting of acceleration and deceleration times have been set respectively
at 0.1sec. by default, but they can be changed within a range of 0.01 to 10 sec. by
changing the setting of the parameter I_(( (Acceleration/deceleration time lower
limit).
Refer to 6.23.3 for details.
If the acceleration or deceleration time is set shorter than the optimum time, which varies
according to the loading condition, it may become longer than the set time because of the
over-current stall function or the over-voltage stall function. In addition, if the acceleration or
deceleration time is set much shorter, the inverter trips more easily to protect itself from an
over-current or an over-voltage.
(Refer to 12.1 for details.)
Output frequency [Hz]
_(( H((
IH
Time [s]
ENT
ENT
E-3
5.2 Increasing starting torque/ energy-saving operation mode
H(_ Automatic V/f mode setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
H(_
Automatic V/f
mode setting
(: (( is always displayed.)
: Automatic torque boost + auto-tuning
_: Sensorless vector control (speed) + auto-tuning
_: Automatic energy-saving + auto-tuning
(
Note) The parameter always returns to ( after completion of the setting. To check the setting
(set value), check the H(_ previous monitor in monitor mode. (Refer to 8.1 for details.)
1 ) To automatically increase the torque according to the load condition
Set the automatic V/f mode setting H(_ at (automatic torque boost + auto-tuning).
When the automatic V/f mode setting H(_ is set at (automatic torque boost + auto-tuning),
the load current is observed in all speed ranges and the inverter's output voltage is adjusted
automatically so that the motor can always produce torque large enough for stable operation.
Note1) The same characteristic can be obtained by setting the motor control mode selection
Parameter Pj at _(automatic torque boost) and the automatic tuning IH(( (auto-
tuning) at _. => Refer to 5.10 for details.
[Setting procedure]
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The running frequency is displayed. (Make this setting When the
motor is out of operation.)(If the monitor display selection
parameterI( is set at ([Running frequency])
H(
Press the [MON]key to read the first basic parameter H(
(Automatic acceleration/deceleration).
H(_
Switch to the parameter H(_ (automatic control) by pressing
the key.
( Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting (set value).
E-4
2) The vector control (Increasing the starting torque and operating with a higher accuracy)
Set the automatic V/f mode setting H(_ at _(vector control (speed) and auto-tuning).
By setting the automatic V/f mode setting H(_ at _(vector control (speed control) and auto-
tuning), the motor reach its full potential and produce large torque even at low speeds. Also, you
can minimize motor speed fluctuations caused by load fluctuations for more accurate operation.
This mode of control is best suited to conveyor and crane/hoist application as operated in speed
control mode.
[Setting procedure]
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The running frequency is displayed. (Make this setting when the
motor is out of operation.)(If the monitor display selection
parameter I( is set at ([Running frequency])
H(
Press the [MON] key to call up the first basic
parameter H((automatic acceleration/deceleration).
H(_
Switch to the parameter H(_(Automatic V/f mode setting)
by pressing the key.
(
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting (set
value).
_
Change the parameter setting to 2 (sensor-less vector
control and auto-tuning) by pressing the key.
_H(_
Press the Enter key to save the change. Then, H(_ and
the set value are displayed alternately.
Note 1) The same characteristic can be obtained by setting the motor control mode selection
parameter Pjat _(vector control) and the auto-tuning parameter IH(( at _. Refer
to 5.10 for details.
2) Setting H(_ at _ causes Pj to be set at _ automatically.
3 ) To operate the inverter in energy-saving mode
Set the automatic V/f mode setting H(_ at _(automatic energy-saving + auto tuning).
When the automatic V/f mode setting H(_ is set at _, the inverter passes a current
commensurate with the load to save energy.
[Setting procedure]
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The running frequency is displayed. (Make this setting when the
motor is out of operation.)(If the monitor display mode setting
parameter I( is set at ([Running frequency])
H(
Press the [MON] key to call up the first basic parameter H(
(Automatic acceleration/deceleration).
H(_
Switch to the parameter H(_(Automatic V/f mode setting)
by pressing the key.
(
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting (set
value). (The value is always (.)
_
Change the parameter setting to _ (automatic energy-saving
and auto-tuning) by pressing the key.
_H(_
Press the Enter key to save the change. Then, H(_ and the
parameter set value _ are displayed alternately.
ENT
ENT
If you fail to make the setting for vector control ...,
First, read the notes on vector control in 9) of section 5.10)
1) If the expected torque cannot be obtained => Selection 3 in 6.20
2) If the auto-tuning error message (j is displayed => Selection 3 in 6.20
MON
ENT
ENT
MON
E-5
H(_(Automatic V/f mode setting) and Pj(Motor control mode selection)
The automatic control parameter is designed to set motor control mode selection parameter
(Pj) and the auto-tuning parameter(IH(() by one operation. Therefore, changing the H(_
setting causes the settings of all related parameters to be changed automatically.
Parameters set automatically
H(_ Pj IH((
( ( is always displayed.
Check the Pj setting (set value).
(((constant torque) if no change is
made to H()
II
Motor
IM
G/E
R/L1 U/T1
Control panel
Power
supply
S/L2
T/L3
V/T2
W/T3
CC RX VI RRPP
External volume control
II
F
R
ST
CC
Forward run if ON
Slowdown stop if OFF
Reverse run if ON
Slowdown stop if OFF
Standby if ON
Free-run stop if OFF
As for the action the motor takes
when both the terminals F and R
are connected at the same time,
you can make a selection between
reverse run and a stop.
=> Refer to 6.2.2
Other speed setting
H: RX2 (voltage input) (optional)*
(: 12/16-bit binary input (optional)*
: Serial communication (optional)*
(: Serial communication RS485
_: Communication add-on(optional)*
(: Up-down frequency
: Pulse input (optional)*
For the setting to be made when using
an asterisked optional device as an
input device, refer to the instruction
manual for the input device used.
RUN STOP
[Start/stop]: Press the key on the
operating panel.
To switch between forward run and reverse run,
use the forward/reverse run selection Ir.
[Speed command]: By means of external signals
(1) VI: 0 to +10 Vdc (0 to +5 Vdc)II: 4 to 20 mAdc
(2) RR: Volume / 0 to +10 Vdc (0 to +5 Vdc)
(3) RX: 0 to +/-10 Vdc (0 to +/-5 Vdc)
[Start/stop]: Connection and disconnection of terminals
F and CC/terminals R and CC.
[Speed command]: By means of external signals
(1) VI: 0 to +10Vdc (0 to +5Vdc)/II: 4 to 20mAdc
(2) RR: Volume/0 to +10 Vdc (0 to +5Vdc)
(3) RX: 0 to +/-10 Vdc (0 to +/-5Vdc)
Other speed setting
H: RX2 (voltage input) (optional)*
(: 12/16-bit binary input (optional)*
: Serial communication (optional)*
(: Serial communication RS485
_: Communication add-on(optional)*
(: Up-down frequency
: Pulse input (optional)*
For the setting to be made when using
an asterisked optional device as an
input device, refer to the instruction
manual for the input device used.
E-10
5.4 Setting and calibrating meters
II_j FM Terminal meter selection
II FM Terminal meter adjustment
I(( AM Terminal meter selection
I( AM Terminal meter adjustment
To calibrate the meter connected to the terminal FM or AM, use the FM Terminal meter adjustment
II or the AM Terminal meter adjustment I( respectively.
Connect meters as shown below.
Connection to terminal FMConnection to terminal AM
An frequency meter QS60T is optionally available.Use an ammeter capable of measuring up to a current
[Terminal FM-related parameters] 1.5 times larger than the rated current of the inverter.
Title Function Adjustment range Adjustment level Default setting
II_j
FM Terminal meter
selection
(: Running frequency
: Frequency command
_: Current
_: DC voltage
H: Output voltage
_: After-compensation frequency
(: Speed feedback (real-time value)
: Speed feedback (1 second filter)
(: Torque
_: Torque reference
(: Internal torque reference
: Torque current
_: Exciting current
_: PID feedback value
H: Motor overload factor (OL2 data)
_: Inverter overload factor (OL1 data)
(: PBr overload factor (PBrOL data)
: PBr load factor (pulse duty)
(: Input power
_: Output power
_(: Peak output current
_: Peak DC voltage
__: Motor counter dummy PG
__: Position pulse
_H: RR input
__: VI/II input
_(: RX input
_: RX2 input
_(: FM output
__: AM output
_(: Fixed output for meters
_: Analog output for communication
__: Acc/dec torque removal
(a)
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(a)
(a)
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(a)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(e)
(e)
(b)
(b)
(d)
(d)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(b)
(
II
FM Terminal meter
adjustment
Function
The terminals AM and FM send out analog voltage signals. Absolute value output
Use a full-scale 0~1 mAdc ammeter or a full-scale 0~7.5 Vdc (10 Vdc) voltmeter.
The reading of the
frequency meter fluctuates
during calibration.
Meter: Ammeter
(Default setting)
The reading of the
ammeter fluctuates during
calibration.
E-11
[Terminal AM-related parameters]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(( AM Terminal meter selection
Same as II_j(__: disabled)
_
I( AM Terminal meter adjustment
Resolution
Both the terminals FM and AM have a maximum resolution of 1/1024.
Calibrating a meter when the inverter is out of operation
If it is difficult to calibrate a meter because of large fluctuations of its reading, you may put the
inverter out of operation to make its calibration easier.
It is possible to adjust the meter for hte data item selected with the parameter II_j or
I((. Refer to the table on the next page for the calibration procedure.
Adjustment level:
(a): The output voltage FM/AM-CC reaches 100% at the maximum frequency (IH).
(b): The output voltage at FM/AM-CC reaches 100% when the reading on the control panel is 150%.
(c): The output voltage at FM/AM-CC reaches 100% when the reading on the control panel is 100%.
(d): Special output (Refer to the instruction manual for the applicable device.)
(e): The output voltage at FM/AM-CC reaches 100% when the electric power is
3200V(400V)(inverter rated current).
[Example of the calibration of the frequency meter connected to the terminal FM-CC]
*Before proceeding to calibration, make the zero-adjustment of the meter itself.
Key operated, LED display Operation
((.(
The running frequency is displayed.(If the monitor display
mode setting I( is set at ([Running frequency])
H(
Press the MON key to call up the first basic parameter
H( (automatic acceleration/deceleration).
II Select II by pressing the or key.
((.( Press the Enter key to display the running frequency.
((.(
Adjust the meter by pressing the or key.
Note that the meter reading varies during adjustment,
though the reading in the digital LED (monitor) on the
control panel does not change.
By setup, before the needle of meter begins to sway,
it will take time.
((.(II
Press the Enter key to terminate the meter calibration.
Then, II and the running frequency are displayed
alternately.
((.(
Press the Monitor key to return to the running frequency
display mode.(If the monitor display mode setting parameter
I( is set at ([Running frequency])
For meter connection, the VF-P7 inverter has two output terminals; FM and AM,
which can be used simultaneously.
ENT
ENT
MON
MON
[Point] Holding down the key for several
seconds facilitates this adjustment.
With the default settings, FM terminal outputs about 16 V (external impedance is
infinity) or about 3mA (external impedance is 0 ohm), when running frequency
is 80Hz. AM terminal outputs about 16 V or about 3mA, when the output current
reading on the control panel is 150%
E-12
[Example: Procedure of calibrating the meter connected to the terminal AM to which "output
current" is assigned.]
Key operated, LED display Operation
(.(
The running frequency is displayed.(If the monitor display mode
setting parameter I( is set at (. [Running frequency])
H(
Press the MON key to call up the first basic parameter
H((automatic acceleration/deceleration).
I( Select I( by pressing the or key.
I((( Press the Enter key to display the parameter I(((.
I((
Select the terminal AM terminal meter selection parameter
I(( by pressing key.
_
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting
(set value).
_(
Set the parameter at _( (fixed output for meter
calibration) by pressing the key.
_(I((
Press the Enter key to save the change. Then,
I(( and the set value are displayed alternately.
I(
Select the AM terminal meter sdjustment I( by
pressing key.
(( Press the Enter key to switch to the data display mode.
((
Calibrate the meter by pressing the or key. Adjust
the pointer to the graduation to which you want it to point
when the inverter passes a current 150% larger than its
rated output current.
(Note that the meter reading varies during adjustment,
though the reading in the digital LED (monitor) on the
control panel does not change.)
By setup, before the needle of meter begins to sway,
it will take time.
((I(
Press the Enter key to save the setting. Then, I( and
the set value are displayed alternately.
I((
_(
_
I((_
Select the terminal AM terminal meter selection parameter
I(( by pressing key.
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting.
Return the parameter setting to _ (output current display).
Press the Enter key to save the change. Then, I(( and
the newly-set value are displayed alternately.
(.(
Press the Monitor key three times to return to the running
frequency display mode.(If the monitor display mode setting
I( is set at ([Running frequency])
MON
ENT
ENT
ENT
ENT
ENT
MON
ENT
ENT
Base-frequency voltage #1
I_((
_j
Base frequency #1 _j
0
Output frequency [Hz]
Output voltage [V]
Output voltage [V]
E-19
4) To increase starting torque and the accuracy of operation - Vector control
[Set the V/f control selection parameter Pj at _(Sensorless vector control).]
In vector control mode, the VF-P7 inverter enables the Toshiba standard motor combined with it
to produce large torque even at extremely low speeds. The vector control mode is effective in:
(1) Obtaining large torque
(2) Achieving smooth and stable operation even in low speed ranges
(3) Eliminating load fluctuations due to slippage of the motor
(4) Making the motor produce large starting torque.
This control mode involves the setting of the motor constant.
Basically, however, there is no need to set the motor constant if the inverter is used for a
Toshiba 4P motor with the same capacity as the inverter. The motor constant can be set in any
of the following three ways:
1)Set the basic parameter H(_ at _. With this parameter, you can make the setting of
both the sensorless vector control and the motor constant (auto-tuning) at a time.
=> Refer to 5.2.2) for details.
2)Set the extended parameter IH(( at _. In this mode, the motor constant is set
automatically. (Auto-tuning) => Refer to selection 2 in 6.20 for details.
3)The constants of motors can also be set individually. => Refer to selection 3 in 6.20 for details.
[Procedure for setting the V/f control selection parameter Pj at _(Sensorless vector control)]
key operated, LED display Operation
(.(
The running frequency is displayed. (Make this setting when the
motor is out of operation.)(If the monitor display selection
parameter I( is set at ([Running frequency])
H(
Press the MON key to call up the first basic parameter
H((Automatic acceleration/deceleration).
Pj
Switch to the parameter Pj(Motor control mode selection)
by pressing key.
(
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting (set
value). (Default setting: ((Constant torque))
_
Change the parameter setting to _(Sensorless vector
control) by pressing the key.
_Pj
Press the Enter key to save the change. Then, Pj and the
set value _ are displayed alternately.
5) To increase the starting torque while saving energy
[Set the motor control mode selection parameter Pj at H
(Automatic torque boost + automatic energy-saving).]
In this mode, the load current is monitored in all speed ranges and the inverter's output
voltage (torque boost) is adjusted automatically so that the motor can always produce
torque large enough for stable operation. In addition, the output current is optimally
adjusted for energy saving according to the load applied.
This control mode involves the setting of the motor constant.
Basically, however, there is no need to set the motor constant if the inverter is used for
a Toshiba 4P motor with the same capacity as the inverter.
The motor constant can be set in any of the following two ways:
1)Set the extended parameter IH(( at _. In this mode, the motor constant is set
automatically. (Auto-tuning) => Refer to selection 2 in 6.20 for details.
2)The constants of motors can also be set individually.
=> Refer to selection 3 in 6.20 for details.
MON
ENT
ENT
E-20
6) To increase starting torque and the accuracy while saving energy
[Set the motor control mode selection parameter Pj at _
(Sensor-less vector control + automatic energy-saving).]
In vector control mode, the VF-P7 inverter enables the Toshiba standard motor
combined with it to produce large torque even at extremely low speeds. In addition, the output
current is optimally adjusted for energy saving according to the load applied.
This function is effective in:
(1) Obtaining large torque,
(2) Achieving smooth and stable operation even in low speed ranges
(3) Eliminating load fluctuations due to slippage of the motor, and
(4) Making the motor produce large starting torque.
This control mode involves the setting of the motor constant.
Basically, however, there is no need to set the motor constant if the inverter is used for a
Toshiba 4P motor with the same capacity as the inverter.
The motor constant can be set in any of the following three ways:
1)Set the basic parameter H(_ at _. In this mode, you can make the setting of both the
automatic energy-saving and the motor constant (auto-tuning) at a time.
=> Refer to 5.2.3) for details.
2)Set the extended parameter IH(( at _. In this mode, the motor constant is set
automatically. (Auto-tuning) => Refer to selection 2 in 6.20 for details.)
3)The constants of motors can also be set individually.
=> Refer to selection 3 in 6.20 for details.
7) To set the V/F characteristic arbitrarily
[Set the V/f control selection parameter Pj at ((V/f 5-points setting).]
In this mode, the base frequency and the base-frequency voltage for the V/f control need to
be set to operate the motor while switching a maximum of 5 different V/f characteristics.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(
V/f 5-point setting V/F1 frequency (.( (j [Hz]
(
I_ V/f 5-point setting V/F1 voltage ( (( [%]
(.(
I__
V/f 5-point setting V/F2 frequency (.( (j [Hz]
(
I__ V/f 5-point setting V/F2 voltage ( (( [%]
(.(
I_H
V/f 5-point setting V/F3 frequency (.( (j [Hz]
(
I__ V/f 5-point setting V/F3 voltage ( (( [%]
(.(
I_(
V/f 5-point setting V/F4 frequency (.( (j [Hz]
(
I_ V/f 5-point setting V/F4 voltage ( (( [%]
(.(
I_(
V/f 5-point setting V/F5 frequency (.( (j [Hz]
(
I__ V/f 5-point setting V/F5 voltage ( (( [%]
(.(
100% adjustment value (200V class: 200V, 400V class: 400V)
Note) Do not set the manual torque boost (_j) above 5%. Boosting the torque too much may impair the
linearity between points.
Output frequency
[Hz]
_j
_j
E-23
[Torque reference]
The command set with the parameter IH_( is valid. (Default setting: RX input)
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
IH_(
Torque reference
selection
: VI (voltage input)/II (current input)
_: RR (volume/voltage input)
_: RX (voltage input)
H: RX2 (voltage input) (optional)
_: Operating panel input
(: Binary/BCD input(optional)
: Common serial communication option
(: Serial communication RS485
_: Communication add-on cassette optio
n
_
E-24
5.12 Manual torque boost - Increasing the torque produced at low speeds
_j Manual torque boost
[Parameter]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
_j Manual boost ( _( [%] Model dependent
This parameter is valid when Pj = ((V/f constant), (square reduction torque) or
((V/f 5-points setting).
Note 1) Torque boost rate has been set optimally according to the inverter capacity. Do not set the
torque boost rate too high, or the inverter may trip during start-up because of an over-current.
When needs to be changed, be careful not to increase more than +/-2% of the default value.
5.13 Setting the electronic thermal protective function
(jI Selection of electronic thermal protection characteristics
I((( Motor overload protection level #1
I((( Overload reduction start-up frequency
I(( Motor 150%-overload time limit
Parameter setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
Setting
Kind of
motor
Overload
protection
Overload stall
( protect not stall
protect stall
_ not protect not stall
_
Standard
motor
not protect stall
H protect not stall
_ protect stall
( not protect not stall
(jI
Selection of electronic
thermal protection
characteristics
VF motor
(special
motor)
not protect stall
(
I(((
Motor overload protection
level #1
( (( [%] ((
Function
When the torque produced in low speed ranges is not large enough, it can be
boosted up by increasing the torque boost rate with this parameter.
Function
These parameters are used to set the electronic thermal protective function according to
the rating and characteristic of the motor to be controlled.
Base-frequency voltage I_((
Output frequency [Hz]
_j
Base frequency _j
Output voltage []
E-25
1) Setting the electronic thermal protection characteristics parameter (jI and
the motor overload protection level #1 I(((
The electronic thermal protection characteristics selection parameter (jI is used to
enable or disable the motor overload trip function ((j_) and the soft stall function.
The motor overload trip function ((j_) needs to be selected with the parameter
(jI, while the inverter overload trip function ((j) is always activated.
[A general-purpose motor (other than motors intended for use with inverters)]
When a motor is operated in a frequency range below its rated frequency, its cooling
efficiency drops. To prevent the motor to overheat because of this, the overload detecting
point is advanced when the inverter is used for a general-purpose motor.
Setting the electronic thermal protective function (jI
Set value Overload protection Overload stall
(
protect not stall
protect stall
_
not protect not stall
_
not protect stall
Setting the motor overload protection level #1 I(((
When the inverter is used for a motor with a capacity or a current rating smaller than that of the
inverter, it is necessary to adjust the motor overload protection level #1 parameter I((( to
the rated current of the motor.
Explanation of terms
Overload stall(Soft stall):
The function of automatically lowering the output frequency before the motor
overload trip function (j_ is activated when the inverter detects that an
excessive load is applied to the motor. (Lowers maximum about 48Hz when
base frequency is 60Hz.) This function enables the inverter to output a
frequency commensurate with the load current so that the motor can keep
running without tripping. This function is useful for such loads as fans, pump
and blowers, which have the square reduction torque characteristic that the
current passed decreases as the rotating speed falls.
Note) Do not use this overload stall function for loads with a constant torque characteristic (e.g., a belt
conveyer to which a constant load current is always passed regardless of their speed).
Note) The motor overload starting level is fixed at 30 Hz.
If necessary, set (jI at H .
(See the next page for the setting procedure.)
I((( 0.6
I((( 1.0
Output frequency [Hz]
Output current reduction rate [%]
0
30
E-26
[Example of setting: VF-P7 2220P with a 18.5 kW motor (rated current: 66A)]
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The running frequency is displayed. (Make this setting when the
motor is out of operation.)(If the monitor display mode setting
parameter I( is set at ([Running frequency])
H(
Press the MON key to call up the first basic parameter
H((automatic acceleration/deceleration).
I(
Switch to I((extended parameters of from ((( to
(__) by pressing the or key.
I(((
Press the Enter key to call up the parameter I(((
(electronic thermal motor protection level 1).
((
Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting (set
value). (Default setting: (( %)
_
Change the parameter setting to
_ = (motor's rated current/inverter's rated output
current) x 100
= 66.0/88.0 x 100)
_ I(((
Press the Enter key to save the change. Then, I(((
and the set value are displayed alternately.
[VF motor (motor intended for use with an inverter)]
Setting the electronic thermal protective function (jI
Set value Overload protection Overload stall
H
protect not stall
_
protect stall
(
not protect not stall
ENT
ENT
I((( 6.0
Output frequency [Hz]
Output current reduction rate [%]
Setting of motor overload start level
I((( 0.6
I((( 1.0
E-27
2) Motor 150%-overload time limit I((
The motor 150%-overload time limit parameter I(( is used to set the time elapsed before
the motor trips under a load of 150% (overload trip (j_) within a range of 10 to 2400 seconds.
[Example: setting of I((]
Monitored output
current [%]
Motor overload withstanding time [s]
(Outline data)
I((=((( I((=_(( I(((
=((
I(((
=_( I((( (.( [Hz] I((( (.( [Hz]
68 34 7200 3600
70 35 3600 1800
80 40 1000 500
90 45 600 300
100 50 420 210
112 56 12000 310 6000 155
120 60 2400 270 1200 135
130 65 1200 230 600 115
140 70 800 190 400 95
150 75 600 170 300 85
200 100 270 110 135 55
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(( Motor 150%-overload time limit ( to _H(( [s] (((
3) Inverter overload characteristic
This function is provided to protect the inverter itself and it cannot be changed or
disabled by changing any parameter setting.
If the inverter overload trip function ((j) is activated frequently, this condition can be
improved by changing the setting of the stall prevention level parameter I(( to a
lower level or increasing the acceleration time H(( or the deceleration time _((.
Inverter overload withstanding time
[s] (Outline data)
Output
current
[%]
200V:18.5 55kW
400V:18.5 75kW
200V:75 110kW
400V:90 315kW
106 900 900
110 180 180
115 90 90
120 60 60
120 6.8 6
140 3.4 3
150 2.3 0.3
180 0.5
If the load applied to the inverter exceeds 120% of its rated load or the
operation frequency is less than 0.1Hz, the inverter may trip in a shorter time.
Inverter's overload protective characteristic
Monitored output current [%]
Inverter overload
withstanding time [s]
60
105% 120%
Preset-speed #4
3) Use of a preset-speed command in combination with another speed command
When no preset-speed command is issued, the inverter accepts an input command
from the control panel or another analog input device.
Other speed commands
Frequency setting signals from the
control panel
Analog signal input command
(VI, II, RR, RX1 and RX2)
Preset-speed
command
Entered Not entered Entered Not entered
Entered
Preset-speed
command valid
Preset-speed
command valid
Preset-speed
command valid
Preset-speed
command valid
Not entered
Control panel
command valid
Analog signal valid
If a preset-command and another speed command are entered at the same time,
priority is always given to the preset-speed command.
The following figure shows an example of the operation in preset-speed 7 modes with default setting.
Example of the operation in preset-speed 7 modes
ST-CC
F-CC
S1-CC
S2-CC
S3-CC
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
_r
_r_
_r_
_r
_r_
_rH
_r(
Output frequency [Hz]
Time [s]
0
F (Forward run)
C C
S4
S2
S3
S1
R (Reverse run)
E-30
4) Setting the operation mode
An operation mode can be selected for each preset-speed.
Operation mode setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_((
Present-speed operation
mode
(: Disabled
: Enabled
(
(: Disabled ... Only frequency commands are governed by the preset-speed
command (#1 to #15) entered.
: Enabled ... The direction of rotation, the V/f control mode, the acceleration and
deceleration times and the torque limit can be set individually for each
preset-command.
If you selected enabled,the motor runs operation mode setting directions as below
without following terminal F,R.
Operation mode setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_( I___
Present-speed
#1 to #15
control mode
+(: Forward run
+: Reverse run
+_: Selection of acc/dec
switching #1
+H: Selection of acc/dec
switching #2
+(: Selection of V/f switching #1
+(: Selection of V/f switching #2
+__: Selection of torque limit
switching #1
+(H: Selection of torque limit
switching #2
(
For the settings marked with +, more than one function can be selected at the same time by
entering the sum of the numbers of the desired functions.
Ex.1) (+) + (+_) = _
By entering _, you can activate the reverse run function and the acceleration/deceleration
time #2 function at the same time.
Ex.2) (+() + (+_) + (+H)= (
By entering (, you can activate the forward run function and the acceleration/deceleration
time #4 function at the same time.
(Selecting both of acc/dec switching #1 and acc/dec switching #2 means selection
of acceleration/deceleration time #4. This manner is common to V/f pattern and
torque limit.)
F-1
Extended parameters are used for sophisticated operation, fine adjustment and special purposes.
Change parameter settings, as required.
Extended parameter list => Refer to Chapter 10.
6.1Frequency signals
6.1.1 Low-speed signal
I(( Low-speed signal output frequency
[Parameter setting]
Tytle Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(( Low-speed signal output frequency (.( (j (.(
[Connection diagram (Sink logic)]
6. Extended parameters Speed control modeTorque control mode
Function
When the output frequency exceeds the frequency set with the parameter F100, an ON
signal is put out. The function of this parameter is to send a signal for exciting or releasing
an electromagnetic brake.
through the open collector terminal OUT1 or OUT2 (24 Vdc - max. 50 mA). (Default setting: OUT 1)
Output terminal setting
The low-speed signal (ON signal) output function has been assigned to the
terminal OUT1 by default. To invert output signals, it is necessary to change
the setting of the output terminal selection parameter.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Set value
I_(
Output terminal
selection #1 (OUT1)
( _
H: Low speed signal(a-contact)
or
_: Low speed signal(b-contact)
Note) To use OUT2 terminal, set the parameter I_.
P24
OUT1(or OUT2) Ry
Output frequency [Hz]
[s]
I((
ON
OFF
Low-speed signal output: Inversion
P24-OUT1
ON
OFF
0
Set frequency
Low-speed signal output (Default setting)
P24-OUT1
(
)
F-2
6.1.2 Putting out signals of arbitrary frequencies
I( Speed reach setting frequency
I(_ Speed reach detection band
Setting of reach frequency and detection frequency band
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I( Speed reach setting frequency (.( (j (.(
I(_ Speed reach detection band (.( (j _._
Setting of output terminal parameter
Title Function Adjustment range Set value
I_
Output terminal
selection #2 (OUT2)
( _
(: Specified speed arrival(a-contact)
or
_: Specified speed arrival(b-contact)
Note) To put out signals to OUT 1, select the parameter I_(.
1) If detection frequency band + Speed reach setting frequency < Reference frequency
2) If detection frequency band + speed reach frequency > reference frequency
Function
When the output frequency enters the frequency range delimited by the frequencies
set arbitrarily with the parameters I( and I(_ ( (I(-set frequency) +/-
(I(_-set frequency) ), an ON or OFF signal is put out.
Speed reach setting frequency(Default setting)
P24-OUT2
Speed reach setting frequencyInverse
P24-OUT2
Output frequency [Hz]
[s]
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
0
Output frequency [Hz]
[s]
I( I(_
ON
OFF
I( I(_
I(
Speed reach setting frequency(Default setting)
P24-OUT2
Speed reach setting frequencyInverse
P24-OUT2
ON
OFF
0
(
)
(
)
I( I(_
I( I(_
I(
F-3
6.2 Selection of input signals
6.2.1 Changing standby signal function
I(_ ST (standby) signal selection
Parameter setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_
ST (standby)
signal selection
(: Standard, : Always ON,
_: Interlocked with F/R terminal
(
1) Standard
2) Always-ON
The inverter is always on standby regardless of the status of the terminal ST. The terminal ST
can be assigned to another function. In this mode, the motor slows down from the set frequency
speed to a stop in the predetermined deceleration time.
3) Interlocked with terminal F (forward)/R (reverse)
F-CC
6.2.2 Priority selection (both F-CC, R-CC are ON)
I(_ Priority selection (both F-CC, R-CC is ON)
Parameter setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_ Priority selection (both F-CC, R-CC are ON) (:Reverse:Stop
(
Function
This parameter is used to set the function of the standby signal (ST).
1) Normal setting (Standby if ST and CC are connected (ON), gate OFF if they are disconnected
(OFF) (coast stop)
2) Always ON
3) Interlocked with F/R (Forward/reverse run if F/R and CC are connected, coast stop if they are
disconnected)
F-CC
ON
OFF
Breaking the connection of the
operation frequency terminal
(F/R) causes the motor to coast
to a stop. (Free-run stop)
The inverter is shipped with terminals
ST and CC shorted with a bar. Remove
the shorting bar when using these
terminals.
Coast stop
Motor speed
Function
This parameter is used to select the operation to which priority is given when F-CC and R-
CC are closed simultaneously.
1) Reverse run 2) Slowdown stop
F-CC
ST-CC
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
Motor speed
Use this setting if a standby
terminal is needed
The inverter is shipped with
terminals ST and CC shorted
with a bar. Remove the
shorting bar when using
these terminals.
Coast stop
ST-CC OFF
F-4
[I(_=((reverse)]
[I(_=(Stop)]
6.2.3 Assigning priority to the terminal board in panel operation mode
I(( Priority setting of input terminal
Parameter setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(( Priority setting of input terminal (: Disabled,: Enabled (
(: Disabled (Terminal board has no priority)
Priority is given always to commands (operation commands) entered from the control
panel. To give priority to commands from the terminal board, it is necessary to switch
from control panel operation to terminal board operation by sending signals through the
terminal board.
The motor runs in reverse direction if F-CC and R-CC
are closed simultaneously.
Forward
Reverse
F-CC
R-CC
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
The motor slows down to a stop if F-CC and R-CC are
closed simultaneously.
Output frequency[Hz]
Reference frequency
[s]
Function
This parameter is used to give priority to certain external commands entered from the
terminal board in control panel operation mode, for example, when jogging the motor by
giving signals externally.
Command from the control panel
((I(_=)
Internal command
The mode switching terminals are
used to switch to terminal board o
peration mode. (Refer to G-4)
Output frequency [Hz]
Forward
Reverse
F-CC
R-CC
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
Reference frequency
[s]
Reference frequency
Command from the terminal board
F-5
[: terminal board has priority (Enabled)]
Priority is given to commands entered from the terminal board even in control panel operation
mode.
Priority command from terminal board (Operation command)
Jog run input terminal function 18/19
Injection braking input terminal function 22/23(*1)
Forced jog run(forward) input terminal function 50/51(*1)
Forced jog run(reverse) input terminal function 52/53(*1)
(*1)These settings are invalid when the control panel stop pattern parameter I_ is set at .
An example of switching to jog run in control panel operation mode
[Incase that terminals S4 and CC are assigned to jog run]
Assign the control terminal S4 (default: 16 (preset-speed #4)) to jog run.
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I( Input terminal selection #8 (S4) ( __ ((Jog run)
Command from the control panel
((I(_=)
Internal command
A
B
A: No command from the terminal board.
A: Command from the terminal board.
ST-CC
S4-CC
(Jog run)
Output frequency[Hz]
Forward
Forward
Reference
Panel key
Command from the terminal board
F-6
[When terminalsS3, S4 and CC are assigned to forced jog forward/reverse]
Assign the control terminal S4 (default: 16 (preset-speed # 4)) to jog run.
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I Input terminal selection #7(S3) ( __
_(
(Forced JOG forward rotation)
I( Input terminal selection #8(S4) ( __
__
(Forced JOG reverse rotation)
6.2.4 Binary/BCD signal selection(Expansion TB option unit)
I( Binary/BCD signal selection(Expansion TB option unit)
For details, refer to the instruction manual for the optional device.
ST-CC
4-CC
Forced jog(R)
Output frequency [Hz]
Forward
Reverse
Forward
Reference
Panel key
S3-CC
Forced jog(F)
F-7
6.3 Selection of terminal functions
6.3.1 Keeping an input terminal function always active (ON)
I( Always active function selection
Parameter setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I( Always active function selection ( __ (
The selected function is kept always active regardless of the type of logic (positive or negative) in the
table of function settings in 7.2.1.
6.3.2 Changing input terminal functions
I Input terminal selection #1 (F) I( Input terminal selection #6 (S2)
I_ Input terminal selection #2 (R) I Input terminal selection #7 (S3)
I_ Input terminal selection #3 (ST) I( Input terminal selection #8 (S4)
IH Input terminal selection #4 (RES) I_ I_( Input terminal selection #9 #16
I_ Input terminal selection #5 (S1)
Refer to 7.2.1 for details.
6.3.3 Signal on completion of acceleration/deceleration (OUT 2)
I_ Output terminal selection #2 (OUT2)
Setting of output terminal
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I_
Output terminal
selection #2 (OUT2)
( _
(: Acceleration/deceleration
completion(a-contact)
or
: Acceleration/deceleration
completion(b-contact)
Note) OUT1 for putting out a signal, select the parameter I_(.
Function
This parameter is used to select a function to be kept always active (ON) from among the
input terminal functions. (One function can be selected)
Function
If this parameter is so set, a signal is put out on completion of acceleration/deceleration.
Open collector output terminal OUT1 or OUT2 (24 Vdc - max. 50 mA)
Output frequency [Hz]
[s]
ON
OFF
Acc. Completed(a-contact)
Acc. Completed(b-contact)
ON
OFF
Reference
I(_
(Speed reach detection band)
( )
F-8
6.3.4 Changing output terminal functions
I_( Output terminal selection #1 (OUT1)
I_ Output terminal selection #2 (OUT2)
I__ Output terminal selection #3 (FL)
I__ I_( Output terminal selection #4 #7
Refer to 7.2.2 for details.
6.3.5 Response times of input/output terminals
IH( Input terminal #1 response time (F)
IH Input terminal #2 response time (R)
IH_ Input terminal #3 response time (ST)
IH_ Input terminal #4 response time (RES)
IHH Input terminal #5 #8 response time (S1 S4)
IH_ Input terminal #9 #16 response time
I_( I_( Output terminal #1 #7 delay time
I(( I(( Output terminal #1 #7 holding time
Refer to 7.2.3 for details.
F-9
6.4 Basic parameters #2
6.4.1 Switching among V/f characteristics #1, #2, #3 and #4 from input terminal
I( Base frequency #2 I( Manual torque boost #3
I Base frequency voltage #2 I Motor overload protection level #3
I_ Manual torque boost #2 I( Base frequency #4
I_ Motor overload protection level #2 I_ Base frequency voltage #4
IH Base frequency #3 I(( Manual torque boost #4
I_ Base frequency voltage #3 I( Motor overload protection level #4
Setting of switching terminals
The V/f #1, V/f #2, V/f #3 and V/f #4 switching function is not yet assigned to any terminal.
Therefore, it is necessary to assign them to unused terminals.
Ex.) Assigning the V/f switching #1 function to S1 and the V/f switching #2 function to S2.
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I_ Input terminal selection #5(S1) ( __ _(: (V/f switching #1)
I( Input terminal selection #6(S2) ( __ _(: (V/f switching #2)
Function
These parameters is useful for - for example - when 4 motors are connected to a
single inverter and thus they need to be switched from time to time to operate or
there is a need to change V/f characteristics (#1 to #4).
1) Switching with input terminal
2) Switching by parameter settings => Refer to 6.29.6.
Note) The setting of the parameter Pj (V/f control mode selection) is valid only when V/f #1 is
selected. If V/f #2, V/f #3 or V/f #4 is selected, V/f control is performed in constant torque mode.
Do not switch motors when the parameter Pj (Motor control mode selection) is set at 7, 8 or 9.
For parameters selected when changing V/f characteristics (1 to 4), refer to table on the next
page.
S1V/f switching #1
S2V/f switching #2
CC
F-10
S1(V/f switching #1)
-CC
S2(V/f switching #2)
-CC
V/f Parameters selected
OFF OFF #1
Base frequency #1 _j
Base frequency voltage #1 I_((
Manual torque boost _j
Motor overload protection level #1 I(((
Acceleration time #1 H((
Deceleration time #1 _((
Acceleration/deceleration pattern #1 I_(_
Power running torque limit #1 IHH
Regenerative torque limit #1 IHH_
ON OFF #2
Base frequency #2 I(
Base frequency voltage #2 I
Manual torque boost #2 I_
Motor overload protection level #2 I_
Acceleration time #2 I_((
Deceleration time #2 I_(
Acceleration/deceleration pattern #2 I_(_
Power running torque limit #2 IHHH
Regenerative torque limit #2 IHH_
OFF ON #3
Base frequency #3 IH
Base frequency voltage #3 I_
Manual torque boost #3 I(
Motor overload protection level #3 I
Acceleration time #3 I_(
Deceleration time #3 I_
Acceleration/deceleration pattern #3 I__
Power running torque limit #3 IHH(
Regenerative torque limit #3 IHH
ON ON #4
Base frequency #4 I(
Base frequency voltage #4 I_
Manual torque boost #4 I((
Motor overload protection level #4 I(
Acceleration time #4 I_H
Deceleration time #4 I__
Acceleration/deceleration pattern #4 I_(
Power running torque limit #4 IHH(
Regenerative torque limit #4 IHH_
Select V/f #1 when using the sensor-less vector control and the V/f 5-point setting.
Selecting V/f #2, #3 or #4 disables the vector control but enables the V/f constant control.
In addition, if the torque limit switching function and the acceleration/deceleration
switching function are assigned to input terminals, their settings are valid.
Note) With the control panel or communication, the following parameters can be set individually:
V/f switching (I_()
Acceleration/deceleration switching(I_(H)
Torque limit switching(I__)
These functions are active only in control panel operation mode.
6.5 V/f 5-point setting
I_( V/f 5-point setting VF1 frequency I_( V/f 5-point setting VF4 frequency
I_ V/f 5-point setting VF1 voltage I_ V/f 5-point setting VF4 voltage
I__ V/f 5-point setting VF2 frequency I_( V/f 5-point setting VF5 frequency
I__ V/f 5-point setting VF2 voltage I__ V/f 5-point setting VF5 voltage
I_H V/f 5-point setting VF3 frequency
I__ V/f 5-point setting VF3 voltage
Refer to 5.10.7 for details.
F-11
6.6 Speed/torque command gain and bias
6.6.1 Using two types of frequency (speed) commands
II(_ Speed setting mode selection
I_(( Reference priority selection
I_( Speed setting mode selection #2
I_(( II(_I_( switching frequency
1) One frequency (speed) reference
Reference priority selection I_((=((Default setting)
Priority is given to the reference set with II(_.
2) Switching with input terminal (I_(H=H)
Reference can be switched if the frequency priority switching function is assigned to a terminal.
II(_ has priority Frequency priority switching terminal OFF
I_( has priority Frequency priority switching terminal ON
Ex.) When the frequency priority switching function is assigned to terminal S4.
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I( Input terminal selection #8(S4) ( __
(H(Frequency reference
priority switching)
Reference priority
OFF II(_ has priority
ON I_( has priority
Function
These parameters switch two types of frequency
Switching by parameter setting
Automatic switching by means of switching frequencies
Switching with input terminal
II(_ Frequency(speed) reference
II(_
I_(
Frequency reference
A
B
S4
C C
F-12
3) Automatic switching by means of switching frequencies (I_((_)
A: If the frequency set with II(_ is higher than that set with I_((
Priority is given to the command set with II(_.
B: If the frequency set with II(_ is equal to or lower than that set with I_((
Priority is given to the command set with I_(.
4) Automatic switching by means of switching frequencies(I_((=_).
A: If the frequency set with I_( is higher than that set with I_((
Priority is given to the reference set with I_(.
B: If the frequency set with I_( is equal to or lower than that set with I_((
Priority is given to the reference set with II(_.
A
B
Frequency reference
I_((
Priority is given to
the command set
with II(_.
Priority is given to
the command set
with I_(.
Frequency reference
I_((
Priority is given to
the command set
with I_(.
Priority is given to
the command set
with II(_.
I_(
II(_
I_(
II(_
Command selected with II(_
Command selected with I_(
Frequency reference
F-13
Parameter setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
II(_ Speed setting mode selection
:VI(voltage input)/II(current input)
_:RR(volume/voltage input)
_:RX(voltage input)
H:RX2(voltage input)(optional)
_:Operating panel input
(:Binary/BCD input (optional)
:Common serial communication option
(:Serial communication RS485
_:Communication add-on cassette
option
(:Up/down frequency
:Pulse input #1 (optional)
_
I_(( Reference priority selection
(:II(_
:I_(
_:II(_has priority
_:I_(has priority
H:II(_/I_(switching
(input terminal function 104)
(
I_( Speed setting mode selection #2 Same as II(_
I_(( II(_/I_( switching frequency (. IH
.(
6.6.2 Setting frequency command characteristics
I_( VI/II reference point #1 I___ RX2 reference point #1
I_(_ VI/II reference point #1 frequency I___ RX2 reference point #1 frequency
I_(_ VI/II reference point #2 I__H RX2 reference point #2
I_(H VI/II reference point #2 frequency I___ RX2 reference point #2 frequency
I_( RR reference point #1 I__( BIN reference point #1
I_ RR reference point #1 frequency I___ BIN reference point #1 frequency
I__ RR reference point #2 I__( BIN reference point #2
I__ RR reference point #2 frequency I__ BIN reference point #2 frequency
I_( RX reference point #1 I__H Pulse reference point #1
I_ RX reference point #1 frequency I___ Pulse reference point #1 frequency
I_( RX reference point #2 I__( Pulse reference point #2
I__ RX reference point #2 frequency I__ Pulse reference point #2 frequency
Refer to 7.3 for details.
6.6.3 Setting torque reference characteristics
I_( VI/II reference point #1 I___ RX2 reference point #1
I_(_ VI/II reference point #2 I__H RX2 reference point #2
I_(_ VI/II reference point #1 rate I__( RX2 reference point #1 rate
I_(( VI/II reference point #2 rate I__ RX2 reference point #2 rate
I_( RR reference point #1 I__( BIN reference point #1
I__ RR reference point #2 I__( BIN reference point #2
I_H RR reference point #1 rate I___ BIN reference point #1 rate
I__ RR reference point #2 rate I___ BIN reference point #2 rate
I_( RX reference point #1
I_( RX reference point #2
I__( RX reference point #1 rate
I__ RX reference point #2 rate
Refer to 6.21 for details.
F-14
6.7 Operation frequency
6.7.1 Start-up frequency and End frequency
I_H( Start-up frequency
I_H_ Stop frequency
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_H( Start-up frequency (.( (.( [Hz] (.
I_H_ Stop frequency (.( _(.( [Hz] (.(
Note) Set these parameters so that the start-up frequency I_H( is higher than the stop frequency I__H.
If the I_H(-set frequency is lower than the I_H_-set frequency, the reference frequency
must be higher than the I_H_-set frequency to start the motor.
6.7.2 Operating by means of reference signals
I_H Run frequency
I_H_ Run frequency hysteresis
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_H Run frequency (.( IH (.(
I_H_ Run frequency hysteresis (.( _(.( [Hz] (.(
6.7.3 0Hz dead band frequency
I_HH 0Hz dead band frequency
Function
The frequency set with the parameter I_H( is put out immediately.
These parameters are used if the acceleration/deceleration time causes a delay in the response of
the starting torque. It is advisable to set these frequencies between 0.5 and 2 Hz (at a maximum
of 5 Hz). This setting reduces the slippage of motor below the rated value to prevent over-current.
If 0 speed torque is needed(pt = (,_), set I_H(, I_H_ at (.(.
At startup: frequency set with I_H( is put out immediately.
At stop: The output frequency drops to 0 Hz immediately by the frequency set with I_H_.
Function
The start and stop of the motor can be controlled simply by giving frequency setting signals.
Start-up frequency I_H(
Stop frequency I_H_
Output frequency [Hz]
[s]
The motor starts to accelerate when the
frequency setting signal reaches point B, while
it starts to decelerate and stop when the
frequency setting signal falls below point A.
0 A B 100 Frequency reference [%]
I_H I_H_
I_H
I_H I_H_
IH
Output frequency [Hz]
Function
In order to fixe the motor axis by the control with a sensor, you may set frequency
reference as 0[Hz] by the analog input etc.. But it may be set to 0[Hz] neither
by the drift nor offset. In such a case, this function sets frequency instructions to
0[Hz] certainly. When frequency reference is smaller than I_HH-set value,
frequency reference is set to 0[Hz].
F-15
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_HH 0Hz dead band frequency (.( _.( [Hz] (.(
notes 1) This function is invalid to preset-speed operation.
notes 2) It is effective as frequency instructions to the
frequency reference chosen by the priority
processing by II(_, I_(, communication, etc.
notes 3) The addition and multiplication of the override
function is carried out to the frequency in which
this function operated.
6.8 DC injection braking
6.8.1 DC injection braking
I__( DC injection braking start frequency
I__ DC injection braking current
I___ DC injection braking time
I___ Forward/reverse DC braking priority control
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__( DC injection braking start frequency (.( _(.( [Hz] (.(
I__ DC injection braking current (.( ((.( [%] _(.(
I___ DC injection braking time (.( (.( [s] .(
I___ Forward/reverse DC braking priority control (: OFF, : ON (
Note) The sensitivity of the inverter's overload protective function increases during D.C. braking. To avoid
tripping, the inverter may automatically adjust the D.C. braking rate.
<D.C. braking start conditions>
The forward/reverse DC braking priority control function I___ recognizes certain conditions as
stop commands from the inverter, and is activated when the output frequency goes down below
the DC injection braking start frequency set with I__(. In this case, the conditions under which
DC injection braking starts include not only the issue of a start or stop command from the control
panel or an external input device, but also a fall in the reference frequency below the value set with
I_H_ (stop frequency setting) or a fall in the output frequency below the operation stop
frequency.
Function
These parameters apply a direct current to the motor to obtain large braking torque.
These parameters are used to set the direct current to be applied to the motor, the
braking time and the braking start frequency.
[s]
DC injection braking
start frequency I__(
DC injection braking current
I__
DC injection braking time I___
Output frequency [Hz] DC injection braking
Operating signalF-CC
ON
OFF
Output current [A]
Reference
Display of _j blinks
Frequency after 0Hz
dead band operation
carried out.
I_HH
0 [Hz]
Frequency reference
F-16
[D.C. braking under normal conditions]
(Forward/reverse DC braking priority control I___=([OFF])
If I__( and I_H_ > reference frequency : DC injection braking
If I__( > reference frequency > I_H_ : Operation at command frequencies,
If I__( and I_H_ > reference frequency : DC injection braking
If an operation command is entered during D.C. braking : D.C. braking is discontinued to restart the
operation.
[Priority to DC injection braking during forward/reverse operation]
(Forward/reverse run D.C. braking priority control I___ = (ON))
During normal forward/reverse run(I___()
Not recognized as a stop command, so that DC injection braking is not active.
If a reverse run (or forward) command is entered during forward run (or reverse)
(I___)DC injection braking starts when the frequency set with I__( exceeds the
reference frequency during deceleration.
If an operation command is entered during D.C. brakingpriority is given to D.C. braking.
6.8.2 Motor shaft fixing control
I__H Motor shaft fixing control
Function
This function is useful for preventing the motor shaft from rotating freely or for
preheating the motor.
ON
OFF
time []
: DC injection braking
I__(
I___ Output frequency [Hz]
Operating signal (F-CC)
Reference frequency
0
Set frequency
I_H_
I__(
I___ I___
I__(
I___
Output frequency [Hz]
signal (F-CC)
ON
OFF
Reference frequency
Set frequency
I_H_
I__(
: DC injection braking
I___ I___
signal (R-CC)
ON
OFF
I___
I___( I___
time []
F-17
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__H Motor shaft fixing control (: Disabled, : Enabled (
If the motor shaft fixing control parameter I__H is set at , DC braking continue at half a
braking rate of that set with I__ to retain the motor after it has come to a full stop by DC
braking. To terminate the motor shaft fixing control, cut off the standby signal (ST signal).
Note 1) Almost the same motor shaft fixing control can be exercised when DC injection braking is controlled
by means of external signals.
Note 2) If the motor shaft fixing control parameter I__H is set at (enabled) when the output frequency
is below the DC injection braking start frequency I__( and terminals ST-CC are closed (ON), the
DC injection braking function is activated and the motor shaft fixing control continues regardless of
the setting of the D.C. braking time parameter I___.
However, when a general-purpose motor is operated, if the D.C. braking rate I__ is set above
60% and the D.C. braking time I___ is set at a certain value, the overload protective function
may be activated by the electronic thermal protective function.
In addition, the inverter may automatically control the D.C. braking rate to avoid tripping.
Note 3) If the motor shaft is set free because of a power failure, the brake shaft fixing control is
discontinued. Also, if the inverter trips when the motor shaft fixing function is active, the fixing
control is discontinued, whether or not it automatically recovers from tripping by its retry function.
6.8.3 Zero-speed stop mode selection
I___ Zero-speed stop mode selection
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I___ Zero-speed stop mode selection
(: Standard(DC injection braking)
: 0 Hz command
(
I__( DC injection braking start frequency (.( _(.( [Hz] (.(
I___ DC injection braking time (.( (.( [s] .(
Note.1) This function doesn't operate when I__( = (.(.
Note.2) If this function is set up, motor shaft fixing control(I__H)cannot be used.
Note.3) This function doesn't operate at the time of a torque control and position control.
Note.4) This function doesn't operate except the time of the vector control (Pj= (, _) with a
sensor. In order to use this function, the option board for PG feedback is required. In
other than the vector control (Pj= (, _) with a sensor, the usual DC injection braking
operates.
Note.5) Since the reference frequency that will suspend the motor abruptly from the state of high
[s]
I__(
Output frequency [Hz]
LED display _j lights
Operating signal (F-CC)
ON
OFF
Output current [A]
0
0
Setting frequency
Stand-by signal (ST-CC)
ON
OFF
I__
2
_j( lights
Function
This function controls motor in the zero-speed state at the time of a stop. If this
function is set up, 0Hz reference will be put out instead of DC braking at the time
of a stop, and a motor will be controlled in the setting time stop state. The monitor
display serves as _j during this control operation. This function operates only at
the time of vector control (Pj= (, _) with a sensor.
Refer to the direct-current braking (6.8.1) for conditions of operation. The portion of
DC injection braking is served as operation which set frequency reference to 0Hz.
F-18
rotation if I__( is set up highly, please be careful. A trip may occur according to load
conditions.
Note.6) Setting of this function will influence following DC injection brakings.
1. DC injection braking by terminal command (the input terminal functions 22 and 23)
2. DC injection braking by command via communication
3. DC injection braking when I_((Jog stop control) is set at _.
4. DC injection braking when I((_(Emergency stop mode selection) is set at _ or _.
6.9 Jog run
I_(( Jog run frequency
I_( Jog stop control
Jog run is operational when the terminals S4(assigned to Jog)-CC are active.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(( Jog run frequency (.( _(.( [Hz] (.(
I_( Jog stop control
(: Deceleration stop, : Coast stop,
_: DC injection braking stop
(
<Example of jog run>
Forward jog run when S4-CC (Jog terminal) is ON, and F-CC are ON (connected)
Reverse jog run when S4-CC (Jog terminal) is ON, and R-CC are ON (connected)
( Forward run (or reverse) if a frequency reference is given when F-CC are ON (or R-CC are ON) )
The terminals S4 and CC assigned to jog run are enabled when the operation frequency is lower than
the jog frequency, and they are disabled if not. To switch to jog run during normal operation, set the
forced jog run parameter (input terminal function selection) at 50 or 51 (inversion), and 52 or 53
(inversion).
Jog run is operational when the jog run terminals S4-CC is active (ON).
Priority is given to jog run even when an operation command is entered during jog run.
In control panel operation mode, setting the parameter I(( (input terminal priority selection) at
makes it possible to perform jog run, using the Run and Stop keys.
Even when I_( is set at ( or , an emergency DC injection braking stop can be used (I((_ is
set at _ or _).
If F-CC and R-CC are ON simultaneously when I(_ (Priority selection) is set at ( (reverse run),
operation modes switches as follows:
Forward jog run -> slowdown stop (jog frequency -> 0 [Hz]) -> reverse jog run.
[Setting of jog terminals S4-CC]
Assign the control terminal S4 to jog run (default setting:16 (preset-speed #4).
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I( Input terminal selection #8 (S4) ( __ ((Jog run)
Note) During jog run, Low-speed signal may be output but not RCH signal, and PID control is disabled.
Function
The jog run parameters are used to jog the motor. When a jog run signal is given, the jog
run frequency is put out immediately irrespective of the predetermined acceleration time.
ST-CC
F-CC
R-CC
S4-CC
Output frequency [Hz]
Forward
Reverse
Forward
Forward
0
Setting frequency
Setting frequency
F-19
6.10 Jump frequency - Jumping resonant frequencies
I_( Jump frequency #1
I_ Jump frequency band #1
I__ Jump frequency #2
I__ Jump frequency band #2
I_H Jump frequency #3
I__ Jump frequency band #3
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_( Jump frequency #1 (.( IH (.(
I_ Jump frequency band #1 (.( _(.( (.(
I__ Jump frequency #2 (.( IH (.(
I__ Jump frequency band #2 (.( _(.( (.(
I_H Jump frequency #3 (.( IH (.(
I__ Jump frequency band #3 (.( _(.( (.(
If the upper limit frequency ((j) is within a jump frequency range,
it is limited to the lowest frequency in the jump frequency range.
If the lower limit frequency (jj) is within a jump frequency range,
it is limited to the highest frequency in the jump frequency range.
Do not overlap the upper limit freqency ((j) and the lower limit
frequency (jj) within a jump frequency range. If they overlap, it
is operated lowest jump frequency.
Do not overlap two or more jump frequency ranges,or it cannot
be operated within normal range.
The operation frequency is not jumped during acceleration
or deceleration.
6.11 Preset-speed #8 15
I_( I__H Preset-speed #8 #15
Refer to 5.14 for details.
Function
These parameters are used to jump resonant frequencies to avoid resonance with the
natural frequency of the mechanical equipment operated. In jump mode, the motor
exhibits hysteresis with respect to the jump frequency.
Jump frequency band #3
I__
Jump frequency band #2
I__
Jump frequency band #1
(I_)
Jump frequency #1(I_()
Jump frequency #3(I_H)
Jump frequency #2(I__)
Output frequency [Hz]
Setting frequency
(j
jj
Jump frequency
band #2
Jump frequency
band #1
F-20
6.12 PWM carrier frequency
I_(( PWM carrier frequency
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(( PWM carrier frequency
(._ _.(((.(, _.() [kHz](*1)
[Upper limits differ by applicable motor
capacity. Refer to the table below.]
Model
dependent
(*1)Setting the PWM carrier frequency larger than the default value, reduction of rated current is
needed. For details, refer to figure and table below.
PWM carrier freq. [kHz] Voltage
class [V]
Applicable motor
capacity [kW] Default setting Upper limit
Rated current
at upper limit [%]
Max value, no rated current
reduction is needed [kHz]
18.5 12 15 No need of rated current reduction
22 12 15 90 12
30 12 15 93 12
37 8 15 No need of rated current reduction
45 8 15 80 8
55 2.2 8 85 3
200
7590110 2.2 5 No need of rated current reduction
18.5 12 15 No need of rated current reduction
22 12 15 90 12
30 12 15 89 12
37 8 15 70 8
45 8 15 80 11
55 8 15 65 8
75 2.2 8 70 4
90 2.2 5 75 2.2
110 220 2.2 5 80 2.2
280 2.2 5 75 2.2
400
315 2.2 5 70 2.2
Note1) In vector control mode, set the carrier frequency to 2.2 [kHz] or over. Operation may
become unstable if the carrier frequency is lower than 2.2 [kHz].
Note2) In the case that the operation frequency is more than 130Hz,carrier frequency is limited
to less than 10kHz automatically.
Note3) Set the carrier frequency to 2.2kHz when sine wave filter (LFL,LFC)is used at output
side of inverter. Filter can be damaged by fire in the case of other than 2.2kHz
6.13 Trip-less enhancement
6.13.1 Auto-restart (restart during free-run (coast))
I_( Auto-restart I_H Auto-restart mode
I__ Auto-restart adjustment #1 I__ Auto-restart adjustment #3
I__ Auto-restart adjustment #2
Warning
Mandatory
Do not get near the motor or the machine.
The motor and the machine unexpectedly restart after recovery from a momentary power
failure, which might cause injury to persons.
Stick caution labels to the inverter, the motor and the machine, to prevent accidents due
to an unexpected restart of them after recovery from a momentary power failure.
Function
1) The sound tone of acoustic noise can be changed by adjusting the PWM carrier frequency. This
adjustment is effective in preventing the motor from resonating with its load(machine) or its fan cover.
2) Decreasing the carrier frequency is also effective in reducing electromagnetic.
Note) Decreasing the carrier frequency reduces electromagnetic noise but increases acoustic noise.
PWM carrier frequency [kHz]
Rated current [%]
100
Default setting Upper limit
F-21
Step 1: Set the control method of Auto-restart
1) Restart after a momentary power failure
I_(=: This function is performed when the inverter recovers from a momentary power
failure after under-voltage of the main circuit and the control circuit).
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting Setting value
I_(
Auto restart
(Motor speed search)
(: Disabled
: Enabled(at power failure)
_: Enabled(at ST ON/OFF)
_: Enabled( + _)
( or _
* This function is performed in retry mode regardless of the setting of this parameter.
* The function (I_(=,_,_) is activated when the reset of trip or the control power is turned on.
* The function (I_(=,_) is activated when a voltage is detected in the main circuit.
2) Restart of coasting motor (Motor speed search function)
I_(=_: This function is performed when ST-CC are OFF and then connected again.
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting Setting value
I_(
Auto restart
(Motor speed search)
(: Disabled
: Enabled(at power failure)
_: Enabled(at ST ON/OFF)
_: Enabled( + _)
( _ or _
To restart the inverter in control panel operation mode, press the RUN key after a power failure.
When I_(((Number of PG input phases) is set at (single phase) in PG feedback vector control mode (Pj= (),
the inverter may trip ((_: speed error) if the direction of rotation of the motor does not agree with.
Step 2: Set the mode of Auto-restart
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_H
Auto-restart mode
(When Pj is set at
( or _, set this
parameter at (.)
(: Speed search #1 (*1),(*2),(*3)
: Restart at coasted frequency #1 (*3)
_: Restart at coasted frequency #2 (*3)
_: Speed search #2 (*2),(*3)
H: Special method
Model
dependent
(*1),(*2),(*3): Refer to inside of box in the next page.
: This setting is for special usage. Do not set at this.
Function
Auto-restart detect the rotating speed and direction of rotation of the motor during coasting
or momentary power failure, to ensure that the motor restarts smoothly (Motor speed
search function). With this parameter, you can also switch from commercial power
operation to inverter operation without stopping the motor.
When this function is being performed, rjr_ is displayed.
Motor speed
F-CC
ON
OFF
ST-CC
ON
OFF
Input voltage
Motor speed
F-CC
ON
OFF
F-22
[Adjustment value]
(
VF-P7 searches the motor speed and restarts. It detects the motor speed also at
the time of a power supply injection. This method needs setting of motor constant
parameters. Activation of zero speed motor needs waiting times.
It starts from the frequency, when coast started in instant electric power failure, ST
terminal OFF, etc... Usual starting is performed at the time of a power supply
injection and after P(II(Control circuit insufficient voltage) detection, at the time
of a trip reset.
_
It starts from the frequency, when coast started in instant electric power failure, ST
terminal OFF, etc. It starts on setting frequency (speed reference frequency) at the
time of a power supply injection and after P(II(Control circuit insufficient voltage)
detection, at the time of a trip reset.
At the case where inverter-commercial change sequence is performed, and the case
where the motor is always rotating at the time of starting, selecting this method and
setting frequency that corresponds motor speed make it smooth operation.
_
This setting is used for the models 37kW or more. Do not set it as I_H=_ for
other models. If it is set as I_H=_ from a model 30kW or less, since the
rotational frequency of a motor is normally undetectable, there is a possibility that
trips, such as an over-current, overload, and an over-voltage, may occur.
The rotational speed and the rotation direction of a motor are searched It searches
also at the time of a power supply injection. The time taken to detect the rotational
speed of a motor becomes short as compared with the speed search #1.
Use at factory default setting (18.5~30(37)kW:I_H=( 37(45)~315kW:I_H=_).
The setting I_H=,_ is for short time starting without speed searching to save
waiting times(*1). It may give the machine load of torque momentarily so use it
carefully
Caution!
By using retry function I_(_ together, auto restart function can be actuated at the time of
tripping.
Adaptation for elevator applications
The load may go down in the waiting time after operation start signal is inputted until it starts.
When you apply an inverter to an elevator, make the setting as I_(=(. And do not use
the retry function.
In the case the auto restart function does not work
When a trip occur at the time of auto restart, or auto restart function does not work well,
please adjust parameters referring to step 3.
(*1)Case I_H(
For the sake of motor speed detection after the power restoration, there are following waiting
times(longest time) at time of auto restart.
When the auto restart function is selected, the this function is actuated also at time of
activation of motor and at the first operation after the reset of tripping. The operation will
restart after the waiting time passes.
Before using the auto restart function, be sure to confirm the setting value of the motor
constant parameters;IH(_ IH(H, IH( IH_.
If the wrong setting value is used, motor speed cannot be searched and tripping accident
such as over-current, overload, over-voltage, etc. can occur.
In the case of the combination with a motor smaller two or more frames than inverter rated
capacity, this function may be unable to detect the rotational speed of the motor.
You cannot use a smaller capacity motor for check of operation etc., please be careful.
Even when the auto restart function is selected, motor speed may not be detected if the
frequency is more than 60[Hz]. In this case, tripping accident such as over-current, overload,
over-voltage, etc. can occur.
If the motor is idle state and motor-load is light, the motor may rotate a little. Be careful.
Speed search #1
Restart at coasted frequency #1
Restart at coasted frequency #2
Speed search #2
Type of inverter waiting times (longest time) [s]
VFP7-2185P 2300P4185P 4370P About 4
F-23
Step 3: Set the property of Auto-restart
1) Case I_H=(
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__ Auto-restart adjustment #1 (._( _._( Model dependent
I__ Auto-restart adjustment #2 (._( _._( Model dependent
Example of setting) In the case adjustment value is .(, set at . ._ and check the property.
Notice that in this case, waiting time for the restart grows to 110 120[%]. If it cannot be adjusted at
setting I__, I__, reset the range of IH(_ (motor constant #2)at 20~30% lower.
2) Case I_H= _
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__
Auto-restart
adjustment #3
(: Fast(0.5[s])(with a small inertia application)
: Normal(1.0[s])
_ (: 1.5 4.5[s]
_: Slow(5.0[s])
Model
dependent
This parameter adjusts the rising time of motor torque at time of restarting. Adjust this parameter to
inertia moment of the load.
6.13.2 Regenerative power ride-through control / Deceleration stop
I_(_ Regenerative power ride-through control / Deceleration stop
I_( Ride-through time / Deceleration time
[When power is shut off]
[When power fails momentarily]
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(_
Regenerative power ride-through
control / Deceleration stop
(: OFF
: ON (Regenerative
power ride-through control)
_: ON (Deceleration stop)
(
I_( Ride-through time / Deceleration time (.( __(.( [s]
_.(
Note) Even if these functions are used, a motor may free run according to load conditions. In this case,
please use the auto restart function together.
Note) These functions do not operate at the time of torque control or position control.
Note) Usual slowdown time comes at the time of notes I_(_= _ and I_(=(.(.
The time for which the motor keeps running
varies with the inertial of the machine operated
and the loading conditions. So, conduct a test
to determine the time before using this function.
Using this function in conjunction with the retry
function enables the inverter to restart without
making a fault stop.
The power ride-through control (I_(_ = ) is
exercised for about 100 [ms]. (A inverter which
Applicable Motor capacity is 22kW or less is
able to continue to control the motor a few
seconds.)
Motor speed
Less than 100[ms] [I_(_]
Input voltage
Function
1) Regenerative power ride-through control
When instant electric power failure occurs during operation, this function makes
operation continue using the regeneration energy from a motor.
2)Deceleration stop
When instant electric power failure occurs during operation, this function stops the
motor quickly compulsorily. A forcible stop is carried out in I_((Deceleration
time) using the regeneration energy from the motor. (Deceleration time changes with
control.) After a compulsive stop, it maintains a stop state until operation instruction
is once turned off.
Motor speed
About 100[ms]
[I_(_]
Input voltage
free run time
F-24
6.13.3 Retry function
I_(_ Retry selection
Warning
Mandatory
Do not get near the alarm-stopped motor and machine.
When the inverter is in retry mode, the alarm-stopped motor and machine unexpectedly
restart when the predetermined time has passed, and thus might cause you to get an injury.
Stick caution labels to the inverter, the motor and the machine, to prevent accidents
due to an unexpected restart of them because of the retry function.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(_ Retry selection 0: Disabled, ( times
(
Causes of tripping and retry process
Cause of tripping Retry process Canceling conditions
Momentary
power failure
Over-current
Over-voltage
Overload
a maximum of 10 consecutive retries
1st retry : about 1 [s] after tripping
2nd retry: about 2 [s] after tripping
3rd retry : about 3 [s] after tripping
Power
supply
/
MCCB
External braking resistor
(optional)
Inverter
F-26
b) When using a braking resistor without thermal fuse
(*1) Connection when using an MCCB with a top coil instead of an MC.
(*2) A step-down transformer is required for 400V models but not for 200V models.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I_(H
Dynamic braking
mode selection
(: Disabled
: Enabled with over load detection
I_(( PBR resistor .( ((( [] Any value(*3)
I_(_ PBR resistor capacity (.( ((( [kW] Any value(*3)
(When the standard internal braking resistor option is not used, be sure to set the parameters F308
and F309 properly for overload protection.)
(*3) I_(_ is for overload protection of our optional PBR and PBR3 type. Please consider the
protection at external thermal for DGP type.
A thermal relay (THR) must be connected as the last resort for fire prevention in case a failure
occurs in the overload and over-current protective functions provided for the inverter to protect the
braking resistor. Select and connect a thermal relay (THR) with a capacity (watt) commensurate
with that of the braking resistor used.
- Caution -
In the above circuit, the MC in the main circuit is turned off if an inverter's protective function is
activated, and consequently no trip message is displayed. The inverter recovers from a trip if it is
turned off. So, check the trip history record after turning off the inverter and then on again. (Refer
to 8.1.)
To prevent a trip condition from being cleared by turning off the power and then on again,
change the setting of the inverter trip retention selection parameter F602. (Refer to 6.25.3)
Control power unit option22kW or less
In a circuit where a control power supply
is connected to RO and SO, when the
MC in the main circuit is turned off when
a trip is occurred, trip data is saved so
that trip messages can be displayed (FL
output also is retained.) For optional
control power supply units, refer to 9.4.
When using a custom braking resistor, be sure to select a braking resistor with a resistance larger
than the minimum admissible resistance. Refer to 4 on the next page for the minimum admissible
resistance.
IM
Motor
Power
supply
Power
supply
THR
Surge killer
Forward/stop
Reverse/stop
If no power supply is provided
for the control circuit
Inverter
22kW or less
Option
F-27
3) Selection of braking resistor option and braking unit
input
voltage
[V]
_j
0
Output
voltage
Output frequency
Input voltage
[V]
_j
high
low
0
Output frequency
Output
voltage
I_((
Rated voltage
input
voltage
F-30
6.14 Drooping control
I__( Drooping gain
I__ Speed at a drooping gain 0%
I___ Speed at the drooping gain I__(
I___ Drooping insensitive torque band
I__H Output filter for drooping
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__( Drooping gain ( (( [%]
(
I__ Speed at a drooping gain 0[%] ( __(.( [Hz]
((.(
I___ Speed at the drooping gain I__( ( __(.( [Hz]
((.(
I___ Drooping insensitive torque band ( (( [%]
(
I__H Output filter for drooping (. _((.( [rad/s]
((.(
When torque larger than the dead band torque is applied, the frequency is decreased (during power
running) or increased (during regenerative braking).
Drooping takes effect within the frequency range above the frequency set with I__.
In the frequency range between I__ and I___, the drooping rate varies with the torque.
The change in the frequency during drooping can be calculated as described below.
a) Gain by internal torque reference (Gain 1)
If internal torque reference [%]0
Gain1 internal torque reference dead band I___ / 100
Grain 1 needs to be set at 0 or a positive number.
If internal torque reference [%]0
Gain1 internal torque referencedead band I___ / 100
Grain 1 needs to be set at 0 or a negative number.
b) Gain by frequency after acceleration (Gain 2)
If I__ I___
Frequency after accelerationFrequency 1 set with I__
Gain2 0
Frequency after accelerationFrequency 2 set with I___
Gain2 Drooping gain I__( / 100
Function
When operating a single load with more than one inverter and one motor, these parameters distribute
the load to the inverters. These parameters can adjust the frequency range, the insensitive torque band
and gains.
Frequency
Drooping
gain
I__(
I__(
I__
I__
I___
I___
Dead band
Internal torque reference
Drooping
gain
Dead band
F-31
If frequency 1 I__ frequency after accelerationfrequency 2 I___
Drooping gain I__( (freq. after acceleration freq.1 I__ )
100 ( freq.2 I___ freq.1 I__ )
If I__ I___
Iffrequency after acceleration frequency 1 I__
Gain2 0
Iffrequency after acceleration frequency 1 I__
Gain2 Drooping gain I__( / 100
c) Drooping speed
Drooping speed = base frequency _j
Note
Gain1Gain2
Note) For this calculation, assume the base frequency to be 100 Hz if it is higher than 100 [Hz].
6.15 Function for crane/hoist
I__( Light-load high-speed operation
I__ Light-load high-speed operation switching lower limit frequency
I___ Light-load high-speed operation load waiting time
I___ Light-load high-speed operation load detection time
I__H Light-load high-speed operation heavy load detection time
I___ Switching load torque current during forward run
I__( Heavy load torque during acceleration in forward direction
I__ Heavy load torque during fixed speed in forward direction
I__( Switching load torque current during reverse run
I___ Heavy load torque during acceleration in reverse direction
I_H( Heavy load torque during fixed speed in reverse direction
I_H Automatic light-load high-speed operation frequency
6.16 Commercial power/inverter switching
I__H Output signal selection of commercial power/inverter switching
I___ Commercial power/inverter switching frequency
I__( Inverter side switching waiting time
I__ Commercial power side switching waiting time
I__( Commercial power switching frequency holding time
Gain2
Function
The function switches between the commercial power and the inverter operation witho
ut stopping the motor in case of tripping or by sending a signal, and also to transmit
switching signals to an external sequence (MC, etc).
F-32
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__H
Output signal selection of
commercial power/inverter
switching
(: OFF
: Automatic switching in case of trip
_: Commercial power switching frequency setting
enabled
_: Both ( + _)
(
I___
Commercial power/inverter
switching frequency
( IH [Hz]
((.(
I__(
Inverter side switching
waiting time
[Model dependent] (.( [s]
Model
dependent
I__
Commercial power side
switching waiting time
(._ (.(( [s]
(.(_
I__(
Commercial power switching
frequency holding time
(. (.( [s]
_.(
(*1)The trips which is followed by automatic switching are trips other than ((j, (I, (I_
and (.
[Timing chart]
Commercial power switching signal S3-CC ONCommercial power operation
Commercial power switching signal S3-CC OFFInverter operation
Note) If ST-CC is opened,switching cannot be operated normally
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I__H
Output signal selection of
commercial power/inverter switching
( _ _ or _
I___
Commercial power/inverter switching
frequency
( IH [Hz]
Power source frequency, etc.
I__(
Inverter side switching waiting time
[Model dependent]
(.( [s]
Model dependent
I__
Commercial power side switching
waiting time
(._ (.(( [s]
(.(_
I__(
Commercial power switching
frequency holding time
(. (.( [s]
_.(
I
Input terminal selection #7 (S3) ( __
(_: (Commercial power
/inverter switching)
I_(
Output terminal selection #1 (OUT1) ( _
H(: (Commercial power
/inverter switching output #1)
I_
Output terminal selection #2 (OUT2) ( _
H(: (Commercial power
/inverter switching output #2)
Caution!
Before switching to the commercial power, make sure that, when the motor takes power directly from
the commercial power, it rotates in the forward direction as defined for operation by the inverter.
Do not set the Reverse-run prohibition parameter I_ at _ or _ that forward run may be
prohibited. These settings make it impossible to switch the inverter to the forward run position,
and thus to switch from the inverter to the commercial power.
Frequency Reference
Commercial power/inverter
switching frequency I___
MC output for inverter operation
Commercial power/inv. Switching
output(P24-OUT1)
MC output for commercial
power operation
Commercial power/inv.
switching output(P24-OUT2)
Commercial power switching
signal (S 3 -C C )
O N
Commercial power side switching
waiting time I__
Inverter side switching
waiting time I__(
Detecting time
Commercial power switching
freq. holding time I__(
O N
ON
ON
ON
ST (standby) signal
(S T -C C )
F-33
6.17 PID control
I_(( Signal selection of PID control
I_( Delay filter
I_(_ Proportional (P) gain
I_(_ Integral (I) gain
I_(H PID deviation upper limit
I_(_ PID deviation lower limit
I_(( Differential (D) gain
6.18 Speed feedback/positioning control
I_( Number of PG input pulses
I_(( Number of PG input phases
I_(_ PG disconnection detection
I_( Electronic gear
I_ Position loop gain
I__ Positioning completion range
I__ Frequency limit at position control
I_H Current control proportional gain
I__ Current control integral gain
I_( Speed loop proportional gain
I_ Speed loop integral gain
I_( Motor counter data selection
I__ Speed loop parameter ratio
6.19 Preset speed operation mode
I_(( I___ Preset speed operation modes
Refer to 5.14 for details.
F-34
6.20 Setting motor constants
IH(( Auto-tuning IH( Motor constant #5
IH( Slip frequency gain IH Number of motor poles
IH(_ Motor constant #1 IH_ Rated capacity of motor
IH(_ Motor constant #2 IH_ Motor type
IH(H Motor constant #3 IHH Auto-tuning prohibition
IH(_ Motor constant #4
Warning
Mandatory
Do not set the motor parameter #3(Exciting inductance: IH(H) less than or equal to a half
of default value. If the motor parameter #3(Exciting inductance: IH(H) was set at a
extremely small value, stall prevention function would work and output frequency would rise.
When using the vector control or the automatic torque boost, it is necessary to set (tuning) motor
constants. You can set motor constants by any of the following three methods.
After setting by one of three methods, drive the motor.
1) Using the automatic V/f mode setting (H(_) to make the setting of the motor control mode
selection (Pj) and the auto-tuning parameter (IH(() at a time
2) Setting the motor control mode (Pj) and the auto-tuning parameter (IH(() individually
3) Setting the motor control mode (Pj) and setting motor constants manually
<Note> If tuning error ((j) occurs when the power is turned on, set the motor type IH_ at H (others).
[Selection 1: Setting by the automatic V/f mode]
This is the simplest way of setting. With the automatic control parameter, you can set the
automatic torque boost, the sensorless vector control and the auto-tuning parameter at a time.
Automatic V/f mode H(_ (Automatic torque boost + auto-tuning)
Automatic V/f mode H(__ (Sensorless vector control + auto-tuning)
Automatic V/f mode H(__ (Automatic energy-saving + auto-tuning)
Refer to 5.2 for details of this setting.
[Selection 2: Individually setting the vector control and the auto-tuning]
This is the method for individually setting the vector control and the auto-tuning. You need to
set the control mode with the motor control mode selection Pj, before auto-tuning setting.
Set the auto-tuning IH((_ (Automatic tuning execution)
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
IH(( Auto-tuning
(: Without auto-tuning (internal table)
: Motor constant initialization (( after execution)
_: Automatic tuning execution (( after execution)
(
Here are the setting conditions for each type of motor.
Applicable motor
Type motor poles Capacity
Auto-tuning
Same capacity as the inverter Not required
4P
Different capacity from the inverter
Same capacity as the inverter
Toshiba
standard motor
others
Different capacity from the inverter
Other motors
Required
F-35
[Setting procedure]
Key operated LED display Operation
(.(
The running frequency is displayed. (Make this setting when
the motor is out of operation.) (If the monitor display momde
setting parameter I( is set at ([Running frequency])
H(
Press the Monitor key to call up the first basic parameter
H((automatic acceleration/deceleration).
IH
Select the parameter IH(extended parameters of H((
to H__) by pressing or key.
IH(( Press the Enter key to activate the parameter IH((.
( Press the Enter key to display the parameter setting.
_
Change the parameter setting to _ (Automatic tuning
execution) by pressing key.
_IH((
Press the Enter key to save the change. Then, IH(( and
the set value are displayed alternately.
[Selection 3: Individually setting the vector control and the manual tuning]
If a tuning error (j occurs during auto tuning or the sensorless vector control charact
eristic needs to be improved, you may set motor constants individually.
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
IH Number of motor poles _,H,(,(,(,_,H,( H
IH_ Rated capacity of motor (. [Model dependent] [kW] Model dependent
IH_ Motor type
(: Toshiba standard motor #1 (*1)
: Toshiba VF motor
_: Toshiba V3 motor
_: Toshiba standard motor #2 (*1)
H: Other motors
(
(*1) Toshiba standard motor 1: World-energy series of totally-enclosed fan-cooled motors
Toshiba standard motor 2: World-energy 21 series of totally-enclosed fan-cooled motors
MON
ENT
ENT
ENT
Cautions in setting the auto-tuning parameter
Connect the motor before auto-tuning. Do not proceed to auto-tuning before the motor comes
to a full stop. If the auto-tuning function is activated immediately after stopping motor, it
sometimes fails to work normally because of a residual voltage.
A voltage is applied to the motor during auto-tuning, though it is too low to rotate the motor.
Usually, auto-tuning terminates in some dozens of seconds. If an error occurs, however, the
inverter trips (display (j) and no motor constant is set.
The auto-tuning is incapable of tuning special motors, such as high-speed or a high slip
motors. When using such a motor, set motor constants manually as described in Section 3.
If auto-tuning causes the inverter to trip easily because of an over-voltage (P or an over-
current ((, change the setting of the load inertia moment parameter IH(_. Refer to the
Step 2 for the adjustment of IH(_.
When the inverter is used for a crane/hoist, equip it with a protective device (mechanical
brake, etc.) with a sufficient capacity. Failure to do so might cause the crane/hoist to loose
speed and fall because the motor cannot produce sufficiently large torque during auto-tuning.
When operating a motor in vector control mode, set the carrier frequency at 2.2 kHz
or over. Failure to do so might cause the vector control to be unstable.
If auto-tuning cannot be made successfully or an auto-tuning error ((j) occurs, set
the motor constants manually as described in Selection 3 below.
Notes about vector control: Refer to 5.10 9)
F-36
Step 1: Setting the rating of the motor
Pole number: IH
Motor type: IH_
Set IH(( (Auto-tuning)
Setting
Other than 4P motor
4P motor
H: Other motors
(: Toshiba standard motor #1
: Toshiba VF motor
_: Toshiba V3 motor
_: Toshiba standard motor #2
Manual tuning
Set motor constant
parameters manually.
Caution
In case "(j" (Tuning error) is
displayed at the time of power
injection, set IH_ at H.
Set IH(( (Auto-tuning)
Setting_
Refer to Step 2 in the
next page
End of tuning
Set IH_ (Motor type)
Setting(
Set IH(( (Auto-tuning)
Setting
Check the motor for use. (pole number, rating capacity, type)
Number of motor poles: IH
Adjustment range_,H,(,(,(,_,H,(
Rated capacity of motor: IH_
Adjustment range( _(( [kW]
Motor type: IH_
Adjustment range
(: Toshiba standard motor
#1
: Toshiba VF motor
_: Toshiba V3 motor
_: Toshiba standard motor
#2
End of auto-tuning
No trip
Give a Run command
Panel displays "Hj"
Run (at least 30Hz)
In case desirable
property doesn't
appear.
Set IH_ (Rated capacity)
Setting(. _(( [kW]
Set IH_ (Motor type)
Setting( _
Set IH_ (Motor type)
SettingH
Is motor
capacity same with
Inverter capacity?
Set IH_ (Rated capacity)
Setting(. _(( [kW]
Yes
No
Tuning error ((j)
appeared
Set IH (Number of motor poles)
Setting_,H,(,(,(,_,H,(
F-37
Step 2: Setting motor constants
This section describes how to set motor constants. Select the items to be improved and change
the related motor constants.
Slip frequency gain IH(
This parameter is to adjust the slippage of the motor.
Setting this parameter at a larger number can reduce the slippage of the motor. However,
setting it at an excessively large number may result in hunting, etc., and thus cause an
unstable operation.
Motor constant #1 IH(_ (Primary resistance) (Motor test reports may be useful.)
This parameter is to adjust the primary resistance of the motor.
Setting this parameter at a larger value can prevent the drop of the motor torque in low speed
ranges due to a voltage drop. However, setting it at an excessively large number may result in
large current in low speed range and appearance of overload trip, etc..
Motor constant #2 IH(_ (Secondary resistance)
This parameter is to adjust the secondary resistance of the motor.
The larger the set value, the more the slippage of the motor can be compensated.
Motor constant #3 IH(H (Exciting inductance)
(A motor test record can be used for this setting.)
This parameter is to adjust the exciting inductance of the motor.
The larger the set value, the more the no-load current can be decreased.
Motor constant #4 IH(_ (Load inertia moment)
This parameter is to adjust the transient response of the motor.
Setting this parameter at a larger value can reduce overshooting on completion of
acceleration or deceleration. Set this parameter at a value, which matches to the effective
moment of inertial.
Motor constant #5 IH( (Leak inductance) (Motor test reports may be useful.)
This parameter is to adjust the leakage inductance of the motor.
The larger the set value, the larger torque the motor can be produced in high-speed ranges.
F-38
Examples of setting auto-tuning
Here are setting examples for each of the selections 1, 2 and 3 described in 6.20.
a) Combination with a Toshiba standard motor (4P motor with the same capacity as the inverter)
I nverter : VFP7 - 2185P
Mot or : 18. 5[ kW] , 4P, 60[Hz]
[Selection 1]
Set the automatic V/f mode setting parameter H(_ at _.
[Selection 2]
Set the motor control mode selection parameter Pj at _ (Sensorless vector control).
[Selection 3]
Set the motor control mode selection parameter Pj at _ (Sensorless vector control).
b) Combination with a Toshiba VF motor (4P motor with the same capacity as the inverter)
I nverter : VFP7 - 2185P
Mot or : 18. 5[ kW] , 4P, 60[Hz]
[Selection 1]
Set the automatic V/f mode setting parameter H(_ at _.
[Selection 2]
1) Set the motor control mode selection parameter Pj at _ (Sensorless vector control).
2) Set the auto-tuning IH(( at _.
[Selection 3]
1) Set the motor control mode selection parameter Pj at 3 (vector control).
2) Change the motor type IHH from ( (Toshiba standard motor) to (Toshiba VF motor).
(When using a Toshiba VF motor with a rated capacity smaller than that of the inverter,
properly change the setting of the motor rated capacity parameter IH_.)
3) Set the auto-tuning IH(( at .
c) Combination with a standard motor other than the above Toshiba motors
I nverter : VFP7 - 2185P
Mot or : 15[ kW] , 4P, 50[ Hz]
[Selection 1]
Set the automatic V/f mode setting parameter H(_ at _.
[Selection 2]
1) Set the motor control mode selection Pj at _ (Sensorless vector control).
2) Set the auto-tuning parameter IH(( at _.
[Selection 3]
1) Set the motor control mode selection Pj at _ (Sensorless vector control).
2) Change the motor rated capacity parameter IH_ from (._( to _.((
3) Set the motor type parameter IH_ at ( (default setting)
4) Set IH(( at
5) Set IH(( at _
6) Set the motor pole number parameter IH at _
7) Change the motor parameters (IH( IH(_, IH(), if needed.
F-39
6.21 Torque control
Refer to 5.11 for switch to Torque control
6.21.1 Torque reference
IH_( Torque reference selection
IH__ Torque reference mode selection
I_(_ VI/II reference point #1 rate I_( VI/II reference point #1
I_(( VI/II reference point #2 rate I_(_ VI/II reference point #2
I_H RR reference point #1 rate I_( RR reference point #1
I__ RR reference point #2 rate I__ RR reference point #2
I__( RX reference point #1 rate I_( RX reference point #1
I__ RX reference point #2 rate I_( RX reference point #2
I___ BIN reference point #1 rate I__( BIN reference point #1
I___ BIN reference point #2 rate I__( BIN reference point #2
I__ Panel torque reference (Refer to 6.29.11 for details.)
Current signal 4 20mAdcII terminal
[Default setting]
Torque produced: 0% at 4mAdc and 100%
at 20mAdc.
Voltage signal 0 10VdcRR terminal
[Default setting]
Torque produced: 0% at 0Vdc and 100%
at 10Vdc.
Function
Selecting a mode of torque command in torque control mode.
The relationship between the torque
command and the motor torque can be
changed. The I_( and I_(_ settings
0 and 100% correspond to currents of 0
and 20mAdc, respectively.
The relationship between the torque
command and the motor torque can be
changed. The I_( and I__ settings
0 and 100% correspond to voltages of 0
and 10Vdc, respectively.
[Arbitrary setting]
Motor torque [%]
0
I_( I_(_
I_(_
I_((
[Arbitrary setting]
Motor torque [%]
I_(H 20% I_(_ 100%
I_(_ 0
I_(( 100
4mA 20mA
Motor torque [%]
0
I_( I__
I_H
I__
Motor torque [%]
I_( 0% I__ 100%
I_H 0
I__ 100
0V 10V
F-40
3) Voltage signal 0 10VdcRX terminal
[Default setting] [Arbitrary setting]
Motor torque: -100% at -10Vdc, 0% at 0Vdc and
+100% at +10Vdc.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
IH_(
Torque
reference
selection
: VI/II
_: RR
_: RX
H: RX2(option)
_: Panel input
(: Binary / BCD input(option)
: Common serial communication option(FA30)
(: Serial communication RS485(FA32)
_: Communication add-on cassette option(FA33)
_
Note1) Selecting 5 (Panel input) activates the control panel torque reference I__.
Note2) Use 2 phases input type sensor when torque control is operated by vector control
with a sensor.
Note3) For sensorless vector control, forward power running reverse regeneration
and forward regeneration reverse power running cannot be operated.
Use vector control with a sensor (2 phases) for these uses.
6.21.2 Torque reference filter
IH_ Torque reference filter
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
IH_ Torque reference filter
(.( __._,
_((.((without filter)
_((.(
(without filter)
Motor torque [%]
Torque reference
0V
I__ +100
-100
+10V
-10V
I_( 0% I_( 100%
I__( 0
The relationship between the torque
command and the motor torque can be
changed. The I_( and I_( settings
0 and +/-20% correspond to voltages of
0 and +/-10Vdc, respectively.
Function
When a motor drives a load with large inertia or when the gain cannot be increased
because the machine is not rigid enough to allow it, the motor sometimes vibrates. In
such cases, this filter is used to reduce the vibration. The smaller the set value, the
larger effect the filter can exert. (The response of the motor decreases to reduce the
vibration.)
Motor torque [%]
Torque reference
0V
I__
-10V
I_(
I__(
+10V
I_(
F-41
6.21.3 Speed limits in torque control mode
IH__ Forward speed limit input selection
IH_( Forward speed limit input level
IH_ Reverse speed limit input selection
IH_( Reverse speed limit input level
IH_( Speed limit (torque=0) reference
IH_ Speed limit (torque=0) value
IH__ Speed limit (torque=0) band
IH__ Speed limit (torque=0) recovery time
Setting with the control panel
[Setting of forward speed limit level]
IH__(Forward speed limit input selection) :_(Parameter IH_()
IH_((Forward speed limit input level) :Set a desirable torque limit level.
[Setting of reverse speed limit level]
IH_(Reverse speed limit input selection) :_(Parameter IH_()
IH_((Reverse speed limit input level) :Set a desirable torque limit level.
Function
The function is to limit the rise in the output frequency of the inverter due to a drop
of the load torque during operation in torque control mode. These functions are usef
ul for protecting a machine.
Torque
command
Reference torque set by a potentiometer
Load
torque
The speed varies according with the load torque.
Speed
Coast stop
Forward speed
limit level
Reverse speed
limit level
The speed varies according with the load torque.
Speed
Coast stop
Forward speed limit
input level IH_(
Reverse speed limit
input level IH_(
F-42
Setting by means of external signals
The speed limits can be changed arbitrarily by setting external signals.
[Selection of external signals]
voltage signals
current signals
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
IH__
Forward speed limit input
selection
(: Invalid
: VI (voltage input)/II (current input)
_: RR (volume/voltage input)
_: RX(voltage input)
H: RX2(voltage input)(optional)
_: IH_( enabled
(
IH_( Forward speed limit input level (.( (j [Hz]
((.(
IH_
Reverse speed limit input
selection
(: Disabled
: VI (voltage input)/II (current input)
_: RR (volume/voltage input)
_: RX(voltage input)
H: RX2 (voltage input)(optional)
_: IH_( enabled
(
IH_( Reverse speed limit input level (.( (j [Hz]
((.(
[Speed limit with the center value specified by a reference]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
IH_( Speed limit (torque=0) reference
(:Invalid, :VI/II, _:RR, _:RX,
H:RX2(optional), _: IH_
(
IH_ Speed limit (torque=0) value (.( IH [Hz]
(.(
IH__ Speed limit (torque=0) band (.( IH [Hz]
(.(
IH__ Speed limit (torque=0) recovery time (.(( _._(
(._(
6.21.4 Torque bias and load sharing gain
IH__ Selection of synchronized torque bias input
IH__ Selection of tension torque bias input
IH_H Load sharing gain input selection
1) Selection of synchronized torque bias input
RR-CC 0 10V_
RX-CC 0 10V_
VI-CC 0 10V
II-CC 4(0) 20mA
Speed control
Synchronized torque bias
Torque control
IH__, IH_
Speed ref.
Speed limit
Speed limit center reference value
Speed limit range
Maximum-speed limit
F-43
[Parameter]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
IH__
Selection of synchronized
torque bias input
(: Invalid
: VI/II
_: RR
_: RX
H: RX2 (optional)
_: Panel input (I_( is enabled)
(: Binary / BCD input (optional)
: Common serial communication option(FA30)
(: Serial communication RS485(FA32)
_: Communication add-on cassette option(FA33)
(
I_(
Panel torque revised bias
input
__( __( [%]
(
For a crane/hoist, an elevator
application, as lifted up and down at
controlled speeds, its direction of
rotation is frequently reversed. In such
cases, the load can be started
smoothly, by adding load torque into
the torque reference equivalent to the
additional torque, when starting
acceleration after releasing the brake.
[Selection of external signals]
voltage signals
current signals
2) Selection of tension torque bias input and load sharing gain input
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
IH__
Selection of
tension torque bias input
(: Invalid
: VI/II
_: RR
_: RX
H: RX2 (optional)
_: Panel input (I_ is enabled)
(: Binary / BCD input (optional)
: Common serial communication option(FA30)
(: Serial communication RS485(FA32)
_: Communication add-on cassette option(FA33)
(
I_ Panel tension torque bias ( __( [%] (
IH_H
Load sharing gain input
selection
(: Invalid
: VI/II
_: RR
_: RX
H: RX2 (optional)
_: Panel input (I_( is enabled)
(: Binary / BCD input (optional)
: Common serial communication option(FA30)
(: Serial communication RS485(FA32)
_: Communication add-on cassette option(FA33)
(
I_( Panel load sharing gain ( __( [%] ((
RR-CC 0 10V (0 250%) _
RX-CC 0 10V (0 250%) _
VI-CC 0 10V (0 250%)
II-CC 4(0) 20mA (0 250%)
IH__
Additional torque
(fixed direction)
Reverse
Forward
Tension torque bias
as additional torque
Torque reference
H((
Effective acceleration time
Max. freq. IH
Setting freq.
I_(( H(( %
I_( H(( %
[s]
[Hz]
0
Max. freq. IH
Setting freq.
H((
Effective acceleration time
[Hz]
[s]
Base freq.
F-50
6.23.2 Switching of acceleration/deceleration #1, 2, 3 and 4
I_(( Acceleration time #2 I_H Acceleration time #4
I_( Deceleration time #2 I__ Deceleration time #4
I_(H Acc/dec #1,2,3,4 selection I_ Acc/dec switching frequency #3
I_(_ Acc/dec switching frequency #1 I_(_ Acc/dec pattern #2
I_( Acceleration time #3 I__ Acc/dec pattern #3
I_ Deceleration time #3 I_( Acc/dec pattern #4
I__ Acc/dec switching frequency #2
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(( Acceleration time #2 (.(I_(() (((( [s] Model dependent
I_( Deceleration time #2 (.(I_(() (((( [s] Model dependent
I_(H
Acc/dec time #1, 2, 3, 4
selection
: Acc/dec #1, _: Acc/dec #2,
_: Acc/dec #3, H: Acc/dec #4
I_( Acceleration time #3 (.(I_(() (((( [s] Model dependent
I_ Deceleration time #3 (.(I_(() (((( [s] Model dependent
I_H Acceleration time #4 (.(I_(() (((( [s] Model dependent
I__ Deceleration time #4 (.(I_(() (((( [s] Model dependent
) Selection with parameters
I_(H
I_(H_
I_(H_
I_(HH
The acceleration/deceleration time selection parameter has been set at 1 by default. The setting
of I_(H can be changed from to _, _ or H. (The setting of I_(H is valid when (I(_ is
set at 1.)
Function
With these parameters, you can set 4 acceleration and deceleration times. Acceleration
and deceleration times can be selected or switched by any of the following 3 method:
1) Selection with parameters
2) Switching by means of frequencies
3) Switching with terminals
time [s]
Output frequency [Hz]
_(( H((
IH
I_(( I_(
I_( I_
I_H I__
F-51
2) Switching by frequencies - Automatically switching acc/dec times at certain frequencies
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(_ Acceleration/deceleration switching frequency #1 (.( IH [Hz] (.(
I__ Acceleration/deceleration switching frequency #2 (.( IH [Hz] (.(
I_ Acceleration/deceleration switching frequency #3 (.( IH [Hz] (.(
Note) Regardless of the sequence of input of frequencies, acc/dec times are switched from #1 to #2 at the
lowest frequency, from #2 to #3 at the middle frequency and from #3 to #4 at the highest frequency.
(For example, if the frequency set with I_(_ is higher than that set with I__, the acc/dec time #1
is selected in the frequency range below the I__-set frequency, while the acc/dec time #2 is
selected in the frequency range of the I__-set frequency to the I_(_-set frequency.)
Acceleration at the gradient of H(( Deceleration at the gradient of I__
Acceleration at the gradient of I_(( Deceleration at the gradient of I_
Acceleration at the gradient of I_( Deceleration at the gradient of I_(
Acceleration at the gradient of I_H Deceleration at the gradient of _((
3) Switching with terminals - Switching acc/dec times by means of external terminals
Acceleration at the gradient of H(( Deceleration at the gradient of I__
Acceleration at the gradient of I_(( Deceleration at the gradient of I_
Acceleration at the gradient of I_( Deceleration at the gradient of I_(
Acceleration at the gradient of I_H Deceleration at the gradient of _((
Output freq. [Hz]
I_
I__
I_(_
time [s] 0
Setting freq.
Output frequency [Hz]
Acc/dec switching #1
Acc/dec switching #2
time [s]
0
F-52
Parameter setting
a) Operation mode: Terminal board operation
Set the operation command mode selection (I(_ at (.
b) Switching terminals: S3 and S4(Other terminals also can be settled for this purpose.)
S3Acceleration/deceleration switching #1
S4Acceleration/deceleration switching #2
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I Input terminal selection #7 (S3) ( __ _H(Acc/dec switching #1)
I( Input terminal selection #8 (S4) ( __ _((Acc/dec switching #2)
Acceleration/deceleration patterns
Acceleration and deceleration pattern can be selected individually for each of the acceleration/
deceleration times #1, 2, 3 and 4.
1) Linear acceleration/deceleration
2) S-pattern acceleration/deceleration #1
3) S-pattern acceleration/deceleration #2
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(_
Acceleration/deceleration
pattern #1
(: Linear, : S-pattern #1,
_: S-pattern #2
(
I_(_
Acceleration/deceleration
pattern #2
(: Linear, : S-pattern #1,
_: S-pattern #2
(
I__
Acceleration/deceleration
pattern #3
(: Linear, : S-pattern #1,
_: S-pattern #2
(
I_
Acceleration/deceleration
pattern #4
(: Linear, : S-pattern #1,
_: S-pattern #2
(
Refer to 6.23.1 for an explanation of the acceleration/deceleration patterns.
The settings of the S-pattern lower limit adjustment amount I_(( and the S-pattern upper
limit adjustment amount I_( are reflected in every acceleration/deceleration pattern.
6.23.3 Minimum acceleration/deceleration times
I_(( Acceleration/deceleration lower limit
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(( Acceleration/deceleration time lower limit (.( (.(( [s] (.(
Note) To set the minimum acceleration or deceleration time to less than 0.1 second, set
I(H(Decimal place number of acc/dec time) at _(0.01 second) in advance so that
the time can be displayed in units of 0.01 second.
Refer to 6.29.4 for the parameter I(H(Decimal place number of acc/dec time).
Function
This parameter sets the minimum acceleration and deceleration times.
F-53
6.24 Pattern run
I__( Pattern run selection
I__ Pattern run mode
I__( , I_H( , I__( , I_(( Cycle number of pattern group #1 to #4
I__ I__( Pattern group #1 selection #1 #8
I_H I_H( Pattern group #2 selection #1 #8
I__ I__( Pattern group #3 selection #1 #8
I_( I_(( Pattern group #4 selection #1 #8
I_( I_(H Preset-speed #1 #15 operation continuation mode
I_(_ I___ Preset-speed #1 to #15 operation time
Note) When control is exercised by the operation panel, pattern group #1 is always selected. If you
want to operate in a pattern other than pattern group #1, select pattern group #1, #2, #3 or #4 ,
using input terminal selection parameters (I I_().
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range
Default
setting
I__(
Pattern run
selection
(: Disabled, : Enabled (
I__ Pattern run mode
(: Patterned operation canceled during stop
: Patterned operation continued during stop
(
I__(
Cycle number of
pattern group #1
__H, ___:
I__
I__(
Pattern group #1
selection #1 #8
(: Skip, to _ (
I_H(
Cycle number of
pattern group #2
1 __H, ___:
I_H
I_H(
Pattern group #2
selection #1 #8
(: Skip, to _
_ _,
(
I__(
Cycle number of
pattern group #3
1 __H, ___:
I__
I__(
Pattern group #3
selection #1 #8
(: Skip, to _ (
I_((
Cycle number of
pattern group #4
1 __H, ___:
I_(
I_((
Pattern group #4
selection #1 #8
(: Skip, to _
_ _,
(
I_(
I_(H
Preset-speed
#1 #15
operation
continuation
mode
(: Operation time in second after start of operation
: Operation time in minute after start of operation
_: Operation time in second after attainment of frequency
_: Operation time in minute after attainment of frequency
H: Infinite (continued until stop command is entered)
_: Continue until next step command
(
I_(_
I___
Preset-speed
#1 #15
operation time
(((( [s]/[min]
(The unit depends on I_()
_
Forward/reverse, Acc/Dec time #1/#2, V/f control mode #1/#2 can be set with I_(( I___
(Preset-speed operation frequency #1 to #15 control modes). Refer to 5.14 for details.
Note) When the function of auto-restart is active, the time spent for speed search is added to the operation
time set for pattern operation. Consequently, the effective operation time sometimes becomes
shorter than the settled operation time.
Function
These parameters enable you to form up to 60 patterns of automatic operation by variously
combining operation frequencies, operation times and acceleration/deceleration times.
1) Start-up by control panel operation((I(_) : up to 15 patterns
2) Start-up by terminal board operation((I(_(): up to 60 patterns (15 types x 4 patterns)
F-54
Basic operating
Step Setting Parameter
1
Set the pattern run selection parameter at
(Enabled).
I__(( (Disabled),
(Enabled)
2
Change all frequencies required to preset-
speed frequencies.
_r _r(Preset-speed #1 to #7)
I_( I__H(Preset-speed #8 to #15)
I_(((Preset-speed operation mode)
I_( I___(Preset-speed #1 to #15 control
mode)
3
Set the required operation time at each of
the set operation frequencies.
I_( I_(H(Preset-speed #1 to #15
operation continuation mode)
I_(_ I_(_(Preset-speed #1 to #15
operation time)
Set the sequence of each speed
This sequence following three methods.
Select a run/stop operation from the
pattern run mode
I__((Patterned operation canceled during stop)
Pattern run is reset by stop/switching
operation before operating restarts.
(Patterned operation continued during stop)
Pattern run is started by stop/switching
operation. The system stops temporarily on
completion of every routine, then proceeds to
the next routine.
Select a pattern group, and then set the
sequence of each speed
I__((Cycle number of pattern group #1)
I__ I__((Pattern group #1 selection #1 to #8)
I_H((Cycle number of pattern group #2)
I_H I_H((Pattern group #2 selection #1 to #8)
I__((Cycle number of pattern group #3)
I__ I__((Pattern group #3 selection #1 to #8)
I_(((Cycle number of pattern group #4)
I_( I_(((Pattern group #4 selection #1 to #8)
4
According to the required parameter
group, select pattern group #1, #2, #3 or
#4 from input terminal selection I to
I_(. If you set I_( I_(H at _ at
item 3 above, select step trigger signals
from I I_(. Selecting pattern
run continuation signals makes it possible
to select a start/stop method.
I I_(
_(, __(Pattern group #
1)
H(, H(Pattern group #2)
H_, H_(Pattern group #3)
HH, H_(Pattern group #4)
H(, H(Pattern run continuation signal)
H(, H_(Pattern run trigger signal)
5
Monitor displayed during pattern run
During pattern operation, the following run information is displayed before the normal display.
Pattern run switching output (output terminal function : 36, 37)
If the pattern run switching output function is selected (activated), a signal is put out on
completion of all the predetermined patterns of operation. When there is no operation
command left to be entered or the pattern operation selection signal changes, the output
terminals are turned off(in case of a-contact).
Terminal Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
OUT1 I_(
Output terminal
selection #1
( _
_((pattern run switching output: a-contact
or
_(pattern run switching output: b-contact
Note) To put out the signals to the terminal OUT2, select the parameter I_.
Condition Display Meaning
Pattern group and pattern
P.(
(A)(B)
(A): Number or the pattern group
(B): Number of the pattern
Number of repetitions __
Means that the current pattern operation is to
be repeated (ex. 123 times).
Preset operation speed I
Frequency reference with preset-speed #1
data.
Remaining time of the
current pattern operation
__H
Set the input terminal selection I I_( at H( (or H_): pattern run trigger signal.
Notes)
Pattern operation groups should be selected by terminal input.
When the operation command mode selection is set for panel operation, pattern group #1 is always
selected.(If you need a pattern other than pattern group #1, set input terminal selection (I
I_() at _( to H_, and operate with the terminal input.)
If no signal is put out from any pattern run signal (all terminals are turned off), or after the
pattern run is completed, the system returns to the normal operation mode.
When two or more pattern group numbers are entered simultaneously, the pattern group operations
are performed in ascending order and automatically switched to one another. In this case, it may
take about 0.06 seconds to search for each pattern.
10 milliseconds after a pattern operation group selection #1, 2, 3 or 4 is activated, turn on the
operation signal (F-CC). Within 10 [ms] or less, a signal for ordinary operation may be put out.
Output frequency [Hz]
[s]
I__
F-CC
ON
OFF
0
Setting frequency
I__ (
I_( I_(H(Preset-speed #1 to #15 operation continuation mode)
= H(Infinite(continued until stop command is entered))
I_( I_(H(Preset-speed #1 to #15 operation continuation mode)
= _ (Continue until next step command)
Pattern group #1(S1-CC)
Pattern group #2(S2-CC)
Pattern group #3(S3-CC)
Pattern group #4(S4-CC)
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
select pattern group #1
select pattern group #2
select pattern group #3
select pattern group #4
<Parameter setting>
I_=_((Pattern group #1)
I(=H((Pattern group #2)
I=H_(Pattern group #3)
I(=HH(Pattern group #4)
Pattern run operation
Step trigger signal
ON
OFF
Output frequency [Hz]
[s]
0
Setting frequency
F-56
6.25 Protection functions
6.25.1 Motor over road protection level adjust / motor types
I((( Motor over road protection level #1
I((( Overload reduction start-up frequency
Refer to 5.13 for details.
6.25.2 Setting of current stall
I(( Stall prevention level
Warning
Mandatory
Do not set the stall prevention level(I(() at a extremely small value.
If the stall prevention level(I(() was set at a value that is near the motor's no
load current or less, stall prevention function would work and output frequency would
rise. In ordinary usage, do not set the stall prevention level at 30% or less.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(( Stall prevention level ( __ [%], _((: Disabled _(
[Display during the alarm ((]
When (( is displayed (when the output current is on the point of exceeding I((), the ou
tput frequency displayed changes and a "(" is displayed on the left side of the frequency.
Example of display
Note) In V/f constant control mode, the torque limits #1, #2, #3 and #4 can be used as a stall prevention.
You can make various settings by combining these functions with the V/f1, 2, 3 and 4 functions.
6.25.3 Inverter trip holding
I((_ Selection of inverter trip holding
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I((_ Selection of inverter trip holding
(: Cleared if power is turned off
: Hold even if power is turned off
(
The last 4 trip records can be held and displayed in status monitor mode.
Trip data (current, voltage, etc. at the time of a trip) can be displayed in status monit
or mode when the inverter trips, but is cleared if the power is turned off.
Function
If the output current exceeds that set with I((, the stall protective function is a
ctivated to reduce the output frequency.
Function
The function is to hold inverter's trip records. If this function is active, trip records
are retained and can be displayed even after the inverter is reset.
Inverter trip
Reset holding FL
Ready for
normal operation
Turn on power again
Fault display
FL not active
Trip again
Fault display
FL active
If the cause of tripping or that of another failure
is not yet removed.
( _(
Power source reset
Panel (terminal) reset
F-57
6.25.4 Emergency stop
I((_ Emergency stop
I((H Emergency DC injection braking control time
Note) When setting I((_ at _ or _(Emergency DC injection braking stop), you need to set also the
parameters I__(DC injection braking current) and I((H(Emergency DC injection braking
control time).
1) Emergency stop by terminal operation
Emergency stop can be performed with the a or b-contact. Assign the emergency stop function
to a terminal as described below, and select a stop mode.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I((_ Emergency stop
(: Coast stop
: Deceleration stop
_: Emergency DC injection braking stop
_: Coast stop without FL output
H: Deceleration stop without FL output
_: Emergency DC injection braking
without FL output
(
I((H
Emergency DC injection braking
control time
(.( (.( [s] (.
I__ DC injection braking current (.( ((.( [%] _(.(
(Example of assignment) Assigning the emergency stop function to the terminal S4
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I( Input terminal selection #8(S4) ( __ _((emergency stop)
Note 1) An emergency stop can be carried out from the terminal even in panel operation mode. In this case,
however, holding down the Stop key for more than 5 seconds causes the inverter trip (()
even when I((_ is set at _, H or _.
Note 2) If DC injection braking is not needed for normal stops, though I((_ is set at _ or _ (emergency
DC injection braking), then set the DC braking time I___ at (.( [s].
2) Emergency stop by panel operation
Emergency stop can be performed with the control panel, in other operation command mode.
Press twice the STOP key on the control panel.
Press the STOP key ((II starts blinking.
Press the STOP key again Emergency stop
Then, "(" is displayed, and also a fault detection signal (FL) is put out at
I((_ =(, or _, while the FL is not active if I((_ is set at 3, 4 or 5.
6.25.5 Overload reduction start-up frequency
I((( Overload reduction start-up frequency
Refer to 5.13 for details.
6.25.6 Motor's 150%-overload time limit
I(( Motor 150%-overload time limit
Refer to 5.13 for details.
Function
Emergency stop mode of can be selected. At emergency stop, a trip message ("(") is displayed.
CC
Input
CC
Input
a-contact b-contact
F-58
6.25.7 Action at low currents
I(( Low-current trip
I( Low-current detection level
I(_ Low-current detection time
I(((Disablednot trip(FL is not active)
Low-current alarm can be output by output terminal selection.
I((EnabledThe inverter trips if low-current passes during operation for
the time set with I(_ or over.(FL is active)
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(( Low-current trip (: Disabled, : Enabled (
I( Low-current detection level ( (( [%]
(
I(_ Low-current detection time ( ___ [s]
(
6.25.8 Detection of output phase failure
I(_ Detection of output short-circuit during start-up
I(H Adjustment of detection pulse for output short-circuit during start-up
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_
Detection of output short-
circuit during start-up
(: Standard
: Only one time at power injection or at
first start after reset
(
I(H
Adjustment of detection pulse
for output short-circuit during
start-up
(( [s] _(
I(_(: Standarddetecting at starting
A check is made once at the first start of operation after the power is turned on or
the inverter is reset.
I(HSet the pulse length for the detection of short circuits.
Note) Shorten the pulse length if the motor trips in error (OCL) at start-up, especially a high-speed motor.
6.25.9 Over-torque trip
I(_ Over-torque trip
I(( Over-torque detection level during power running
I( Over-torque detection level during regeneration
I(( Over-torque detection time
Function
If the current is lower than I( level and passes for a time longer than I(_, the
inverter trips. When I(( is set at (tripping disabled), it is necessary to set, with
I(_, the time elapsed before the inverter trips after the detection of a small current.
Function
If a torque current exceeding the current set with I((, I( is detected, the inverter
trips and the trip message (j is displayed.
Function
The function is to detect short circuits with inverter's output terminals.
F-59
I(_((Disabled)does not trip (FL is not active).
I(_(Enabled)The inverter trips if a torque current larger than I(((during
power running) or I((during regeneration) passes for a
time longer than the time set with I((.
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_ Over-torque trip
(: Disabled
: Enabled
(
I(( Over-torque detection level during power running ( __( [%] _(
I( Over-torque detection level during regeneration ( __( [%] _(
I(( Over-torque detection time (.( ((.( [s] (._
6.25.10 Cooling fan control mode selection
I(_( Cooling fan control mode
I(_((Automatic control of cooling fan, enabled. Operates only when the inverter is in
operation.
I(_(Automatic control of cooling fan, disabled. The cooling fan always operates
when the inverter is energized.
The cool ing fan automati call y operates whenever the ambient temperature is
high, even when the inverter is out of operation.
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_( Cooling fan control mode
(: Automatic
: Always ON
(
6.25.11 Cumulative operation time alarm
I(_ Cumulative operation time alarm setting
Panel display of (. corresponds to 10 hours. If _(.__ is displayed, the cumulative operation time
is 3855 hours.
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_
Cumulative operation time
alarm setting
(. ___._
[100h]
_.(
Output terminal setting
Ex.) Assigning the cumulative operation time alarm function to the terminal OUT2
Title Function Adjustment range Setting value
I_ Output terminal selection#2 (OUT2) ( _
_(
Function
With this parameter, you can set the condition of cooling fan so that it operates only when
the inverter requires cooling, and thus it can be used for a longer period of.
Function
This parameter is to make a setting so that the inverter puts out a signal when it
s cumulative operation time has reached the time set with this parameter.
F-60
6.25.12 Over-voltage stall protection level
I(__ Over-voltage stall protection level(high response)
I(_( Over-voltage stall protection level
Refer to 6.13.5 for details.
6.25.13 Under-voltage trip
I(_ Under-voltage trip mode
I(_( Under-voltage detection time
I(_(DisabledInverter stops, but does not trip.(FL is not active)
I(_EnabledThe inverter trips if an under-voltage passes for the time
set with I(_( or over. (FL is active)
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_ Under-voltage trip mode (: Disabled, : Enabled (
I(_( Under-voltage detection time (.(( (.(( [s] (.(_
6.25.14 UV stall level
I(__ Under-voltage stall level
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(__ Under-voltage stall level _( (( [%] _
6.25.15 System-supporting sequence (B-timer)
I(_( System-supporting sequence (B-timer)
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_( System-supporting sequence (B-timer)
(.(: Invalid
(. (.( [s]
(.(
Function
This parameter is to select the action when detecting an under-voltage. (Invalid, while the
inverter stops.) If I(_ is set at (Enabled), it is necessary to set, with I(_(, the time
elapsed before the inverter trips after the detection of an under-voltage.
Function
This parameter is used to set the operation level of the regenerative power
ride-through control and the deceleration stop. (Refer to 6.13.2)
Function
This parameter is used to set the waiting time for answer from system(Input terminal function
setting: System-supporting sequence (BA:_(,_) ). After start of operation, if no answer
is received in set time(I(_(), the inverter trips(().
F-61
6.26 Special analog input
I(_( Acceleration/deceleration base frequency adjustment
I(_ Upper-limit frequency adjustment
I(__ Acceleration time adjustment
I(__ Deceleration time adjustment
I(_H Manual torque boost adjustment
1) Acceleration/deceleration base frequency adjustment
If this parameter is so set, The signal from the terminal VI, II or RR can be used as data for the
adjustment of acceleration/deceleration time reference frequencies. This function is useful for
performing proportional operation. Frequency adjustment range: 30 to 400 Hz.
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_(
Acceleration/deceleration base
frequency adjustment
(: Invalid
: VI/II
_: RR
(
2) Upper-limit frequency adjustment
The signal from VI, II or RR can be used as the upper limit frequency.
Adjustment range: 0 (j(The frequency cannot be set above the upper-limit frequency ((j).)
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_ Upper-limit frequency adjustment
(: Invalid
: VI/II
_: RR
(
3) Acceleration time adjustment
Using reference input from VI, II or RR, acceleration time set with the parameter H((
(or acceleration time #2, #3 or #4) can be multiplied the by factors of 1.0 to 10.0 .
10% of reference input act as multiply factor of 1.0 .
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(__ Acceleration time adjustment
(: Invalid
: VI/II
_: RR
(
4) Deceleration time adjustment
Using reference input from VI, II or RR, deceleration time set with the parameter _((
(or deceleration time #2, #3 or #4) can be multiplied the by factors of 1.0 to 10.0 .
10% of reference input act as multiply factor of 1.0 .
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(__ Deceleration time adjustment
(: Invalid
: VI/II
_: RR
(
5) Manual torque boost adjustment
Using reference input from VI, II or RR, manual torque boost set with the parameter _j
(or I_, I( or I(() can be multiplied the by factors of 0.0 to 2.5 .
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_H Manual torque boost adjustment
(: Invalid
: VI/II
_: RR
(
Function
The function is to make it possible to change the fixed settings of some paramete
rs by means of external analog signals.
F-62
6.27 Over-ride
I((( Over-ride addition input selection
I(( Over-ride multiplication input selection
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(((
Over-ride
addition input
selection
[Hz]
(: Disabled
: VI(voltage input) / II(current input)
_: RR(volume / voltage input)
_: RX(voltage input)
H: RX2(voltage input)(optional)
_: Operating panel input
(: Binary/BCD input(optional)
: Common serial communication option(FA01)
(: Serial communication RS485(FA05)
_: Communication add-on cassette option(FA07)
(: Up/down frequency
: Pulse input #1(optional)
(
I((
Over-ride
multiplication
input
selection
[%]
(: Disabled
: VI(voltage input) / II(current input)
_: RR(volume / voltage input)
_: RX(voltage input)
H: RX2(voltage input)(optional)
_: I__
(
The override functions calculate output frequency by the following expression:
Output frequency 1 I((( [Hz]
1) Additive over-ride
In this mode, an externally input over-ride frequency is added to reference frequency.
[Ex1: RR(reference), VI(over-ride frequency)] [Ex2: RX(reference), VI(over-ride frequency)]
Function
These parameters are used to adjust reference frequencies by means of external
I(( [%]
100
RR input
(reference)
Output frequency [Hz]
Over-ride
(VI input)
0
10V
Over-ridden
frequency
IH
Over-ride
(VI input)
0
RR input
(reference)
10V
Over-ridden frequency
IH
( )
( )
Output frequency [Hz]
Reverse
Forward
F-63
Ex1:
I((((VI input), I((((disabled)
Output frequency = Reference + Over-ride (VI input [Hz])
Ex2:
I((((VI input), I((((disabled)
Output frequency = Reference + Over-ride(VI input [Hz])
2) Multiplicative over-ride
In this mode, each output frequency is multiplied by an externally override frequency.
[Ex1: RR(reference), VI(over-ride frequency)] [Ex2: RX(reference), VI(over-ride frequency)]
Ex1:
I(((=((Disabled), I((=(VI input), II(_=_(RR input), IH=(((, (j=(((
RR input(I_(=(, I_=((, I__=((, I__=((()
VI input(I_(=(, I_(_=(, I_(_=((, I_((=(()
Note) Setting of RR input: Refer to 7.3.1, Setting of VI input: Refer to 7.3.2
Output frequency = Reference {1 + Over-ride(VI input [%] / 100)}
Ex2:
I(((=((Disabled), I((=(VI input), II(_=_(RX input), IH=(((, (j=(((
RX input(I_(=(, I_=((, I_(=((, I__=((()
VI input(I_(=(, I_(_=(, I_(_=((, I_((=(()
Note) Setting of RX input: Refer to 7.3.1, Setting of VI input: Refer to 7.3.2
Output frequency = Reference {1 + Over-ride(VI input [%] / 100)}
Ex3:
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__
Panel over-ride multiplication
gain
(( (( [%] (
Output frequency = Reference {1 + Over-ride(I__ [%] / 100)}
Output frequency[Hz]
0
RR input
(reference)
10V
Over-ridden frequency
IH
Output frequency [Hz]
0
RR input
(reference)
10V
Over-ridden frequency
IH
( )
( )
Reverse
Forward
F-64
6.28 Meter output
6.28.1 Setting of meter outputs
I(( AM terminal meter selection
I( AM terminal meter adjustment
Refer to 5.4 for details.
6.28.2 Setting of optional meter outputs
I(_ Optional analog terminal #1 meter selection
I(_ Optional analog terminal #1 meter adjustment
I(H Optional analog terminal #2 meter selection
I(_ Optional analog terminal #2 meter adjustment
I(( Optional analog terminal #1 meter offset
I(_ Optional analog terminal #2 meter offset
I((( Optional analog terminal #2 sign selection
6.28.3 Pulse output to meters
I(( FP terminal meter selection
I( FP terminal meter adjustment
The function set with I(( is output from FP terminal.
Set a desired number of output pulses as I( with
reference to the following table. Refer to 5.4 about adjustment level.
Ex.)Output Running frequency(0 80Hz) at 0 10kHz
Setting: IH=((, I((=(, I(=(
Title Function Adjustment range Adjustment level Default setting
I((
FP terminal meter
selection
0: Running frequency
1: Frequency command
2: Current indication
3: DC voltage
4: Output voltage
5: After-compensation frequency
6: Speed feedback (real-time value)
7: Speed feedback (1 second filter)
8: Torque
9: Torque reference
10: Internal torque reference (*1)
11: Torque current
12: Exciting current
13: PID feedback value
14: Motor overload factor (OL2 data)
15: Inverter overload factor (OL1 data)
16: PBr overload factor (PBrOL data)
17: PBr load factor (pulse duty)
18: Input power
19: Output power
20: Peak output current
21: Peak DC voltage
22: Motor counter dummy PG
23: Position pulse
24: PR input
25: VI/II input
26: RX input
27: RX2 input
28: FM output
29: AM output
30: Fixed output for meter adjustment
31: Analog output for communication
32:Acc/dec torque removal
(a)
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(a)
(a)
(a)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(b)
(a)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(e)
(e)
(b)
(b)
(d)
(d)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(c)
(b)
(
I(
FP terminal meter
adjustment
.(( H_._( [kHz] _(H
Note).ON pulse width is fixed at a value that depends on the setting of I(.(about 50~70%)
The data of current, torque, etc. are limited by 200 %
Function
These parameters are used
to set the pulse output
function and the number of
pulses output from the output
terminal FP.
F-65
6.29 Control panel parameters
6.29.1 Prohibiting the change of parameter settings
I(( Prohibition of parameter setting
Setting method
(AllowedNo parameters are write-protected. (Default setting)
ProhibitedAll parameters except for I(( are write-protected.
Parameter setting
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(( Prohibition of parameter setting
(Allowed
Prohibited
(
Canceling method
I(( only is designed so that its setting can be changed anytime even when it is set at .
To prohibit all operation, including key operation, use the parameter I_((Panel operation
prohibition).
6.29.2 Changing the units of display
I( Current / voltage display mode
Example of setting
When the VFP7-2185P (rated current: 73A) is operated under the rated 100% load :
1) Display in [%] 2) Display in [A] or [V]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(
Current / voltage display
mode
(: [%]
: [A] or [V]
(
Function
This parameter is used to change the units of display of current and voltage.
Display in % <=> Display in A (ampere) or V (volt)
__((
(_.( (((
_((
Output current
: 73.0A
Input voltage
: 200V
DC voltage
: 100%
Output current
: 100%
With I(, you can convert the units pertaining to the following parameters:
Display in [A]: Current monitor
Motor overload protection level #1,#2,#3,#4 I(((, I_, I, I(
DC injection braking current I__
Stall prevention level I((
Display in [V]: Voltage monitor
V/f 5-point setting I_, I__, I__, I_, I__
Note Base frequency voltage is always displayed in voltage unit.
Function
This parameter is used to make a setting to prohibit or allow the change of parameter settings.
F-66
6.29.3 Display the motor speed and the load speed
I(_ Frequency free unit magnification
Value displayed
The LED displays the value obtained by multiplying the monitored or parameter-set frequency by
the value set with I(_.
Displayed valueMonitored frequency or frequency set with a parameter Value set with I(_
Note) If the display value is more than ____,4digit from the left and ( are displayed
alternately. (Ex. alternate display _(((( for the value _((((.)
Examples of setting
1) Display of the rotating speed of the motor
To switch from the operation frequency (default setting: 60 Hz) to the rotating speed of the 4P motor
(1800 min
-1
)
2) Display of the speed of the load
To switch from the operation frequency (default setting: 60 Hz) to the speed of the load (6 m/min-1.)
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(_ Frequency free unit magnification (.((: OFF, (.( _((.(
(
Note: This parameter is to display the value obtained by multiplying the output frequency of the
inverter by an integer. Therefore, the value calculated from the output frequency is always
displayed regardless of fluctuations of the rotating speed of the motor due to fluctuations of
the load.
6.29.4 Column number below decimal point of Frequency, Acc/dec time
I(_ Decimal place number of frequency
I(H Decimal place number of Acceleration/deceleration time
Example of setting
Title Function
Adjustment
range
Default
setting
Value displayed after
change (example)
(: 1 [Hz] ((
: 0.1 [Hz] ((.( I(_
Decimal place number of
frequency
_: 0.01 [Hz]
((.((
Function
This parameter is used to convert the monitored or parameter-set frequency into the
rotating speed of the motor or the speed of the load.
(.(
((( ((.
((.(
I(_ = ((OFF)
Function
These parameters are used to change the number of decimal places of the monitored or
parameter-set frequency, acceleration time or deceleration time displayed.
I(_ = _(.(
(((_(.( = ((()
I(_ = ((OFF) I(_ = (.
((((. = (.()
F-67
Title Function
Adjustment
range
Default
setting
Value displayed after
change (example)
(: 1 [s] (
: 0.1 [s] (.( I(H
Decimal place number of
Acceleration/deceleration
time _: 0.01 [s]
(.((
6.29.5 Changing items displayed in status monitor mode
I( Monitor display mode setting
I Status monitor #1 display mode
I_ Status monitor #2 display mode
I_ Status monitor #3 display mode
IH Status monitor #4 display mode
These parameters are used to select the item to be displayed when the power is turned on and
also to change items displayed in status monitor mode. Refer to 8.1 for details.
6.29.6 Switching basic parameters
I_( Selection of panel V/f1, 2, 3 or 4
[Parameter setting]
V/f1 is selected default setting.
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(
Selection of panel
V/f1,2,3 or 4
1: V/f1, 2: V/f2,
3: V/f3, 4: V/f4
[Parameters which can be switched with I_(]
(V/f1) _(V/f2)
Base frequency #1 _j
Base frequency voltage #1 I_((
Manual torque boost _j
Motor overload protection level #1 I(((
Base frequency #2 I(
Base frequency voltage #2 I
Manual torque boost #2 I_
Motor overload protection level #2 I_
_(V/f3) H(V/f4)
Base frequency #3 IH
Base frequency voltage #3 I_
Manual torque boost #3 I(
Motor overload protection level #3 I
Base frequency #4 I(
Base frequency voltage #4 I_
Manual torque boost #4 I((
Motor overload protection level #4 I(
: Parameter groups selected by default
Function
This parameter is used to switch V/f characteristics during operation or to drive
four motors with a single inverter.
This parameter is valid only when the inverter is in panel operation mode.
Switching by means of terminals
The V/f1, 2, 3 and 4 can also be switched by switching on and off terminals.
Refer to 6.4.1 for details.
F-68
6.29.7 Selecting a control panel stop pattern
I_ Panel stop pattern
1) Slowdown stop
The motor stops in the deceleration time set with the parameter _(((I_(, I_ or
I__).
2) Free-run stop
The output of the inverter is cut off. As a result, the motor coasts to a stop. Depending on the
load, the motor can keeps rotating for a while before coming to a complete stop.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_ Panel stop pattern
(: Deceleration stop
: Coast stop
(
6.29.8 Resetting the inverter from the control panel
I__ : Panel reset function
Resetting method
1) Press the Stop key and make sure that (jr is displayed.
2) Press the Stop key again to reset the inverter.
Note) If the inverter trips because of trouble indicated with the message (P _, (j, (j_, (jr or (H,
it may take a bit of time for the inverter to be reset.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__ Panel reset function (: Disabled, : Enabled
6.29.9 Selecting a torque limit in control panel operation mode
I__ Panel torque limit
Control panel operation: The mode of operation obtained by setting the torque command
selection parameter IH_( at _(Panel input).
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__ Panel torque limit , _, _, H
Refer to 6.22 for details of torque limit setting.
Function
This parameter is used to select the mode in which the machine is stopped by pressing the STOP
key on the control panel when the operation is started by pressing the RUN key.
Function
This parameter is used to reset the inverter by control panel operation when it trip
s because of a failure, a fault, etc.
Function
With this parameter, you can select a torque limit when torque control is exercised by the
control panel.
This parameter is valid only when the inverter is in control panel operation mode.
F-69
6.29.10 Canceling PID control in panel operation mode
I_H Panel PID control OFF
(PID control enabled
PID control is exercised if I_(( is not set at (.
PID control disabled
Open-loop control (normal control mode) is exercised instead of PID control.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_H Panel PID control OFF
(: ON
: OFF
(
Note) When I_(( is set at (, open-loop control is exercised even if this parameter is
set at ( (PID control enabled).
6.29.11 Setting a torque command in panel operation mode
I__ Panel torque reference
Panel operation: Torque command selection IH_( is set at _(Panel input).
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I__ Panel torque reference ( __( [%] (
Refer to 3.3.3 for details.
6.29.12 Drooping control in panel operation mode
I_( Panel synchronized torque bias
I_ Panel tension torque bias
I_( Panel load sharing gain
6.29.13 Override in panel operation mode
I__ Panel over-ride multiplication gain
Refer to 6.27 for details.
Function
This parameter is to switch from PID control to open-loop control (normal control
mode) when PID control is exercised by the control panel.
Note) This parameter is valid only when the inverter is in panel operation mode.
Function
This parameter is to set a torque command when torque control is exercised by the
operation panel. This parameter is valid only when the inverter is in control panel
operation mode.
F-70
6.29.14 Restricting or prohibiting key operation
I_( Panel operation prohibition
Setting
Every key operation, enabled(_ (Default setting)
Every key operation, prohibited(
Ex.) to enable monitor display operation and Panel operation(start/stop):
Monitor display operation enabled ...H
Panel operation(start/stop) enabled ...(
(H) (() _
Therefore, the number you should key in to enable these functions is _.
[Parameter setting]
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I_(
Panel operation
prohibition
(: Every key operation, inhibited
+: panel frequency setting enabled
+_: Parameter Load enabled
+H: Monitor display operation enabled
+(: Panel operation(start/stop) enabled
(+(: No function is assigned)
+__: Emergency stop operation enabled
(_: normal mode(Every key operation enabled)
(_
Note) The LED displays "I_(" immediately after I_( is set at (, but it returns to normal
standard mode after the inverter is reset or is locked to trip monitor mode if the inverter trips.
To prohibit the read or write of parameter, refer to 6.29.1.
Canceling methods
1) Temporary cancellation
Every key operation is enabled temporarily, until the power is turned off. (Turning off the power
disables every key operation again.)
In standard monitor display mode or trip monitor mode,
press the key twice while holding down the key
2) Permanent cancellation
[Canceling method in cases that parameters are not read/write-protected]
I_( is overridden permanently. Changing its setting causes the previous setting to be
overridden automatically in a mode where parameters are not read/write-protected.
[Canceling in cases that parameters are read/write-protected]
In standard monitor display mode or trip monitor mode,
press the key twice while holding down the key
and then change the setting of I_( to (_.
Note) "(_" is displayed when I_( is called. Press the and keys to make
the "(_" blink, then press the Enter key to save the setting.
Function
This parameter can prohibit the operation of control panel keys to avoid operation errors.
Note 1) The setting of this parameter take effects as soon as it is saved.
Note 2) Once saved, the setting of this parameter cannot be overridden unless the
power is turned off or the inverter is reset after trip.
ENT
ENT
F-71
6.30 Communication function (RS485/common serial)
I((( Communication rate (common serial)
I(( Parity (common serial/RS485)
I((_ Inverter number (common)
I((_ Communication time-out (common serial/RS485)
I((H Communication time-out action (common serial/RS485)
I((_ Communication waiting time (common serial)
I((( Inter-drive communication (common serial)
I(( Frequency point selection
I( Point #1 setting
I(_ Point #1 frequency
I(_ Point #2 setting
I(H Point #2 frequency
I(_( Communication rate (RS485)
I(_ RS485 wiring system
I(__ RS485 communication waiting time
I(_( Inter-drive communications (RS485)
6.30.1 Common serial optional device
With RS232C unit (optional), and RS485 unit(optional), connect inverters to a higher-order
control system (host computer) to establish a data communications network between them.
Also, you can establish a data communications link between a computer and each
inverter(RS485).
the common serial options available:
RS232C communications converter units (model: RS2001Z)
Communication cable (model: CAB0011 (1 m), CAB0013 (3 m), CAB0015 (5 m))
RS485 communication converter unit (model: RS4001Z, RS4002Z)
Communication cable (model: CAB0011 (1 m), CAB0013 (3 m), CAB0015 (5 m))
(Note) Distance between Inverter and a common serial option should not be more than 5 m apart.
Function
These parameters set up a data communications network by connecting inverters to one
another and to a host control system, and also establish a data communications link
between a computer and each inverter.
Computer link
The function is to enable data communications between a host control system (computer)
and each inverter.
Monitoring of inverter status (output frequency, current, voltage, etc.)
Command to each inverter (start command, stop command, etc.)
Load, modify, and save of inverter's parameter setting
Inter-drive communication
Designed to enables an inverter (master) to send data selected with parameters to the
other inverters (slaves) on the network. With this function, you can establish a network
to perform simplified synchronous or proportional operation (point frequency setting).
Timer function .Designed to detect broken communications cables. With this function,
you can set the inverter in such a manner that it can trip ("(rr_" is
displayed) or an alarm goes off. ("j" is displayed on the panel) if it
receives no data within the predetermined time.
Broadcast communication ... Designed to send data to more than one inverter at a time.
Inter-drive communication ...The master inverter transmit the data that was chosen with
the parameter to all the slave inverters on the same network.
Using this function, the network that performs synchronized
operation and proportion operation (point frequency setting) in
simple way can be constituted.
F-72
Setting of operation command (common serial)
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting Setting
(I(_
Operation command
mode selection
( H
((Terminal
block enabled)
_(Common serial
communication)
Note) To use inter-drive communication (I(((), (I(_ can't be set at _ for slave inverter.
Setting for speed reference (common serial)
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting Setting
II(_
Speed setting mode
selection
_(RR)
(Common serial
communication)
Communication parameters (common serial options)
With these parameters, you can set or change the data transmission speed, the parity,
inverter numbers and the communication error trip timer with the control panel or
Communication.
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(((
Communication rate(common
serial)
(: 1200 [bps]
: 2400 [bps]
_: 4800 [bps]
_: 9600 [bps]
_
I(( Parity(common serial/RS485)
(: No parity, : Even parity,
_: Odd parity
I((_ Inverter number(common) ( ___ (
I((_
Communication time-out
(common serial/RS485)
(: OFF, (( [s] (
RS485 Common serial
( No action No action
Alarm No action
_ Trip No action
_ No action Alarm
H Alarm Alarm
_ Trip Alarm
( No action Trip
Alarm Trip
I((H
Communication time-out action
(common serial/RS485)
( Trip Trip
(
I((_
Communication waiting time
(common serial)
(.((: Normal communications,
(.( _.(( [s]
(.((
I(((
Inter-drive communication
(common serial)
(: Normal communications
(slave operation)
: Master (frequency reference)
_: Master (output frequency)
_: Master (torque reference)
H: Master (output torque)
(
I(( Frequency point selection
(: Invalid
: Common serial
_: RS485
_: Communication add-on cassette
option
(
I( Point #1 setting ( (( [%] (
I(_ Point #1 frequency ( IH [Hz] (.(
I(_ Point #2 setting ( (( [%] ((
I(H Point #2 frequency ( IH [Hz] ((.(
No action: No action is taken even if a timeout occurs.
Alarm: An alarm goes off if a timeout occurs. The message "j" blinks at the left end of the
control panel.
Tripping: The inverter trips if a timeout occurs. The message "(rr_" blinks on the control panel.
Note) Changes to the parameters I(((, I((, I((( do not take effect until the power is turned off
and then on again.
F-73
6.30.2 Using the RS485 port fitted as standard
With the standard serial RS485, you can connect each inverter to a higher-order control system
(host computer) to set up a data communications network between inverters. Also, you can
establish a data communications link between a computer and each inverter.
Serial RS485 connectors should be used to connect inverters to one another.
Data transfer specification
Item Specification
Interface RS485
Transmission path
specification
Half-duplex transmission [2/4-wire, bus architecture (A terminator needs
to be attached at each end of the system.)]
Transmission distance Up to 500 m (overall length of the cable)
Number of
connectable units
Up to 32 units (including a host computer)
Up to 32
Synchronization mode Asynchronous transfer
Data transfer rate
Default setting: 9600 bps (parameter setting)
Selectable from among1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200 and 38400 bps
Transmission character
ASCII code ... JIS X 0201 8-bit (ASCII)
Binary code ... Binary code, 8-bit fixed
Stop-bit length Received by inverter: 1 bit, sent from inverter: 2 bits
Error detecting system Parity: even/ odd/ non (parameter setting), check sum
Error correction function Not provided
Response monitoring Not provided
Transmission code Sending: 11 bit, Reception: 12 bit(with parity)
Transmission waiting
time setting
Possible
Others
Action the inverter takes when an timeout occurs: tripping/alarm/no action
When alarm is selected, "j" blinks at the left end of the control panel.
When tripping is selected, "(rr_" is displayed on the control panel.
An example of the connection of inverters linked to a computer
Selective communications
When an operation frequency reference is isued by the host computer to the inverter No.
(IG)Ignore: Inverters take no action if their numbers do not agree with the number specified in the
command( they ignore data received and get ready to receive the next data.)
The host computer transmits data to inverters.
Each inverter receives data from the host computer and checks the number specified by the
computer against its number.
Only the inverter with the number that agrees with that specified by the computer decodes the
command and takes action according to it.
On completion of the action, the inverter returns the results of the action taken to the host computer,
with the inverter number added to this information.
In this case, the inverter No. 3 only operates according to the operation frequency command
given by the host computer to it across the network.
Host computer
Wiring
DataHostInverter
Return dataInverterHost
IG IG IG IG IG
.
.
Use a terminal board, etc., to divide each cable into branches.
F-74
Broadcast communications
When the host computer to inverters broadcasts an operation frequency reference.
The host computer transmits data to inverters.
Each inverter receives data from the host computer and checks the number specified by the
computer against its number.
If an asterisk () is marked in place of an inverter number, all inverters judge the data to be common
to them (broadcast message), decode the command and take action.
To avoid collision between data sets, data from the inverter with an a zero instead of an asterisk only
is sent back to the host computer.
In this case, all inverters operate, following the operation frequency command given by the host
computer across the network.
Note) Data can also be broadcast to a specific group of inverters (group broadcast communication
s) by putting a number common to each inverter in the group.(This function is usable only in
ASCII mode.)
(Ex.) If "1" is designated, data is broadcast to all inverters bearing the numbers 01, 11, 21,
31, ... 91, and data from the inverter bearing 01 only is sent back to the host.
Inter-drive communications
When inverters (slaves) operate at the same operating frequency as the master inverter to which
they are connected (No frequency point is set.)
The master inverter transmits frequency command data to its slave inverters.
The slave inverters calculate a frequency reference from the data received and save the frequency
calculated.
As a result, all slave inverters operate at the same frequency as the master inverter.
(Note) The master inverter always sends frequency command data to its slave inverters, and all slave
inverters are always waiting for frequency command data from the master inverter.
Master inverter
Wiring
DataMasterslave
.
Use a terminal board, etc., to divide each cable into branches.
Use a terminal board, etc., to divide each cable into branches.
Wiring
DataHostInverter
.
Host computer
F-75
Setting of operation command (RS485)
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting Setting
(I(_
Operation command
mode selection
( H ((Terminal block enabled) _(RS485)
Note) To use inter-drive communication (I(_(), (I(_ can't be set at _ for slave inverter.
Setting of speed reference (RS485)
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting Setting
II(_
Speed setting mode
selection
_(RR) ((RS485)
Communication parameters (standard RS485)
These parameters are used to set or change the data transmission speed, the parity, inverter
numbers and the communication error trip timer with the control panel and or a linked control.
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I(( Parity(common serial/RS485)
(: No parity, : Even parity,
_: Odd parity
I((_ Inverter number ( ___ (
I((_
Communication time-out
(common serial/RS485)
(: OFF, (( [s] (
RS485 Common serial
( No action No action
Alarm No action
_ Trip No action
_ No action Alarm
H Alarm Alarm
_ Trip Alarm
( No action Trip
Alarm Trip
I((H
Communication time-out action
(common serial/RS485)
( Trip Trip
(
I(( Frequency point selection
(: invalid
: Common serial
_: RS485
_: Communications add-on cassette
option
(
I( Point #1 setting ( (( [%] (
I(_ Point #1 frequency ( IH [Hz] (.(
I(_ Point #2 setting ( (( [%] ((
I(H Point #2 frequency ( IH [Hz] ((.(
I(_( Communication rate (RS485)
(: 1200 [bps]
: 2400 [bps]
_: 4800 [bps]
_: 9600 [bps]
H: 19200 [bps]
_: 38400 [bps]
_
I(_ RS485 communication system (: 2-line system, 1: 4-line system
I(__
RS485 communication waiting
time
(.((: Norm, (.( _.(( [s] (.((
I(_(
Inter-drive communication
(RS485)
0: Normal communications
(slave operation)
1: Master (frequency reference)
2: Master (output frequency)
3: Master (torque reference)
4: Master (output torque)
(
No action: No action is taken even if a timeout occurs.
Alarm: An alarm goes off if a timeout occurs. The message "j" blinks at the left end of the
control panel.
Tripping: The inverter trips if a timeout occurs. The message "(rr_" blinks on the control panel.
Note) Changes to the parameters I((, I(_(, I(_, I(_( do not take effect until the
power is turned off and then on again.
G-1
7. 1. External Operation
The inverter can be freely controlled externally.
Parameters must be differently set depending on the operation method. Make sure of the
operation method before setting parameters, and set parameters properly to the operationmode
according to the procedure mentioned below.
Procedure for setting parameters
Check of external signal conditions
In case of control panel operation
command input
II(__: Operation panel
input
In case of run/stop with external input
II(_: VI(voltage input) / II(current input)
_: RR(volume/voltage input)
_: RX(voltage input)
H: RX2(voltage input) (optional)
(: Binary/BCD input (optional)
: Common serial communication option
(: Serial communication RS-485
_: Communication add-on cassette option
(: Up-down frequency
: Pulse input 1 (optional)
Operation signal:
Control panel
Operation speed command:
Control panel
Refer to 5.3, Example 1).
Operation signal:
Terminal board
Operation speed command:
Control panel
Operation signal:
Control panel
Operation speed command:
Terminal board
Operation signal:
Terminal board
Operation Speed command:
Terminal board
In case of run/stop with external input
(I(_(: Terminal block enabled
_: Common serial communication option enabled
_: Serial communication RS-485 enabled
H: Communication add-on cassette option
Sink logic and source logic (logic of input/output terminal)
are switchable to each other. For details, refer to the
section 2.3.2.
In case of control panel operation
command input
(I(_: Operating panel
enabled
7. OPERATION WITH EXTERNAL SIGNAL
Refer to 5.3, Example 2). Refer to 5.3, Example 3). Refer to 5.3, Example 4).
G-2
7. 2 Applied operation with input and output signals
(operation by the terminal board)
7. 2. 1 Functions of input terminals (in case of sink logic)
Signals that are supplied to control input terminals from the programmable controller, etc. are
used to operate or set up the inverter.
Since function of each contact input terminal is selectable from 136 functions, this inverter
makes it possible to design a system flexibly.
[Control terminal board]
Setting of contact input terminal function
Terminal Title Function
Adjustment
range
Default setting
I( Always active function selection
( (No assignment
function)
F I Input terminal selection #1 (F) _ (Forward rotation)
R I_ Input terminal selection #2 (R) H (Reverse rotation)
ST I_ Input terminal selection #3 (ST) ( (Standby)
RES IH Input terminal selection #4 (RES) ( (Reset)
S1 I_ Input terminal selection #5 (S1) ( (Preset speed #1)
S2 I( Input terminal selection #6 (S2) _ (Preset speed #2)
S3 I Input terminal selection #7 (S3) H (Preset speed #3)
S4 I( Input terminal selection #8 (S4) ( (Preset speed #4)
Option I_ I_( Input terminal selection #9 #16
( __
(Refer to
page G-4.)
Note: When I( (Always active function selection) is selected, selected function is generally activated regardless of
positive or negative logic.
Note: I_ I_( is for use of expansion TB option unit.
Connection method
1) In case of positive logic (a-contact) input
2) In case of negative logic (b-contact) input
CC
Input
terminal
CC
Input
terminal
This function is activated when the input terminal
and CC (common) are short-circuit, and it is used
for forward rotation, reverse rotation, preset
speed operation, etc.
This function is activated when the input terminal
and CC (common) are open-circuit, and it is used
for standby signal, reset signal, etc.
Inverter
Inverter
a-contact switch
b-contact switch
F S T C C C C R R R V F M O U T 1 P 2 P P
R E S S 1 S 2 S 3 S 4 A M F P R X O U T 2
F L F L F L B
G-3
Inverter
3) In case of connection with transistor output
Regarding interface between inverter and programmable controller In the case programmable controller of open
collector output is used to control the inverter, if the programmable controller is turned off as the power supply to
the inverter is on, such a wrong signal as shown in the following figure flows into the inverter because of
difference in potential of control power. Be sure to provide the system with an interlock so that the programmable
controller cannot be turned off while the inverter is turned on.
Example of use - Push-type operation stop
Operation: Press the START button.
Stop: Press the STOP button.
Switch between forward and reverse
rotation:
Short circuit between S2 and CC.
[Parameter setting]
Symbol of
terminal
Title Function
Adjustment
range
Setting value
F I Input terminal selection #1(F)
_H
(PUSH-type run command)
S1 I_
Input terminal selection #5(S1)
_
(PUSH-type stop command)
S2 I( Input terminal selection #6(S2)
( __
(Refer to
page G-4) _(
(Forward/reverse selection)
The inverter can be controlled by connecting the
input terminal with output (contactless switch) of a
programmable controller. This input is used for
forward rotation, reverse rotation, preset speed
control, etc. Use a transistor that operates on
24VDC,5mA power.
C C
Input
terminal
Programmable controller
External +24 V
power supply
Fuse
Fuse blowout
detector circuit
Internal +24 V power
supply (inverter)
The terminals VI and II cannot be used together at a time. Be sure to use either of them.
G-13
7. 3. 3 Setup by analog input signals (RX terminal)
Connect voltage signal (0 to 10 VDC) to the terminal RX so that the inverter can be run and
stopped with external commands.
<Related parameters>
Title Function Adjustment range Default value Setup value
(I(_ Operation command mode selection ( H ((Terminal) ((Terminal)
II(_ Speed setting mode selection _(RR) _(RX)
II_j FM terminal meter selection _
II FM terminal meter adjustment
I_(( Reference priority selection ( H ((II(_) ((II(_)
I_(_ Analog input filter
((Disabled) to
_ (Max. filter capacity)
( (
I_( RX reference point #1 (( (( [%] (( ((
I_ RX reference point #1 frequency IH IH [Hz] (.( (.(
I_( RX reference point #2 (( (( [%] (( ((
I__ RX reference point #2 frequency IH IH [Hz] ((.( ((.(
I__( RX reference point #1 rate __( __( [%] ( (
I__ RX reference point #2 rate __( __( [%] (( ((
*
*Regardless of open/closed circuit between
R and CC terminals, run and stop operation is controllable.
Switching between forward rotation and reverse rotation is controllable by the terminals
F/R and RX if reverse rotation disabling selection F311 is properly set up.
Refer to 6.13.7, for details
Motor
IM
G/E
R/L1 U/T1
MCCB
Power
supply
S/L2
T/L3
V/T2
W/T3
CC RX
RES
S1
S2
CC
S3
S4
F
R
ST
FM
AM
FP
FLA
FLB
FLC
P24
OUT1
OUT2
FL
VI II RR PP
CHARGE
Run/stop setup
To run and stop the inverter by external
commands.
Setup of frequency setting signal and
running frequency characteristic
To set up frequency setting signal and
characteristic of running frequency that are
to be externally input to the terminal RX.
Frequency characteristic is set up at the
two points of RX reference point #1
(I_()/frequency(I_), RX
reference point #2(I_()/frequency
(I__).
Connection and calibration of
frequency meter
Connect a 1 mAdc full-scale DC current
meter, 7.5 VDC full-scale DC voltmeter or
rectifier type AC voltmeter. For calibration
of the meter, refer to the section 5.4.
RunStop
[%]
I__
I_
I_(
I_(
Point 2
Point 1
Frequency setting signal
V
Running frequency [Hz]
Frequency
meter
Forward
rotation
Reverse
rotation
H-1
8. 1 Status monitor mode
Status of the inverter can be monitored.
To monitor the inverter when it is normally running,
Press the key twice and the current status is indicated on the LED display.
Setup procedure to monitor the inverter status. (EX. Operation at 60 Hz)
Com.No. Details of indication Key operated LED display Description
Standard monitor
mode
(((
Running frequency indication (in operation)
(In the case monitor display mode setting
I( is set at ([running frequency])
FE01
Parameter setup
mode
H(
Indication of "Automatic acceleration
/deceleration(H()" that is the first basic
parameter
FE01
Status monitor
mode (rotating
direction)
IrI
Indication of rotating direction
(I: forward, r: reverse)
Frequency
command
(((
Indication of frequency command value.
(In case of I=)
Load indication (((
Indication of inverter output current (load
current)(In case of I_=_)
DC voltage _((
Indication of inverter DC voltage (Default
setting unit: [%]) (In case of I_=_)
Output voltage P((
Indication of inverter output voltage (Default
setting unit: [%]) (In case of IH=H)
Input terminal
information #1
Indication of ON/OFF status of control input
terminals (F, R, RES, ST, S1, S2, S3, S4) in
bits
Input terminal
information #2
H
Indication of ON/OFF status of optional control
input terminals (B8,B9,B10,B11) in bits
FE06
FE50
FE51
Input terminal
information #3
j
Indication of ON/OFF status of optional control
input terminals (B11,B12,B13,B14) in bits
Output terminal
information #1
Indication of ON/OFF status of control output
terminals (OUT1,OUT2,FL) in bits
Output terminal
information #2
(
Indication of ON/OFF status of optional control
output terminals (R1,R2,OUT3,OUT4) in bits
FE07
FE52
FE53
Output terminal
information #3
P
Indication of ON/OFF status of optional control
output terminals (ALM0,ALM1,ALM2,ALM3) in
bits
FE48
Sink/source
switching status
j (
Indication of sink or source status
((: source, : sink)
FE47
Type of connected
option
( ( Indication of connected options
FE54 j_P last set data j ( Indication of j_P value set last
FE55 H(_ last set data H ( Indication of H(_ value set last
FE08 CPU version (_( Indication of version of the CPU
FE43
Flush memory
version
I(( Indication of version of the flush memory
FE09
Control EEPROM
version
( ( Indication of version of the control EEPROM
FE44
Drive EEPROM
version
_(( Indication of version of the drive EEPROM
(Continued on the following page)
8. Monitoring operation status
MON
1
2
3
4
5
MON
MON
H-2
(Continued from the preceding page)
Com.No. Details of indication Key operated LED display Description
FE10 Past trip #1 ((_
(Alternately blinking at intervals of 0.5
second) Past trip #1
FE11 Past trip #2 (H_
(Alternately blinking at intervals of 0.5
second) Past trip #2
FE12 Past trip #3 (P__
(Alternately blinking at intervals of 0.5
second) Past trip #3
FE13 Past trip #4 (rrH
(Alternately blinking at intervals of 0.5
second) Past trip #4
FE14
Cumulative
operation time
j (.
Indication of total (accumulated) operation
hours(Indication of 0.1 represents 10 hours.)
Standard monitor
mode
Note 1
((.( Running frequency indication(in operation)
Note 1: When or key is pressed, indication changes in the status monitor mode.
Note 2: Contents of status indications of *1, *2, *3, *4 and *5 can be selected from 30 kinds of information.
Unit of current and voltage indications can be changed from % to A (amperage) and V (voltage)
and vice versa respectively.
Note 3: Indicated input voltage is DC voltage just after input voltage is rectified multiplied by 1/2.
Note 4: Past trip is in order of 1(last)234(oldest)
Note 5: Cumulative operation time indicates a total of actually running hours.
Information on input terminals
Information on H input terminals and j input terminals are for the optional add-on cassette.
H
j
Input terminal #9 to #16: Expansion TB option unit
Note) When I( is set at a number of to ( expansion TB option input terminal information (H,j)
indicate information of lower 8 bit terminal (B0 B7).
Input terminal #1F :F111 :0
Input terminal #2R :F112 :1 When there is signal input
Input terminal #3ST :F113 :2
Input terminal #4RES :F114 :3 When there is no signal input
Input terminal #5S1 :F115 :4 (Blank in the upper half)
Input terminal #6S2 :F116 :5
Input terminal #7S3 :F117 :6
Input terminal #8S4 :F118 :6
Input terminal #9 B8 :F119 :8 When there is signal input
Input terminal #10B9 :F120 :9
Input terminal #11B10 :F121 :10 When there is no signal input
input terminal #12B11 :F122 :11 (Blank in the upper half)
Input terminal #13B12 :F123 :12 When there is signal input
Input terminal #14B13 :F124 :13
Input terminal #15B14 :F125 :14 When there is no signal input
Input terminal #16B15 :F126 :15 (Blank in the upper half)
O
p
t
i
o
n
a
l
a
d
d
-
o
n
c
a
s
s
e
t
t
e
MON
H-3
Information on output terminals
Information on ( output terminals and P output terminals are for the optional add-on cassette.
(
P
Type of connected option
((_
Note1) Connection of add-on cassette options are reflected in this display.
Note2) Connection of PG feedback boards are not in this display.
Total (accumulated) operation hours
For indication of total operation hours, running hours are counted up when the output frequency
monitor reads a frequency other than 0.0 Hz. 10 hours is indicated as 0.1 (unit of indication). Total
hours is indicated in the range from "(." to "____" that represent 10 hours and 9999 hours
respectively.
Output terminal #1OUT1:F130 :1 When there is signal output
Output terminal #2OUT2:F131 :2
Output terminal #3FL :F132 :3 When there is no signal output
blank in the upper half
Error code output #0ALM0 :8 When there is signal input
Error code output #1ALM1 :9
Error code output #2ALM2 :10 When there is no signal input
Error code output #3ALM3 :11 blank in the upper half
Error code output #0,1,2,3 : Vector option unit
Output terminal #4R1 :F133 :4 When there is signal output
Output terminal #5R2 :F134 :5
Output terminal #6OUT3:F135 :6 When there is no signal output
Output terminal #7OUT4:F136 :7 blank in the upper half
Output terminal #4,5 : Expansion TB option unit
Output terminal #6,7 : Vector option unit
O
p
t
i
o
n
a
l
a
d
d
-
o
n
c
a
s
s
e
t
t
e
Expansion TB option unit
_Vector option unit
_Expansion TB option unit & Vector option unit(_)
F10M option unit
_S20 option unit
H-4
8. 2 Changing status monitor function
Changing indication of status with power on
The standard monitor mode (*1) indicates running frequency (with default setting) such as
"(.(" when power is on or "(II" when power is off, however, such the standard indication
can be changed into arbitrary indication as shown on page H-5. When the standard monitor
indication is changed for an option, each indication appears lacking in the initial letter (j, (,
etc.).
Standard monitor modeStandard monitor indication selectionI
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I( Monitor display mode setting ( __(Refer to the next page.) (
Changing contents of status monitor indication
Regarding contents of status monitor indications appearing in the left column of the table on
page H-1, those marked with *2 to *5 can be changed for others. Select a desirable monitor
function from among optional monitor functions appearing on page H-5.
*2 Frequency command Changeable by status monitor #1 display mode (I).
*3 Load current Changeable by status monitor #2 display mode (I_).
*4 Input voltage Changeable by status monitor #3 display mode (I_).
*5 Output voltage Changeable by status monitor #4 display mode (IH).
Title Function Adjustment range Default setting
I Status monitor #1 display mode
( __
(Refer to the next page.)
I_ Status monitor #2 display mode ( __(ditto) _
I_ Status monitor #3 display mode ( __(ditto) _
IH Status monitor #4 display mode ( __(ditto) H
If I to IH are set at "(" (Running frequency) the running frequency is not held
in trip status.
H-5
Setup values of monitor indication parameters(I IH)
Com.
No.
Setup
value
Function Indication Unit(Panel)
Unit(Com-
munication)
FD00 0 Running frequency (((
Depends
on I(_
0.01[Hz]
FE02 1 Frequency command ((( ditto 0.01[Hz]
FE03 2 Current ( (
1[%] or
I(
0.01[%]
FE04 3 DC voltage _ ( ditto 0.01[%]
FE05 4 Output voltage P ( ditto 0.01[%]
FE015 5 After-compensation frequency (((
Depends
on I(_
0.01[Hz]
FE16 6 Speed feedback (real-time value) ( ditto 0.01[Hz]
FE17 7 Speed feedback (1 second filter) ( ditto 0.01[Hz]
FE18 8 Torque j ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE19 9 Torque reference j ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE56 10 Internal torque reference (*1) j ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE20 11 Torque current j ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE21 12 Exciting current ( ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE22 13 PID feedback value _ (
Depends
on I(_
0.01[Hz]
FE23 14 Motor overload factor (OL2 data) j ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE24 15 Inverter overload factor (OL1 data) ( ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE25 16 PBr overload factor (PBrOL data) r ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE28 17 PBr load factor (pulse duty) r ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE29 18 Input power H ( 0.1[kW] 0.01[kW]
FE30 19 Output power H ( 0.1[kW] 0.01[kW]
FE31 20 Peak output current ( (
1[%] or
I(
0.01[%]
FE32 21 Peak DC voltage _ ( ditto 0.01[%]
FE33 22 Motor counter dummy PG P ( 1/100 count 1 count
FE34 23 Position pulse P ( 1/100 count 1 count
FE35 24 PR input _ ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE36 25 VI/II input _ ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
GE37 26 RX input _ ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE38 27 RX2 input _ ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE39 28 FM output H ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
FE40 29 AM output H ( 1[%] 0.01[%]
H-6
8. 3 Indication in trip status
When the inverter trips, details of the trip status are indicated. In the status monitor mode, the
status when the inverter trips is held.
Details of indications of trip status
Trip indication Details Com. code Error code
((,((P Over-current during acceleration 1,37 25,29
((_,((_P Over-current during deceleration 2,38 26,30
((_,((_P Over-current during constant speed 3,39 27,31
((j
Trip caused by short-circuit in the loaded
side on starting
4 41
((H U-phase arm over-current 5 61
((H_ V-phase arm over-current 6 62
((H_ W-phase arm over-current 7 63
(PH Input phase failure 8 44
(PH( Output phase failure 9 40
(P Over-voltage during acceleration 10 21
(P_ Over-voltage during deceleration 11 22
(P_ Over-voltage during constant speed 12 23
(j Inverter overload 13 17
(j_ Motor overload 14 18
(jr Dynamic braking resistor trip by overload 15 16
(H Overheat 16 19
( Emergency stop 17 14
((PH EEPROM error (write error) 18 49
((P_ Initial read error 19 50
((P_ Initial read error 20 51
(rr_ Main RAM error 21 48
(rr_ Main ROM error 22 53
(rrH CPU error 23 55
(rr_ Communication abnormal interruption 24 15
(rr( Gate array fault 25 54
(rr Output current detector error 26 58
(rr( Option error 27 57
(rr_ Flush memory fault 28 52
(( Trip of low current operation status 29 4
(P
Trip by insufficient voltage (main circuit
power supply)
30 5
(P_
Trip by insufficient voltage (control circuit
power supply)
31 6
(j Trip by over-torque 32 7
(I 33 45
(I_
Trip by short-circuit
34 46
(j Auto-tuning error 40 13
(j_P Inverter type error 41 56
(( Sink/source switching error 42 32
( Sequence error 43 37
(_ Disconnection of encoder 44 36
(_ Abnormal speed 45 11
(H Extreme potential deviation 46 9
( Key error 49 33
(rr (*1) No error 0 0
Note: Past trip indications (that have been saved in the memory or that appeared in the past)
can be read out. (Refer to "Status monitor mode, 8.1".)
(*1)This is not a trip indication, but it appears when no error record is found in monitoring the
past trip indications.
H-7
Examples of reading out trip data
Com,No. Contents of indication Key operated LED display Description
FC90 Trip information (P_
Status monitor mode (Blinking for trip
indication) Motor is in free-run status.
Parameter setup
mode
H(
Indication of "Automatic
acceleration/deceleration (H()" that is
the first basic parameters.
FE00 Running frequency H(.(
Indication of running frequency when trip
occurred.
FE01 Running direction IrI
Indication of direction of rotation when
trip occurred.
(I: Forward rotation, r: Reverse rotation)
frequency command ((.(
Indication of frequency command value
when trip occurred.
Current (_(
Indication of inverter output current (load
current) when trip occurred.
DC voltage _H
Indication of inverter DC voltage when
trip occurred.
Output voltage P((
Indication of inverter output voltage
when trip occurred.
Input terminal
information #1
Indication of ON/OFF status of control input
terminals (F, R, RES, ST, S1, S2, S3, S4)
when trip occurred.
Input terminal
information #2
H
Indication of ON/OFF status of optional
control input terminals (B8, B9, B10, B11)
when trip occurred.
FE06
FE50
FE51
Input terminal
information #3
j
Indication of ON/OFF status of optional
control input terminals (B12, B13, B14,
B15) when trip occurred.
Output terminal
information #1
Indication of ON/OFF status of control
output terminals (OUT1, OUT2, FL) when
trip occurred.
Output terminal
information #2
(
Indication of ON/OFF status of optional
control output terminals (R1, R2, OUT3,
OUT4) when trip occurred.
FE07
FE52
FE53
Output terminal
information #3
P
Indication of ON/OFF status of optional
control output terminals (ALM0, ALM1,
ALM2, ALM3) when trip occurred.
FE48
Sink/source
switching status
j
Indication of sink or source status
(: Sink, (: Source)
FE47
Type of
connected option
( (
Indication of connected add-on cassette
options
FE54 j_P last set data j ( Indication of j_P value set last
FE55 H(_ last set data H ( Indication of H(_ value set last
FE08 CPU version (_( Indication of version of the CPU
FE43
Flush memory
version
I(( Indication of version of the flush memory
FE09
Control EEPROM
version
( (
Indication of version of the control
EEPROM
FE44
Main circuit
EEPROM version
_(( Indication of version of the drive EEPROM
Continued on the following page
MON
MON
2
3
4
5
H-8
Continued from the preceding page
Com,No. Contents of indication Key operated LED display Description
FE10 Past trip #1 ((_
(Alternately blinking at intervals of 0.5
second) Past trip #1
FE11 Past trip #2 (H_
(Alternately blinking at intervals of 0.5
second) Past trip #2
FE12 Past trip #3 (P__
(Alternately blinking at intervals of 0.5
second) Past trip #3
FE13 Past trip #4 (rrH
(Alternately blinking at intervals of 0.5
second) Past trip #4
FE14
Cumulative operation
time
j (.
Indication of total (accumulated)
operation hours(Indication of 0.1
represents 10 hours.)
Standard monitor
mode
2
(P_
Status monitor mode(Blinking for trip
indication)
Reverts to the first trip indication.
Note 1: Failures that occur during initialization of the CPU on turning on the power or after resetting the
inverter are not held by the failure trip holding function, and status monitor indications appear for
such the failure.
Note 2: Contents of status indications of *2, *3, *4 and *5 can be selected from 30 kinds of information.
Contents of indications that are set up at I to IH(status monitor #1 to #4 display
mode) are displayed.
Unit of current and voltage indications can be changed from % to A (amperage) or V (voltage)
and vice versa respectively with I((Current/voltage display mode).
8. 4 Indication of alarm, pre-alarm, etc...
When the inverter alarm, pre-alarm, etc. occurred, the contents are displayed. (Some are
not displayed.) Listed below ones can be monitored via communication(FC91). Refer to
12.1 for the other alarms.
Bit Contents of indication Panel indication
0 Over-current pre-alarm (
1 Inverter overload pre-alarm j
2 Motor overload pre-alarm j
3 Overheat pre-alarm H
4 Over-voltage pre-alarm P
5 Main circuit under-voltage (I(II) detected I(II
6 Poor control power supply (P(II) pre-alarm P(II
7 Low current detected
8 Over-torque detected
9 Braking resistor overload ((jr) pre-alarm
10 Cumulative operation time alarm
11
Abnormal communication alarm #1
(caused by scanning)
j
12
Abnormal communication alarm #2
(caused by RS485 logic or message transmission)
j
13 Reservation area
14 Reservation area
15 Reservation area
Note) For each bit, "0" indicates normal condition and "1" indicates appearance of
alarm, etc..
MON
I-1
Danger
Mandatory
When using the inverter without the front cover, be sure to place the inverter unit inside a
cabinet. If they are used outside the cabinet, it may cause electric shock.
Be grounded
Be sure to ground every unit. If not, it may cause electric shock or fire on the occasion of
failure, short-circuit or electric leak.
9. 1 Selection of wiring equipment
Wire size AWGcross-section[mm
2
]
Voltage
class
Applicable
motor
[kW]
Inverter model
Main circuit(*1)
DC reactor
(optional)
Braking resistor/
Braking
unit(optional)
Earth cable
18.5 VFP7-2185P 4(22) 8(8)
22 VFP7-2220P 2(38)
2(38) 4(22)
30 VFP7-2300P 2/0(60)
6(14)
37 VFP7-2370P
2/0(60)
4/0(100)
2(38)
45 VFP7-2450P 4/0(100) 2/0(60)
55 VFP7-2550P
75 VFP7-2750P
300(150)
90 VFP7-2900P
300(150)
400(200)
200V
class
110 VFP7-2110KP 400(200)
3002
(1502)
2(38)
4/0(100)
18.5 VFP7-4185P 8(8) 8(8)
22 VFP7-4220P
6(14)
30 VFP7-4300P
6(14)
4(22)
6(14)
37 VFP7-4370P 4(22)
10(5.5)
45 VFP7-4450P
2(38)
55 VFP7-4550P
2(38)
2/0(60)
6(14)
4(22)
75 VFP7-4750P 4/0(100)
90 VFP7-4900P
4(22)
110 VFP7-4110KP
132 VFP7-4132KP
4/0(100) 2/0(60)
160 VFP7-4160KP 300(150)
300(150)
2(38)
200 VFP7-4200KP
400
(1002)
220 VFP7-4220KP
400(200)
3002
(1502)
4/0(100) or
22(382)
4/0(100)
280 VFP7-4280KP
400V
class
315 VFP7-4315KP
3002
(1502)
4002
(2002)
4/0(100) or
2/0(602)
300
(150)
(*1): Indicates wire sizes of input terminals R, S, T and output terminals U, V, W. Wiring distance is supposed to
be 30 m at maximum.
(*2): Cable sizes in this table is in case of 75 degree copper wire.
(*3): For the control circuit, use shielded wires whose size (cross-section) is 0.75 mm
2
or more.
(*4): For the earth cable, use wires larger than the specified ones in size (cross-section).
(*5): Do not connect more than two wires to a terminal block (except for terminal blocks of 2900, 2110K, 4160K
to 4315K and PA terminals of models that have only one PA terminal). If wiring with more than two wires is
needed, set a external relay terminal.
9. Selection of peripheral devices
I-2
Selection of wiring equipment
Molded case
circuit breaker
(MCCB)
Magnetic
contactor
(MC)
Overload
relay
(THR)
Earth leakage
circuit breaker
(ELCB)
Voltage
class
Applicable
motor
[kW]
Inverter
model Rated
current
[A]
Type
form
(*1)
Rated
current
[A]
Type
form
(*1)
Regulate
d
amperag
e
(referenc
e)
[A]
Type
form
(*1)
Rated
current
[A]
Type
form
(*1)
18.5 VFP7-2185P 125 93 C100J 70 T100J 125
22 VFP7-2220P 150 125 LC1D150J 85 150
30 VFP7-2300P 200 110
T115J
200
37 VFP7-2370P 225
NJ225F
180 LC1-F185
138 T150J 225
NJV225F
45 VFP7-2450P 300 220 LC1F225J 162 T185J 300
55 VFP7-2550P 350 198 LR9F53J 350
75 VFP7-2750P 400
EH400
300 LC1F330J
252 400
LEH400
90 VFP7-2900P 600 EH600 400 LC1F400J 314 600 LEH600
200V
class
110 VFP7-2110KP 700 EH800 600 LC1F630J 396
LR9F73J
700 (*4)
18.5 VFP7-4185P 75 48 C50J 35 75
22 VFP7-4220P 100
NJ100F
65 C65J 44 100
NJV100F
30 VFP7-4300P 80 C80J 57
T65J
37 VFP7-4370P
125
110 LC1-D150 65 T100J
125
45 VFP7-4450P 150 85 150
55 VFP7-4550P 175
NJ225F
180 LC1F185J
100
T115J
175
NJV225F
75 VFP7-4750P 250 138 T150J 250
90 VFP7-4900P 300
220 LC1F225J
157 300
110 VFP7-4110KP 350 265 LC1F330J 198
LR9F53J
350
132 VFP7-4132KP 400
EH400
252 400
LEH400
160 VFP7-4160KP 500
400 LC1F400J
268 500
200 VFP7-4200KP 384
220 VFP7-4220KP
600
EH600
396
600
LEH600
280 VFP7-4280KP 800 EH800
600 LC1F630J
460 800 (*4)
400V
class
315 VFP7-4315KP 1000 S1000B 800 LC1F800J 504
LR9F73J
1000 (*5)
(*1): Type forms of Toshiba Schneider Electric Ltd. products.
(*2): Attach surge killers to the magnetic contactor and exciting coil of the relay.
Surge killer for Toshiba Schneider Electric Ltd. magnetic contactor.
200 V class: SS-2 (Manufacture: Toshiba Schneider Electric Ltd.)
(For C11J to C65J, surge absorbing units are served optionally.)
400 V class: For the operation circuit and control circuit, regulate the voltage at 200 V or lower with a
voltage regulator.
(*3): In the case the magnetic contactor (MC) with 2a-type auxiliary contacts is used for the control circuit,
raise the reliability of the contact by using 2a-type contacts in parallel connection.
(*4): EH800 + LRE(Earth leakage relay) + ZCT
(*5): S1000B + LRE(Earth leakage relay) + ZCT
I-3
Among the wiring equipment shown in the above table, the magnetic contactors (MC) and overload relays
(THR) are new models of the ESPER Mighty J series. When using old models of the Mighty J series, refer
to the following comparison table that shows consistency between models of the two series.
Magnetic contactor (MC) Overload relay(THR)
Mighty J series ESPER Mighty series Mighty J series ESPER Mighty series
C50J C50A T65J T65A
C65J C65A T100J T80A
C80J C80A T115J T125A
C100J C100A T150J T150A
LC1-D150 C125A T185J T180A
LC1-F185 C180A LR9-F53 T220A
LC1-F225 C220A LR9-F73 T400A
LC1-F330 C300A
LC1-F400 C400A
LC1-F630 C600A
9. 2. Installation of electromagnetic contactor
When the inverter is used without electromagnetic contactor (MC) in the primary circuit, use the
MCCB (with voltage tripping device) to make the primary circuit open when the inverter
protection circuit is in operation.
When the damping resistor/damping resistance unit is used, install the electromagnetic
contactor (MC) or fuseless circuit breaker with power tripping device in the temporary power
supply circuit of the inverter so that the power circuit becomes open by operation of the error
detection relay (EL) built in the inverter or externally installed overload relay.
Electromagnetic contactor in the primary circuit
If an electromagnetic contactor is installed in the power supply circuit of the inverter, it prevents
the inverter from power failure, tripping of overload relay (Th-Ry), cutout of the inverter
protection circuit after its operation, and double starting.
If the FL contact of the error detection relay built in the VF-P7 is connected with the operation
circuit of the primary electromagnetic contactor (MC), the MC is tripped when the inverter
protection circuit is actuated.
Example of electromagnetic contactor connection in primary circuit
Power
supply
Operation preparation
Forward
Reverse
Moter
I-4
Note on wiring
If alternate operation to run and stop the inverter is frequently repeated, don't turn it on/off with
the primary electromagnetic contactor. Run and stop the inverter with the control terminals F
and CC (forward) and R and CC (reverse).
Attach a surge killer to the exciting coil of the electromagnetic contactor (MC)
Electromagnetic contactor in the secondary circuit
The secondary electromagnetic contactor can be installed for switching the control motor and
power supply when the inverter is suspended.
Note on wiring
To prevent the commercial power supply from impressing the inverters output terminals, be
sure to interlock the secondary electromagnetic contactor with the power supply.
In the case the electromagnetic contactor (MC) is installed between the inverter and motor,
don't turn on/off the electromagnetic contactor on/off while the inverter is running. If the
electromagnetic contactor is turned on/off during operation, it may cause a failure of the
inverter because rush current flows to it.
9. 3. Installation of overload relay
The inverter VF-P7 has a built-in electronic thermal overload protection function inside. In
the following cases, however, install an overload relay proper to the electronic thermal
operation level adjustment and motor used between the inverter and motor.
In the case a motor that is different in rated current from Toshiba standard motor is used.
In the case a motor whose output is lower than the specified Toshiba motor of the
standard specifications is independently operated, or two or more units of such the
motors are operated together at a time.
When the low torque motor "Toshiba VF motor" is operated, properly adjust the electronic
thermal protection characteristic of the inverter VF-P7 for the VF motor.
It is recommended to use a motor with motor winding flush type thermal relay in order to
secure motor protection when it runs at low speed.
I-5
9. 4 Application and functions of options
Separate type options shown below are prepared for the inverter VF-P7
Sorts of separate-type options
No. Option name Function, purpose.
Input AC reactor
(ACL)
DC reactor(DCL)
To be used for improvement of input power-factor of the inverter power source, for reducing
higher harmonic or suppressing external surge. The input reactor can be installed when the
power capacity is 500 kVA or more and it is 10 times or more as high as the inverter capacity
or there are some source distorted wave generation such as a thyristor, etc. and a high
capacity inverter connected with the same distribution system.
The DC reactor is superior to the input AC reactor in power-factor improvement. For the
inverter system that is required to be high reliable, it is recommended to use the input AC
reactor that effectually suppresses external surge together with the DC reactor.
High attenuation
radio noise filter
(LC filter) NF type,
(manufactured by
Soshin Electric
Co., Ltd.)
Effectual to prevent audio equipment used near the inverter from radio interference.
Install this filter in the inverters input side.
Excellent attenuation characteristic for wide frequency band from AM radio band nearly to
10 MHz.
To be used when electric appliances that are easily affected by noise are installed in the
periphery of the inverter
R
a
d
i
o
n
o
i
s
e
r
e
d
u
c
t
i
o
n
f
i
l
t
e
r
Zero-phase reactor
(Inductive filter)
(Ferrite core type,
manufactured by
Soshin Electric
Co., Ltd.)
Effectual to prevent audio equipment used near the inverter from radio interference.
Effectual to reduce noise in the input and output sides of the inverter.
Excellent attenuation characteristic for several decibels in wide frequency band from AM
radio band nearly to 10 MHz.
Braking unit
To be used to shorten deceleration time for the reason of frequently operated quick
deceleration and suspension or high inertia load. This increases consumption of
regenerative energy in dynamic braking.
Braking resistor: (resistor + protective thermal relay) are built in.
Braking unit:(dynamic brake drive circuit + resistor + protective thermal relay + thermal
relay) are built in.
Effect
Type of reactor Power-factor
improvement
Harmonic
suppression
External surge
suppression
Input AC reactor Effective Effective Effective
DC reactor Very effective Very effective Not effective
Molded case
circuit breaker
(MCCB)
N.F.
motor
IM
Magnetic
conductor
(MC)
Power supply
Input AC reactor
(ACL)
High attention radio
noise filter
Zero-phase reactor
ferrite core type
radio noise filter
EMI filter for CE
compliance
Simple radio
noise filter
DC reactor
(DCL)
Braking resistor
/Braking unit
Zero-phase
reactor
ferrite core
type radio
noise filter
VF-P7
N.F.
Motor end surge
voltage suppression
filter (for 400V
models only)
Control power
converter unit
Motor noise
reduction filter
I-6
No. Option name Function, purpose.
(Model: PWU001Z)
Extension control panel
Extension operation control panel unit with LED indicator, RUN/STOP key, UP/DOWN key, Monitor key and Enter key.
(When using this unit, set as follows: F805 [common serial transmission waiting time] = 0.00 [default setting].)
<Outline drawings with dimensions>
(Model: RKP001Z)
RS-232C
communication
converter unit
If this unit is used to connect the inverter and a personal computer and so on with each other, data communication can
be performed between the two besides easy adjustment of parameters, saving and writing data. This unit serves as not
only an RS-232C interface but a communication unit that can be connected with two inverters together.
Monitor functionParameter setup functionCommand functionAdded function
<Outline drawings with dimensions>
(Model: RS2001Z)
(Note)
Use a parameter writer
manufactured in January, 1997 or
after. For using a parameter writer
manufactured in December, 1996 or
before, connect it to the inverter with
cable after turning on the inverter.
<How to know date of manufacture>
RS-232C
communication
converter cable
If this unit is used to connect the inverter and a personal computer and so on with each other, data communication can
be performed between the two besides easy adjustment of parameters, saving and writing data.
<Outline drawings with dimensions>
(Model: RS20035)
RS-485 communication
converter unit
(for communication with
multiple inverters)
More than one inverter can be controlled with a personal computer and so on if this unit is
used for connection between inverters and personal computer.
Computer link: Since this unit makes it possible to connect inverters with higher-class
computer, FA computer, etc., a data communication network can be
constructed among multiple inverters.
Communication among inverters: For the purpose of proportional operation of multiple
inverters, a frequency data communication network can
be constructed among multiple inverters.
<Outline drawings with dimensions>
(Model: RS4001Z) (Model: RS4002Z)
Communication cable
Connection cable for connecting parameter writer, extension control panel,
RS-232C communication units, and RS-485 communication units.
Cable types: CAB0011 (1 m), CAB0013 (3 m), CAB0015 (5 m).
Remote control panel
A frequency meter, frequency setup device, RUN/STOP (forward, reverse) switch
are built in this operation panel. (Model: CBVR-7B)
Applied control units of the AP series make various applied control possible if they
are used in combination with the inverter.
Application control units
Proportional control panel (APP-2B)
Ratio setup panel (APH-7B)
Regulated power supply board (APV-2B)
Cushion starter panel (APC-2B)
Synchronizing control panel
(APS-2B1)
Synchronizing transmitter (DRR-2)
Remote control panel (APM-2B)
Process control panel with built-in PI
controller (APJ-2B)
TG follower panel (APF-7B)
Current detection panel (APD-2B)
Torque control panel (APL-2B)
FV converter (APR-2B)
Loop controller (APU-2B)
Harmonic suppression
converter
Power regeneration
converter
Higher harmonic suppressor unit improves input power-factor by suppressing
harmonic current.
Power regenerator unit protects the inverter from load sprung from frequent rapid
deceleration and negative torque.
For applicable models and particulars, inquire at our office.
Option should be used under the condition of 9600 bps or less ().
RJ45 connector
D-Sub 9pin connector
5m
M
o
u
n
t
in
g
d
im
e
n
s
io
n
.
.
.
I-9
Selection table of separate-type options
Radio noise reduction filter
Voltage
class
Applicable
motor
[kW]
Inverter
model
Input AC
reactor
(ACL)
DC reactor
(DCL)
High
attenuation
type
Simple
type
Core
type
(*1)
Braking resistor
/Braking unit
(*3, 4, 5)
Motor end
surge voltage
suppression
filter
Motor
noise
reduction
filter
18.5 VFP7-2185P NF-3080A-MJ PBR3-2150
22 VFP7-2220P
PFL-2100S DCL-2220
NF-3100A-MJ PBR3-2220
30 VFP7-2300P PB3-2300
37 VFP7-2370P
PFL-2150S DCL-2370 NF-3150A-MJ
45 VFP7-2450P PFL-2200S DCL-2450 NF-3200A-MJ
RC9129
55 VFP7-2550P PFL-2300S DCL-2550 NF-3250A-MJ
PB3-2550
NRL-2220
75 VFP7-2750P PFL-2400S DCL-2750
NF-3200A-MJ
2 (parallel)
NRL-2300
90 VFP7-2900P NRL-2400
200V
class
110 VFP7-2110KP
PFL-2600S DCL-2900
NF-3250A-MJ
2 (parallel)
RCL-M2
RC9129
(*6)
DGP600W-B1
[DGP600W-C1]
(*2)
18.5 VFP7-4185P NF-3040C-MJ PBR3-4150
22 VFP7-4220P
PFL-4050S DCL-4220
NF-3050C-MJ PBR3-4220
MSF-4220Z
30 VFP7-4300P NF-3060C-MJ
37 VFP7-4370P NF-3080C-MJ
PB3-4300 MSF-4370Z
45 VFP7-4450P
PFL-4100S DCL-4450
NF-3100C-MJ
55 VFP7-4550P
RC9129
MSF-4550Z
75 VFP7-4750P
PFL-4150S DCL-4750 NF-3150C-MJ
MSF-4750Z NRL-4155
90 VFP7-4900P
PB3-4550
110 VFP7-4110KP
PFL-4300S DCL-4110K NF-3250C-MJ NRL-4230
132 VFP7-4132KP NRL-4300
160 VFP7-4160KP
PFL-4400S DCL-4160K
NF-3200C-MJ
2 (parallel)
DGP600W-B2
[DGP600W-C2]
NRL-4350
200 VFP7-4200KP
220 VFP7-4220KP
PFL-4600S DCL-4220K
NF-3250C-MJ
2 (parallel)
DGP600W-B3
[DGP600W-C3]
NRL-4600
280 VFP7-4280KP NRL-4550
400V
class
315 VFP7-4315KP
PFL-4800S DCL-4280K
NF-3250C-MJ
3 (parallel)
RCL-M4
RC9129
(*6)
DGP600W-B4
[DGP600W-C4]
(*7)
(*2)
(*1): This filter needs to be wound 4 turns or more around with the input side power line. This filter can
be used for the output side in the same manner. For the wire whose size is 22 mm
2
or more, install
at least 4 filters in series. Round type (Model: RC5078) is also available.
(*2): For a motor noise reduction filter for this class, please consult.
(*3): PBR3- indicates braking resistor, PB3- indicates braking unit (dynamic braking
drive circuit and braking resistor(s) are built in it).
(*4): Model in square brackets is fitted with top cover.
(*5): To use 200 V-75 kW or more or 400 V-110 kW or more inverter with an external braking resistor
(DGP600 series), installation of a dynamic braking drive circuit inside the inverter is required.
(*6): There is a case that this filter is unusable depending on the type or size of the cable to be used.
(*7): About this filter for inverter models of 90 kW or more, consult with our office
(*8): Be sure to connect DC reactor to 200V-75kW or more or 400V-110kW or more inverter. (Not
necessary for DC input.)
I-10
9. 5 Optional add-on cassettes
The following add-on cassette options are prepared for the inverter VF-P7.
It can be applied to after CPU version V300.
Table of optional add-on cassettes
Table of optional add-on cassettes
Option name Function, purpose Model Remarks (*1)
Vector option
unit
This option compatible to sensor
vector control is usable for speed
control and position control by the
PG feedback function.
VEC001Z
E
x
p
a
n
s
i
o
n
t
e
r
m
i
n
a
l
f
u
n
c
t
i
o
n
Expansion TB
option unit
This option provides extended
terminal functions for use.
ETB001Z
A
S20 option unit
This option provides TOSLINE-
S20 for use.
TLS001Z
F10M option
unit
This option provides TOSLINE-
F10 for use
TLF001Z
Device Net
option unit
This option provides Device Net
for use
Under
planning
C
o
m
m
u
n
i
c
a
t
i
o
n
f
u
n
c
t
i
o
n
Profibus
option unit
This option provides Profibus for
use
Under
planning
B
SBP001Z For 75(132) kW or less(*3)
Attachment
Attachment for fitting add-on
cassette option to the inverter. SBP002Z For 90(160) kW or more(*3)
(*1): One can use two of Group A together with one of the Group B at a time. (Maximally 3 options)
(*2): To use 37 kW or more models in any of conditions described below, refer to 9.7 and execute the
preparation before attachment.
i ) install the vector option unit
ii) install the S20 option unit or the F10M option unit and execute PG feedback control
(*3): Inside ( ) indicates case of 400V class models.
Functions of optional add-on cassettes
Vector option unit
Function Description
PG feedback
Consistent with line driver output encoder (Disconnection detection function is
also provided)
Consistent with complementary/open-collector encoder (Pulse train speed
command)
Max. pulse freq. 60kHz(2-phase), 120kHz(single-phase), Duty: 5010%
Power supply for encoder 5 V, 6 V, 12 V, 15 V DC, 160 mA or less
Voltage drop detection Detection of voltage drop in PG power supply line
Standby signal output
Open-collector output/sink output (30 V DC, 50 mA or less)
Approximately 1 second after the main circuit power is turned on, this terminal is
connected with COM. In an error status, circuit between this terminal and COM is
open regardless of main circuit power supply.
OC pre-alarm
Open-collector output/sink output (30 V DC, 50 mA or less)
When current exceeds the limiting range, this terminal is connected with COM.
Alarm output (Error code 0, 1,
2, 3)
With occurrence of an error, the cause of trip is output in 4-bit binary system. Error
is detected according to the open/closed status of the circuit between the open-
collector of each terminal and COM.
P24 power supply +24 V DC power supply (200 mA or less) for driving external relay, etc.
PG feedback output
Open-collector outputs of phase-A positioning pulse, phase-B positioning pulse,
phase-Z positioning pulse originating from the encoder built in the motor. (30 V DC,
50 mA or less)
PG line driver output
Outputs phase-A positioning pulse, phase-B positioning pulse, phase-Z positioning
pulse originating from the line drive output encoder built in the motor.
10 V analog command power
supply
Power supply for 10 V analog voltage command. (Internal impedance: 500 ,
for 1 k resistor)
10 V analog command input 10 V programmable voltage command is input to this terminal.
Pulse train position control
command input
Pulse train positioning commands for forward rotation and reverse rotation are
input to this terminal. This terminal is enabled only when it is set in the position
control mode or switched for position control.
Encoder supply voltage check To check encoder supply voltage.
I-11
Expansion TB option unit
Function Description
16-bit binary input
(12-bit binary)
4-digit BCD code input (3-digit
BCD code)
Contact
input
Multifunction programmable
input (high-order 8 bits)
Sink input
ON : 5 V DC or less (5 mA type)
OFF : 11 V DC or more, or 0.5 mA or less
Source input
ON : 11 V DC, 2.5 mA or more (maximum 30 V DC)
OFF : 5 V DC or less, or 1.4 mA or less
Multifunction programmable analog output
(current/voltage output switchable)
Current: 4 to 20 mA DC output (source output)
Maximum connectable resistance: 750
Voltage: 10 V DC output
Multifunction programmable relay contact
output
1a, 1b contact output (double circuit)
Contact rating : 250 V AC, 2 A (cos = 1)
250 V AC, 1 A (cos = 0.4)
30 V DC, 1 A
75 kW or less model (200V class)
Installation of optional add-on cassettes to 160 kW or less model (400V class)
To install optional add-on cassette(s), use the attachment and set the options on the right side
of the inverter. To attach the option(s), secure an enough space in the right side of the inverter.
To install a cassette: L = 48.5 mm or more
To install two cassettes: L = 73.5 mm or more
To install three cassettes: L = 98.5 mm or more
No matter for cassettes number, L1 = 20.0 mm or more
90 kW or more model (200V class)
Installation of optional add-on cassettes to 200 kW or more model (400V class)
To install optional add-on cassette(s), use the attachment and set the options on the right side
of the control panel. To attach the option(s), secure an enough space (L: 50 mm or more) in front
of the inverter.
L
Option cover
Option cover
Flexible connecting
board
Optional add-
on cassettes
L L1
Optional add-
on cassettes
: In a set with SBP001Z.
Attachment
Flexible connecting
board Optional add-
on cassettes
: In a set with SBP002Z.
I-12
9. 6 Board options
Besides the optional add-on cassettes, such the board options as shown below are prepared for
the inverter VF-P7.
Table of board options
Option name Function, purpose Model Remarks
VEC002Z
(For complementary / open
collector type encoder)
PG feedback
board
Since this option is compatible to
vector option unit, it can be used
for speed control and torque
control by the PG feedback
function.
VEC003Z
(For line driver type encoder)
Cannot be
used together
with any
optional add-on
cassettes.
Functions of board options
Vector option unit
(optional add-on cassette)
PG feedback board
(board option)
Model
VEC001Z VEC002Z VEC003Z
Vector control with sensor
Speed controlled operation
(150 % torque at zero speed, speed control range: 1:1000 [1000 ppr PG],
speed accuracy: 0.02 % [50 Hz, basic digital input])
Torque controlled operation
(torque control accuracy: 10 % [torque control range: -100 to +100 %])
Position control command operation Available(pulse command) Unavailable Unavailable
PG system
Line driver system
(equivalent to 26LS31)
Complementary system
Open collector system
Complementary system
Open collector system
Line driver system
(equivalent to 26LS31)
Maximum frequency of input pulse
60 kHz(2-phase), 120 kHz(single phase)
Maximum frequency is restricted depending on kind of encoder and wiring distance.
Pulse duty: 5010 %
Length of PG wiring 100 m (complementary system) 100 m (complementary system) 30 m
Power supply for PG
5 V, 6 V, 12 V, 15 V
(switchable), 160 mAdc
12 V (fixed), 160 mAdc 5 V (fixed), 160 mAdc
Voltage drop compensation
for PG power supply
Available Unavailable Unavailable
Sensor disconnection
detection/in running (in rotation)
Available Available Available
Sensor disconnection
detection/in suspension
Available
(line driver system only)
Unavailable Unavailable
10 V analog command input Available Unavailable Unavailable
Multifunction programmable output 2 circuits (sink/source switchable) Unavailable Unavailable
Alarm output 4 circuits (sink/source switchable) Unavailable Unavailable
Terminal board
Detachable terminal board
(Phoenix)
+ connector for VFV3 sensor
Fixed terminal board (Phoenix)
(equivalent to VFS7E control
terminal board)
Fixed terminal board (Phoenix)
(equivalent to VFS7E control
terminal board)
PG wiring
Connector wiring
(connector for VFV3 sensor)
Screw terminal Screw terminal
Connection with other add-
on cassette option
Available Unavailable Unavailable
Remarks
(applied motor, expected)
VFV3 motor/standard
motor with sensor
Standard motor with sensor VFV3 motor
Installation of board option
For installing a board option, fit the bracket to the right side of the inverter and plug the
connector of the option board into the connector jack of the control board.
Bracket Board option
Connector
I-13
9.7 Before installing optional add-on cassette or board option
When using optional add-on cassette(s) or a board option with a model 200V-37kW or more or
400V-45kW or more, prepare for installing according to explanation below.
In any case, check that all the power sources are OFF before opening the front cover.
Option name Model Reference section
Vector option unit VEC001Z
VEC002Z
PG feed back board
VEC003Z
9.7.1 Case 1
S20 option unit TLS001Z
F10M option unit TLF001Z
9.7.1 Case 2
Other than models above 9.7.1 Case 3
9.7.1 Case 1
1. Please extract wire-C from the
connector on board-B.
2. Remove board-A(attached to the
control board) and wire-C from the
control board.
3. For using again in the future, keep
board-A and wire-C which were
removed.
4. Attach the option according to
the instruction manual of each option.
The image after option attachment becomes as follows.
(Left: In the case optional add-on cassette, Right: In the case board option)
5. Switch on power supply and change the setup of the parameter into .
Note) Do not open the front cover, unless 10 minutes has passed after the
power sources turned off and charge lamp is not lit.
Board-B
Wire-C
Board-A
Control board
Note)
Board-A, board-B and wire-C aim at the function of the speed search #2
among the auto-restart modes described in 6.13.1.
At case 1 or case 2-A, speed search #1 is performed. So, board-A, board-B
and wire-C are not needed in these cases.
Warning
Mandatory
Control board
Optional
add-on
cassette
Flexible connecting board
Connector
Control board
Board option
Note) Fix the board option with installation
stay and support screw.
Terminal block
Connector
I-14
9.7.2 Case 2
Case 2-A. When PG feedback function is used
Prepare for installing according to 9.7.1, 1 to 5.
Case 2-B. When PG feedback function is not used
Preparation is not needed.
Note1) Attach flexible connecting board to the board-A (not to the control board).
The image after option attachment becomes as follow.
Note2) Do not change the position of the bit switch for PG input (default setting is
without PG input) in the option unit (TLS001Z or TLM001Z). If you set at
with PG input position, auto-restart function(refer to 6.13.1) dose not work
correctly and over-current, overload, over-voltage, etc. trips may occur.
9.7.3 Case 3
Preparation is not needed.
Note) Attach flexible connecting board set with attachment (SBP001Z or SBP002Z)
to board-A (not control board).
Refer to attachment image in case 2-B.
Control board
Wire-C
Board-A
Optional
add-on
cassette
Flexible connecting board
Connector
J
-
1
5.10
_j 0016 Manual torque boost 0 30% 0.1/0.01 See J-28 Enabled 5.12
Setting Type
Overload
protection
Overload stall
0 protect not stall
1 protect stall
2 not protect not stall
3
Standard
motor
not protect stall
4 protect not stall
5 protect stall
6 not protect not stall
(jI 0017
Selection of electronic
thermal protection
characteristics
7
VF motor
(special
motor)
not protect stall
0 Disabled / / / 5.13
_r 0018 Preset-speed #1 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
_r_ 0019 Preset-speed #2 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
_r_ 0020 Preset-speed #3 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
_rH 0021 Preset-speed #4 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
_r_ 0022 Preset-speed #5 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
_r( 0023 Preset-speed #6 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
_r 0024 Preset-speed #7 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
5.14
I
I_
Extended parameter
Setting of extended parameters listed on the
following pages
/ / / 4.1.2
(r.( Automatic edit function To search parameters different from default value / / / 4.1.3
* Minimum setup unit is 0.1 in case of 16-bit access.Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (:valid, :invalid)
J
-
3
2. Extended parameters
[1] Frequency signal
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No.
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I(( 0100 Low-speed signal output frequency 0.0 (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / / / 6.1.1
I( 0101 Speed reach setting frequency 0.0 (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / / / 6.1.2
I(_ 0102 Speed reach detection band 0.0 (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 2.5 Enabled / / / 6.1.2
[2] Input signal selection
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No.
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I(_ 0103 ST (standby) signal selection 0: Standard, 1: Always ON, 2: Interlock with F/R terminal 0 Disabled / / / 6.2.1
I(_ 0105 Priority selection (both F-CC, R-CC are ON) 0: Reverse, 1: Stop 0 Disabled / / / 6.2.2
I(( 0106 Priority setting of input terminal 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 0 Disabled / / / 6.2.3
I( 0107
Binary/BCD signal selection
(Expansion TB option unit)
0: None
1: 12-bit binary input
2: 16-bit binary input
3: 3-digit BCD input
4: 4-digit BCD input
5: Reverse 12-bit binary input
6: Reverse 16-bit binary input
7: Reverse 3-digit BCD input
8: Reverse 4-digit BCD input
0 Disabled / /
I(( 0108 Up-down frequency 0 7 1/1 0 Disabled / / /
[3] Terminal function selection (1/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No.
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I( 0110 Always active function selection 0 135 0 Disabled / / / 6.3.1
I 0111 Input terminal selection #1 (F) 0 135 2(F) Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I_ 0112 Input terminal selection #2 (R) 0 135 4(R) Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I_ 0113 Input terminal selection #3 (ST) 0 135 6(ST) Disabled / / / 7.2.1
IH 0114 Input terminal selection #4 (RES) 0 135 8(RES) Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I_ 0115 Input terminal selection #5 (S1) 0 135 10(S1) Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I( 0116 Input terminal selection #6 (S2) 0 135 12(S2) Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I 0117 Input terminal selection #7 (S3) 0 135 14(S3) Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I( 0118 Input terminal selection #8 (S4) 0 135 16(S4) Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I_ 0119 Input terminal selection #9 0 135 0 Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I_( 0120 Input terminal selection #10 0 135 0 Disabled / / / 7.2.1
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
4
[3] Terminal function selection (2/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_ 0121 Input terminal selection #11 0 135 0 Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I__ 0122 Input terminal selection #12 0 135 0 Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I__ 0123 Input terminal selection #13 0 135 0 Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I_H 0124 Input terminal selection #14 0 135 0 Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I__ 0125 Input terminal selection #15 0 135 0 Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I_( 0126 Input terminal selection #16 0 135 0 Disabled / / / 7.2.1
I_( 0130 Output terminal selection #1 (OUT1) 0 119 4(LOW) Disabled / / / 7.2.2
I_ 0131 Output terminal selection #2 (OUT2) 0 119 6(RCH) Disabled / / / 7.2.2
I__ 0132 Output terminal selection #3(FL) 0 119 10(FL) Disabled / / / 7.2.2
I__ 0133 Output terminal selection #4 0 119 0 Disabled / / / 7.2.2
I_H 0134 Output terminal selection #5 0 119 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.2
I__ 0135 Output terminal selection #6 0 119 8 Disabled / / / 7.2.2
I_( 0136 Output terminal selection #7 0 119 14 Disabled / / / 7.2.2
[4] Terminal response time setup
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
IH( 0140 Input terminal #1 response time(F) 2 to 200 [ms] (in steps of 2.5 [ms]) (*1) 8 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
IH 0141 Input terminal #2 response time(R) 2 to 200 [ms] (in steps of 2.5 [ms]) (*1) 8 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
IH_ 0142 Input terminal #3 response time(ST) 2 to 200 [ms] (in steps of 2.5 [ms]) (*1) 8 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
IH_ 0143 Input terminal #4 response time(RES) 2 to 200 [ms] (in steps of 2.5 [ms]) (*1) 8 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
IHH 0144 Input terminal #5-#8 response time 2 to 200 [ms] (in steps of 2.5 [ms]) (*1) 8 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
IH_ 0145 Input terminal #9-#16 response time 2 to 200 [ms] (in steps of 2.5 [ms]) (*1) 8 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I_( 0150 Output terminal #1 delay time (OUT1) (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I_ 0151 Output terminal #2 delay time (OUT2) (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I__ 0152 Output terminal #3 delay time (FL) (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I__ 0153 Output terminal #4 delay time (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I_H 0154 Output terminal #5 delay time (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I__ 0155 Output terminal #6 delay time (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I_( 0156 Output terminal #7 delay time
2 to 200 [ms] (in steps of 2.5 [ms])
(*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I(( 0160 Output terminal #1 holding time (OUT1) (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I( 0161 Output terminal #2 holding time (OUT2) (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I(_ 0162 Output terminal #3 holding time (FL) (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I(_ 0163 Output terminal #4 holding time (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I(H 0164 Output terminal #5 holding time (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I(_ 0165 Output terminal #6 holding time (*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
I(( 0166 Output terminal #7 holding time
2 to 200 [ms] (in steps of 2.5 [ms])
(*1) 2 Disabled / / / 7.2.3
(*1)The minimum setting unit is 2.5 [ms]. Please input a value which is a multiple of 2.5 and ommitted below the decimal point.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
5
[5] Basic parameters #2
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I( 0170 Base frequency #2 25.0 400.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 60.0 Enabled 6.4.1
I 0171 Base frequency voltage #2 0.0 600.0 [V] 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Enabled 6.4.1
I_ 0172 Manual torque boost #2 0.0 30.0 [%] 0.1/0.01 See J-28 Enabled 6.4.1
I_ 0173 Motor overload protection level #2 10 100 [%] 1/0.01 100.0 Enabled 6.4.1
IH 0174 Base frequency #3 25.0 400.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 60.0 Enabled 6.4.1
I_ 0175 Base frequency voltage #3 0.0 600.0 [V] 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Enabled 6.4.1
I( 0176 Manual torque boost #3 0.0 30.0 [%] 0.1/0.01 See J-28 Enabled 6.4.1
I 0177 Motor overload protection level #3 10 100 [%] 1/0.01 100 Enabled 6.4.1
I( 0178 Base frequency #4 25.0 400.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 60.0 Enabled 6.4.1
I_ 0179 Base frequency voltage #4 0.0 600.0 [V] 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Enabled 6.4.1
I(( 0180 Manual torque boost #4 0.0 30.0 [%] 0.1/0.01 See J-28 Enabled 6.4.1
I( 0181 Motor overload protection level #4 10 100 [%] 1/0.01 100 Enabled 6.4.1
I(_ 0182 Motor switching mode selection 0: standard, 1: customized - 0 Disabled / / /
I(_ 0183 V/f adjustment coefficient 0 255 1/1 32 Enabled
[6] V/f 5-point setting
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_( 0190 V/f 5-point setting VF1 frequency 0 400 [Hz] 1/1 0 Disabled 6.5
I_ 0191 V/f 5-point setting VF1 voltage 0 100 [%] 0.1/0.01 0.0 Disabled 6.5
I__ 0192 V/f 5-point setting VF2 frequency 0 400 [Hz] 1/1 0 Disabled 6.5
I__ 0193 V/f 5-point setting VF2 voltage 0 100 [%] 0.1/0.01 0.0 Disabled 6.5
I_H 0194 V/f 5-point setting VF3 frequency 0 400 [Hz] 1/1 0 Disabled 6.5
I__ 0195 V/f 5-point setting VF3 voltage 0 100 [%] 0.1/0.01 0.0 Disabled 6.5
I_( 0196 V/f 5-point setting VF4 frequency 0 400 [Hz] 1/1 0 Disabled 6.5
I_ 0197 V/f 5-point setting VF4 voltage 0 100 [%] 0.1/0.01 0.0 Disabled 6.5
I_( 0198 V/f 5-point setting VF5 frequency 0 400 [Hz] 1/1 0 Disabled 6.5
I__ 0199 V/f 5-point setting VF5 voltage 0 100 [%] 0.1/0.01 0.0 Disabled 6.5
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
6
[7] Speed/torque reference gain/bias setup (1/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_(( 0200 Reference priority selection
0: II(_
1: I_(
2: II(_ priority (*1)
3: I_( priority (*2)
4: II(_/I_( switching
0 Enabled / 6.6.1
I_( 0201 VI/II reference point #1 0 100 [%] 1/0.01 20.0 Enabled / / 7.3.2
I_(_ 0202 VI/II reference point #1 frequency 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0. 0 Enabled / / 7.3.2
I_(_ 0203 VI/II reference point #2 0 100 [%] 1/0.01 100 Enabled / / 7.3.2
I_(H 0204 VI/II reference point #2 frequency 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 80.0 Enabled / 7.3.2
I_(_ 0205 VI/II reference point #1 rate -250 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 0 Enabled / / 6.21.1
I_(( 0206 VI/II reference point #2 rate -250 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 100 Enabled / / 6.21.1
I_( 0207 Speed setting mode selection #2 Same as II(_ (1 to 11) 1 Enabled / 6.61
I_(( 0208 II(_/I_(switching frequency 0.1 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 1.0 Enabled / 6.6.1
I_(_ 0209 Analog input filter 0(Disabled) to 3(Max. filter capacity) 0 Enabled / / 7.2.4
I_( 0210 RR reference point #1 0 100 [%] 1/0.01 0 Enabled / / 7.3.1
I_ 0211 RR reference point #1 frequency 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 7.3.1
I__ 0212 RR reference point #2 0 100 [%] 1/0.01 100 Enabled / / 7.3.1
I__ 0213 RR reference point #2 frequency 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 80.0 Enabled / 7.3.1
I_H 0214 RR reference point #1 rate 0 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 0 Enabled / / 6.21.1
I__ 0215 RR reference point #2 rate 0 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 100 Enabled / / 6.21.1
I_( 0216 RX reference point #1 -100 100 [%] 1/0.01 0 Enabled / / 7.3.3
I_ 0217 RX reference point #1 frequency -IH IH [Hz] (*3) 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 7.3.3
I_( 0218 RX reference point #2 -100 100 [%] 1/0.01 100 Enabled / / 7.3.3
I__ 0219 RX reference point #2 frequency -IH IH [Hz] (*3) 0.01/0.01 80.0 Enabled / 7.3.3
I__( 0220 RX reference point #1 rate 0 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 0 Enabled / / 6.21.1
I__ 0221 RX reference point #2 rate 0 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 100 Enabled / / 6.21.1
I___ 0222 RX2 reference point #1 -100 100 [%] 1/0.01 0 Enabled / /
I___ 0223 RX2 reference point #1 frequency -IH IH [Hz] (*3) 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
I__H 0224 RX2 reference point #2 -100 100 [%] 1/0.01 100 Enabled / /
I___ 0225 RX2 reference point #2 frequency -IH IH [Hz] (*3) 0.01/0.01 80.0 Enabled /
I__( 0226 RX2 reference point #1 rate -250 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 0 Enabled / /
I__ 0227 RX2 reference point #2 rate -250 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 100 Enabled / /
(*1): When setup frequency(signal set up by II(_)is I_(( or more, signal set up by II(_ is accepted, When setup frequency is lower than I_((, the inverter runs under the signal of I_(.
(*2): When setup frequency(signal set up by I_()is I_(( or more, signal set up by I_( is accepted, When setup frequency is lower than I_((, the inverter runs under the signal of II(_.
(*3): Adjustment range is -327.68 327.67 [Hz] in case of 16-bit access.
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
7
[7] Speed/torque reference gain/bias setup (2/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I__( 0228 BIN reference point #1 -100 100 [%] 1/0.01 0 Enabled / /
I___ 0229 BIN reference point #1 frequency -IH IH [Hz] (*1) 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
I__( 0230 BIN reference point #2 -100 100 [%] 1/0.01 100 Enabled / /
I__ 0231 BIN reference point #2 frequency -IH IH [Hz] (*1) 0.01/0.01 80.0 Enabled /
I___ 0232 BIN reference point #1 rate -250 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 0 Enabled / /
I___ 0233 BIN reference point #2 rate -250 250 [%] (For torque control, etc.) 1/0.01 100 Enabled / /
I__H 0234 Pulse reference point #1 -100 100 [%] 1/0.01 0 Enabled /
I___ 0235 Pulse reference point #1 frequency -IH IH [Hz] (*1) 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled /
I__( 0236 Pulse reference point #2 -100 100 [%] 1/0.01 100 Enabled /
I__ 0237 Pulse reference point #2 frequency -IH IH [Hz] (*1) 0.01/0.01 80.0 Enabled /
(*1): Adjustment range is -327.68 327.67 [Hz] in case of 16-bit access.
[8] Operation frequency
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_H( 0240 Start-up frequency 0.0 10.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.1 Enabled / 6.7.1
I_H 0241 Run frequency 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.7.2
I_H_ 0242 Run frequency hysteresis 0.0 30.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.7.2
I_H_ 0243 Stop frequency 0.0 30.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.7.1
I_HH 0244 0 Hz dead band frequency 0.0 5.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.7.3
[9] DC injection braking
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I__( 0250 DC injection braking start frequency 0.0 120.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.8.1
I__ 0251 DC injection braking current 0.0 100.0 [%] 0.1/0.01 50.0 Enabled / 6.8.1
I___ 0252 DC injection braking time 0.0 10.0 [s] 0.1/0.01 1.0 Enabled / 6.8.1
I___ 0253 Forward/reverse DC braking priority control 0: OFF, 1: ON 0 Enabled / 6.8.1
I__H 0254 Motor shaft fixing control 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 0 Enabled / 6.8.2
I___ 0255 Zero-speed stop mode selection 0: Standard(DC injection breaking), 1: 0Hz command 0 Disabled / 6.8.3
[10] Jogging operation
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_(( 0260 Jog run frequency 0.0 20.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.9
I_( 0261 Jog stop control
0: Deceleration stop
1: Coast stop
2: DC injection braking stop
0 Enabled / 6.9
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
8
[11] Jumper frequency
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_( 0270 Jump frequency #1 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.10
I_ 0271 Jump frequency band #1 0.0 30.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.10
I__ 0272 Jump frequency #2 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.10
I__ 0273 Jump frequency band #2 0.0 30.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.10
I_H 0274 Jump frequency #3 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.10
I__ 0275 Jump frequency band #3 0.0 30.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.10
I_( 0276 Object of jump frequency process 0: Process amount, 1: Output frequency 0 Enabled / 6.10
[12] Preset speed operation frequency (8- to 15-stage speed)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_( 0287 Preset-speed #8 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 5.14
I_(( 0288 Preset-speed #9 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 5.14
I_(_ 0289 Preset-speed #10 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 5.14
I__( 0290 Preset-speed #11 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 5.14
I__ 0291 Preset-speed #12 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 5.14
I___ 0292 Preset-speed #13 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 5.14
I___ 0293 Preset-speed #14 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 5.14
I__H 0294 Preset-speed #15 jj (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 5.14
[13] PWM carrier frequency
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_(( 0300 PWM carrier frequency 0.5 15.0(8.0, 5.0) [kHz] (*1) 0.1/0.001 See J-28 Disabled / / / 6.12
(*1)Upper limits differ by applicable motor capacity. For details, refer to 6.12.
Carrier frequency is automatically limited to less than 10kHz when operation frequency is more than 130Hz.
[14] Tripless intensification setup (1/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_( 0301 Auto-restart
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled(at power failure),
2: Enabled(at ST ON/OFF), 3: Enabled(1+2)
0 Enabled / / / 6.13.1
I_(_ 0302
Regenerative power ride-through
control / Deceleration stop
0: OFF, 1: ON, 2:ON(Deceleration stop) 0 Enabled / / / 6.13.2
I_(_ 0303 Retry selection 0: Disabled, 1 to 10 times 0 Enabled / / / 6.13.3
I_(H 0304 Dynamic braking mode selection 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled/overload detection enabled See J-28 Enabled / / / 6.13.4
I_(_ 0305 Over-voltage stall protection
0: Enabled, 1: Disabled,
2: Enabled (Forced quick deceleration)
0 Enabled / / / 6.13.5
I_(( 0306
Base frequency voltage #1
(output voltage adjustment)
0.0 600.0 [V] 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Enabled / / / 6.13.6
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
9
[14] Tripless intensification setup (2/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_( 0307
Base frequency voltage
(Voltage compensation)
0: without voltage compensation (limitless output voltage)
1: with voltage compensation (limitless output voltage)
2: without voltage compensation (limited output voltage)
3: with voltage compensation (limited output voltage)
Disabled
This parameter is changeable,
but significant setting value is
fixed to 1 in vector control.
6.13.6
I_(( 0308 Dynamic braking resistance 1.0 1000 [] 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Disabled / / / 6.13.4
I_(_ 0309 Dynamic braking resistor capacity 0.01 600.0 [kW] 0.01/0.01 See J-28 Disabled / / / 6.13.4
I_( 0310 Ride-through time / Deceleration time 0.0 320.0 [s] 0.1/0.01 2.0 Enabled / / / 6.13.2
I_ 0311 Reverse-run prohibition
0: Permitted, 1: Reverse run prohibited,2: Forward run prohibited,
3: Direction designated by command permitted
0 Disabled / / 6.13.7
I__ 0312 Auto-restart adjustment #1 0.50 2.50 0.01/0.01 See J-28 Enabled / / / 6.13.1
I__ 0313 Auto-restart adjustment #2 0.50 2.50 0.01/0.01 See J-28 Enabled / / / 6.13.1
I_H 0314 Auto-restart mode 0 4 1/1 See J-28 Disabled / / / 6.13.1
I__ 0315 Auto-restart adjustment #3 0 9 1/1 1 Disabled / / / 6.13.1
[15] Drooping control
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I__( 0320 Drooping gain 0 100 [%] (Enabled if Pj = 7, 8 or 9) 1/0.01 0 Enabled / 6.14
I__ 0321 Speed at drooping gain 0% 0.0 320.0 [Hz] (Enabled if Pj = 7, 8 or 9) 0.01/0.01 60.0 Enabled / 6.14
I___ 0322 Speed at drooping gain I__( 0.0 320.0 [Hz] (Enabled if Pj = 7, 8 or 9) 0.01/0.01 60.0 Enabled / 6.14
I___ 0323 Drooping insensitive torque band 0 100 [%] (Enabled if Pj = 7, 8 or 9) 1/0.1 10 Enabled / 6.14
I__H 0324 Output filter for drooping 0.1 200.0 [rad/s] (Enabled if Pj = 7, 8 or 9) 0.1/0.1 100.0 Enabled / 6.14
I___ 0325 Load inertia (Acc/Dec torque) 0 1000 0.1/0.1 1.0 Enabled /
I__( 0326 Load torque filter (Acc/Dec torque) 0.0 199.9, 200.0:without filter 0.1/0.1 200.0 Enabled /
I__ 0327 Drooping reference selection
0: Standard, 1: Acc/dec torque removal
2: Internal torque standard
3: Acc/dec torque removal (internal torque standard)
0 Enabled /
[16] Functions for lift (1/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I__( 0330 Light-load high-speed operation 0 5 0 Disabled /
I__ 0331 Light-load high-speed operation switching lower limit frequency 30.0 (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 40.0 Enabled /
I___ 0332 Light-load high-speed operation load waiting time 0.0 10.0 [s] 0.1/0.1 1.0 Enabled /
I___ 0333 Light-load high-speed operation load detection time 0.0 10.0 [s] 0.1/0.1 1.0 Enabled /
I__H 0334 Light-load high-speed operation heavy load detection time 0.0 10.0 [s] 0.1/0.1 5.0 Enabled /
I___ 0335 Switching load torque current during forward run 0 250 [%] 1 50 Enabled /
I__( 0336 Heavy load torque during acceleration in forward direction 0 250 [%] 1 120 Enabled /
I__ 0337 Heavy load torque during fixed speed in forward direction 0 250 [%] 1 100 Enabled /
I__( 0338 Switching load torque current during reverse run 0 250 [%] 1 50 Enabled /
I___ 0339 Heavy load torque during acceleration in reverse direction 0 250 [%] 1 120 Enabled /
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
J
-
1
0
[16] Functions for lift (2/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_H( 0340 Heavy load torque during fixed speed in reverse direction 0 250 [%] 1 100 Enabled /
I_H 0341 Automatic light-load high-speed operation frequency 30.0 (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 80.0 Enabled /
[17] Commercial/inverter switching function
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I__H 0354
Output signal selection of
commercial power/inverter
switching
0: OFF, 1: Automatic switching in case of trip
2: Commercial power switching frequency setting enabled
3: Both (1+2)
0 Disabled / / 6.16
I___ 0355
Commercial power/inverter
switching frequency
0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 60.0 Enabled / / 6.16
I__( 0356 Inverter side switching waiting time Model dependent 10.00 [s] 0.01/0.01 See J-28 Enabled / / 6.16
I__ 0357
Commercial power side
switching waiting time
0.37 10.00 [s] 0.01/0.01 0.62 Enabled / / 6.16
I__( 0358
Commercial power switching
frequency holding time
0.1 10.0 [s] 0.1/0.01 2.0 Enabled / / 6.16
[18] PID control
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_(( 0360 Signal selection of PID control 0: PID control disabled, 1: VI/II, 2: RR, 3: RX, 4: RX2 0 Enabled / 3.3
I_( 0361 Delay filter 0 255 0 Enabled / 3.3
I_(_ 0362 Proportional (P) gain 0.01 100.0 0.01/0.01 0.1 Enabled / 3.3
I_(_ 0363 Integral (I) gain 0.01 100.0 0.01/0.01 0.1 Enabled / 3.3
I_(H 0364 PID deviation upper limit 0 50 [%] 1/0.01 50 Enabled / 3.3
I_(_ 0365 PID deviation lower limit 0 50 [%] 1/0.01 50 Enabled / 3.3
I_(( 0366 Differential (D) gain 0.00 2.55 0.01/0.01 0 Enabled / 3.3
[19] Speed feedback/positioning control
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_( 0367 Number of PG input pulses 1 9999 1/1 500 Disabled / / /
I_(( 0368 Number of PG input phases 1: Single-phase input, 2: Two-phase input 2 Disabled / / /
I_(_ 0369 PG disconnection detection 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 0 Disabled / / /
I_( 0370 Electronic gear 100 to 4000 pulses/rotation 1/1 1000 Disabled /
I_ 0371 Position loop gain 0.0 100.0 0.1/0.01 4.0 Enabled /
I__ 0372 Positioning completion range 1 4000 1/1 100 Enabled /
I__ 0373 Frequency limit at position control 1 8000 [Hz/s], 8001: disabled 1/1 800 Disabled /
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
1
1
[20] Vector control
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_H 0374 Current control proportional gain 100.0 1000 0.1/0.1 209.1 Disabled / / /
I__ 0375 Current control integral gain 100.0 1250 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Disabled / / /
I_( 0376 Speed loop proportional gain 3.2 1000 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Enabled / /
I_ 0377 Speed loop integral gain 0.1 200. 0 [rad/s] 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Enabled / /
I_( 0378 Motor counter data selection 0 5 0 Disabled / /
I__ 0379 Speed loop parameter ratio 0.01 10.00 [s] 0.01/0.01 1.00 Disabled / /
[21] Preset-speed operation mode
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_(( 0380
Preset-speed operation
mode
0: Non-mode preset speed
1: Preset speed by mode
0 Disabled / 5.14
I_( 0381 Preset-speed #1 control mode
0: Forward run
+1: Reverse run
+2: Selection of acc/dec switching #1
+4: Selection of acc/dec switching #2
+8: Selection of V/f switching #1
+16: Selection of V/f switching #2
+32: Selection of torque limit switching #1
+64: Selection of torque limit switching #2
0 Disabled / 5.14
I_(_ 0382 Preset-speed #2 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I_(_ 0383 Preset-speed #3 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I_(H 0384 Preset-speed #4 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I_(_ 0385 Preset-speed #5 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I_(( 0386 Preset-speed #6 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I_( 0387 Preset-speed #7 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I_(( 0388 Preset-speed #8 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I_(_ 0389 Preset-speed #9 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I__( 0390 Preset-speed #10 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I__ 0391 Preset-speed #11control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I___ 0392 Preset-speed #12 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I___ 0393 Preset-speed #13 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I__H 0394 Preset-speed #14 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I___ 0395 Preset-speed #15 control mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 5.14
I__( 0396 Torque reference filter #2 10.0 199.9, 200.0(No filters) 1/0.1 200.0 Enabled / / 6.21.2
I__ 0397 Speed loop proportional gain #2 3.2 1000 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Enabled / /
I__( 0398 Speed loop integral gain #2 10.0 200. 0 [rad/s] 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Enabled / /
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
1
2
[22] Motor constant
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
IH(( 0400 Auto-tuning
0:Without auto-tuning (internal table)
1:Motor constant initialization (0 after execution)
2:Automatic tuning execution (0 after execution)
0 Disabled / / / 6.20
IH( 0401 Slip frequency gain 0.00 2.55 0.01/0.01 0.60 Enabled / / 6.20
IH(_ 0402 Motor constant #1 (primary resistance) 0.00 100000 [] (*1) 0.01/0.01* See J-28 Disabled / / / 6.20
IH(_ 0403 Motor constant #2 (secondary resistance) 0.00 100000 [] (*1) 0.01/0.01* See J-28 Disabled / / / 6.20
IH(H 0404 Motor constant #3 (exciting inductance) 0.0 6500 [mH] 0.1/0.1 See J-28 Disabled / / / 6.20
IH(_ 0405 Motor constant #4 (load inertia moment) 0.0 100.0 0.1/0.1 1.0 Enabled / / / 6.20
IH( 0410 Motor constant #5 (leak inductance) 0.00 650. 0 [mH] 0.01/0.01 See J-28 Disabled / / / 6.20
IH 0411 Number of motor poles 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 1/1 4 Disabled / / / 6.20
IH_ 0412 Rated capacity of motor 0.10 [Model Dependent] 0.01/0.01 See J-28 Disabled / / / 6.20
IH_ 0413 Motor type
0: Toshiba standard motor #1
1: Toshiba VF motor
2: Toshiba V3 motor
3: Toshiba standard motor #2
4: Other motors
0 Disabled / / / 6.20
IHH 0414 Auto-tuning prohibition
0: Prohibited 1: Valid for sensorless vector
2: Valid for vector with PG
1 Disabled / / / 6.20
[23] Torque control
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
IH_( 0420 Torque reference selection
1: VI/II, 2: RR, 3: RX, 4: RX2(optional), 5: Panel input,
6: Binary/BCD input(optional), 7: Common serial
communication option, 8: Serial communication RS485,
9: Communication add-on cassette option
3 Enabled / 6.21.1
IH_ 0421 Torque reference filter 10.0 199.9, 200.0(without filter) 0.1/0.1 200.0 Enabled / / 6.21.2
IH__ 0422 Selection of synchronized torque bias input 0: Invalid, 1 to 9 (Same as IH_() 0 Enabled / / 6.21.4
IH__ 0423 Selection of tension torque bias input 0: Invalid, 1 to 9 (Same as IH_() 0 Enabled / 6.21.4
IH_H 0424 Load sharing gain input selection 0: Invalid, 1 to 9 (Same as IH_() 0 Enabled / 6.21.4
IH__ 0425 Forward speed limit input selection 0: Invalid, 1: VI/II, 2: RR, 3: RX, 4: RX2(optional), 5: IH_( 0 Enabled / / 6.21.3
IH_( 0426 Forward speed limit input level 0.0 (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 80.0 Enabled / / 6.21.3
IH_ 0427 Reverse speed limit input selection 0: Invalid, 1: VI/II, 2: RR, 3: RX, 4: RX2(optional), 5: IH_( 0 Enabled / / 6.21.3
IH_( 0428 Reverse speed limit input level 0.0 (j [Hz] 0.01/0.01 80.0 Enabled / / 6.21.3
IH__ 0429 Torque reference mode selection 0: Fixed direction, 1:F/R permitted 0 Disabled / 3.3.2
IH_( 0430 Speed limit (torque0) reference 0: Invalid, 1: VI/II, 2: RR, 3: RX, 4: RX2(optional), 5: IH_ 0 Enabled / 6.21.3
IH_ 0431 Speed limit(torque0) level 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.21.3
IH__ 0432 Speed limit(torque0) band 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.21.3
IH__ 0433 Speed limit(torque0) recovery time 0.00 2.50 0.01/0.01 0.20 Disabled / 6.21.3
*To be dealt as an index in case of 16-bit access.Sensorless vector/vector with sensor:valid :invalid
When adjustment value is 10(10000m) or more, 1000(in case of 10000m) and (blink alternately.
When adjustment value is 100(10000m), 1000 and (_ blink alternately.
J
-
1
3
[24] Torque limit
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
IHH( 0440 Selection of power running torque limit #1 1 :VI/II, 2: RR, 3: RX, 4: RX2, 5: IHH 5 Enabled / / / 6.22
IHH 0441 Power running torque limit #1 0 249.9 [%], 250: Invalid 0.1/0.01 250.0 Enabled / / / 6.22
IHH_ 0442 Selection of regenerative torque limit #1 1 :VI/II, 2: RR, 3: RX, 4: RX2, 5: IHH_ 5 Enabled / / / 6.22
IHH_ 0443 Regenerative torque limit #1 0 249.9 [%], 250: Invalid 0.1/0.01 250.0 Enabled / / / 6.22
IHHH 0444 Power running torque limit #2 0 249.9 [%], 250: Invalid 0.1/0.01 250.0 Enabled / / / 6.22
IHH_ 0445 Regenerative torque limit #2 0 249.9 [%], 250: Invalid 0.1/0.01 250.0 Enabled / / / 6.22
IHH( 0446 Power running torque limit #3 0 249.9 [%], 250: Invalid 0.1/0.01 250.0 Enabled / / / 6.22
IHH 0447 Regenerative torque limit #3 0 249.9 [%], 250: Invalid 0.1/0.01 250.0 Enabled / / / 6.22
IHH( 0448 Power running torque limit #4 0 249.9 [%], 250: Invalid 0.1/0.01 250.0 Enabled / / / 6.22
IHH_ 0449 Regenerative torque limit #4 0 249.9 [%], 250: Invalid 0.1/0.01 250.0 Enabled / / / 6.22
IH_( 0450 Torque limit mode (polarity)
0: Power-running/regenerative torque limit
1: Positive/negative torque limit
0 Disabled / / / 6.22
IH_ 0451 Torque limit mode 0: Standard, 1: without speed cooperation 0 Enabled /
IH__ 0452
Continuous stall trip detection
time during power running
0.0 1.0 [s] 0.1/0.01 0.0 Enabled
IH__ 0453 Stall prevention during regeneration
0: Stall
1: Stall is prevented
0 Enabled
[25] Speed/torque reference gain/bias setup #2(1/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
IH_H 0454 Current differential gain 0.00 327.6 0.01/0.01 123.0 Enabled
IH__ 0455
High-speed magnetic field
control gain
1.64 327.6 0.01/0.01 16.38 Enabled
IH_( 0456
High-speed magnetic field
rate-of-change limitation
gain
1.64 327.6 0.01/0.01 163.8 Enabled
IH( 0470 VI/II reference bias 0 255 1/1 99 Enabled
IH 0471 VI/II reference gain 0 255 1/1 142 Enabled
IH_ 0472 RR reference bias 0 255 1/1 100 Enabled
IH_ 0473 RR reference gain 0 255 1/1 164 Enabled
IHH 0474 RX reference bias 0 255 1/1 67 Enabled
IH_ 0475 RX reference gain 0 255 1/1 128 Enabled
IH( 0476 RX2 reference bias 0 255 1/1 67 Enabled
IH 0477 RX2 reference gain 0 255 1/1 128 Enabled
IH(( 0480 Exciting strengthening coefficient 0 255 1/1 64 Enabled
IH( 0481 Over-excitation cooperation 0: Enabled, 1: Applied by IH(( setting 0 Enabled
IH(_ 0482
Modulation rate control
margin (current control)
80.0 300.0 [%] 0.1/0.01 90.0 Enabled
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
1
4
[25] Speed/torque reference gain/bias setup #2(2/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
IH(_ 0483
Modulation rate control
margin (voltage control)
80.0 300.0 [%] 0.1/0.01 105.0 Enabled
IH(H 0484
Modulation rate control
margin (V/f control)
80.0 300.0 [%] 0.1/0.01 105.0 Enabled
IH(_ 0485
Stall cooperation gain at field
weakening zone
0 255 1/1 128 Enabled
IH(( 0486 Exciting starting rate 1.64 327.6 0.01/0.01 163.8 Enabled
IH( 0487 Compensation coefficient for iron loss 0 255 1/1 10 Enabled
IH(( 0488
Voltage compensation
coefficient for dead time
0.00 327.6 0.01/0.01 3.90 Enabled
IH(_ 0489 Dead time compensation 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled 0 Enabled
IH_( 0490 Dead time compensation (bias time) -3.27 3.27 0.01/0.001 0.00 Enabled
IH_ 0491
Current / voltage control
switching frequency
10.0 60.0 [Hz] 0.1/0.01 40.0 Enabled
[26] Secondary acceleration/deceleration
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_(( 0500 Acceleration time #2 0.1(I_(() 6000 [s] 0.01/0.01* See J-28 Enabled / 6.23.2
I_( 0501 Deceleration time #2 0.1(I_(() 6000 [s] 0.01/0.01* See J-28 Enabled / 6.23.2
I_(_ 0502 Acceleration/deceleration pattern #1 0: Linear, 1: S-pattern #1, 2: S-pattern #2 0 Enabled / 6.23.1
I_(_ 0503 Acceleration/deceleration pattern #2 0: Linear, 1: S-pattern #1, 2: S-pattern #2 0 Enabled / 6.23.2
I_(H 0504
Acceleration/deceleration
#1,2,3,4 selection
1: Acceleration/deceleration #1
2: Acceleration/deceleration #2
3: Acceleration/deceleration #3
4: Acceleration/deceleration #4
1 Enabled / 6.23.2
I_(_ 0505 Acc/dec switching frequency #1 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.23.2
I_(( 0506 S-pattern lower-limit adjustment amount 0 50 [%] 1/0.01 25 Enabled /
I_( 0507 S-pattern upper-limit adjustment amount 0 50 [%] 1/0.01 25 Enabled /
6.23.1
I_(( 0508 Acc/dec time lower limit 0.01 10.00 [s] 0.01/0.01* 0.10 Enabled / 6.23.3
I_( 0510 Acceleration time #3 0.1(I_(() 6000 [s] 0.01/0.01* See J-28 Enabled / 6.23.2
I_ 0511 Deceleration time #3 0.1(I_(() 6000 [s] 0.01/0.01* See J-28 Enabled / 6.23.2
I__ 0512 Acceleration/deceleration pattern #3 0: Linear, 1: S-pattern #1, 2: S-pattern #2 0 Enabled / 6.23.2
I__ 0513 Acc/dec switching frequency #2 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.23.2
I_H 0514 Acceleration time #4 0.1(I_(() 6000 [s] 0.01/0.01* See J-28 Enabled / 6.23.2
I__ 0515 Deceleration time #4 0.1(I_(() 6000 [s] 0.01/0.01* See J-28 Enabled / 6.23.2
I_( 0516 Acceleration/deceleration pattern #4 0: Linear, 1: S-pattern #1, 2: S-pattern #2 0 Enabled / 6.23.2
I_ 0517 Acc/dec switching frequency #3 0.0 IH [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / 6.23.2
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
* Minimum setup unit is 0.1 in case of 16-bit access.Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (:valid, :invalid)
J
-
1
5
[27] Pattern run (1/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I__( 0520 Pattern run selection 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 0 Disabled / 6.24
I__ 0521 Pattern run mode
0: Patterned operation canceled during stop
1: Patterned operation continued during stop
0 Disabled / 6.24
I__( 0530 Cycle number of pattern group #1 1 254, 255: 1/1 1 Disabled / 6.24
I__ 0531 Pattern group #1 selection #1 0: Skip, 1 to 15 1 Disabled / 6.24
I___ 0532 Pattern group #1 selection #2 0: Skip, 1 to 15 2 Disabled / 6.24
I___ 0533 Pattern group #1 selection #3 0: Skip, 1 to 15 3 Disabled / 6.24
I__H 0534 Pattern group #1 selection #4 0: Skip, 1 to 15 4 Disabled / 6.24
I___ 0535 Pattern group #1 selection #5 0: Skip, 1 to 15 5 Disabled / 6.24
I__( 0536 Pattern group #1 selection #6 0: Skip, 1 to 15 6 Disabled / 6.24
I__ 0537 Pattern group #1 selection #7 0: Skip, 1 to 15 7 Disabled / 6.24
I__( 0538 Pattern group #1 selection #8 0: Skip, 1 to 15 8 Disabled / 6.24
I_H( 0540 Cycle number of pattern group #2 1 254, 255: 1/1 1 Disabled / 6.24
I_H 0541 Pattern group #2 selection #1 0: Skip, 1 to 15 9 Disabled / 6.24
I_H_ 0542 Pattern group #2 selection #2 0: Skip, 1 to 15 10 Disabled / 6.24
I_H_ 0543 Pattern group #2 selection #3 0: Skip, 1 to 15 11 Disabled / 6.24
I_HH 0544 Pattern group #2 selection #4 0: Skip, 1 to 15 12 Disabled / 6.24
I_H_ 0545 Pattern group #2 selection #5 0: Skip, 1 to 15 13 Disabled / 6.24
I_H( 0546 Pattern group #2 selection #6 0: Skip, 1 to 15 14 Disabled / 6.24
I_H 0547 Pattern group #2 selection #7 0: Skip, 1 to 15 15 Disabled / 6.24
I_H( 0548 Pattern group #2 selection #8 0: Skip, 1 to 15 0 Disabled / 6.24
I__( 0550 Cycle number of pattern group #3 1 254, 255: 1/1 1 Disabled / 6.24
I__ 0551 Pattern group #3 selection #1 0: Skip, 1 to 15 1 Disabled / 6.24
I___ 0552 Pattern group #3 selection #2 0: Skip, 1 to 15 2 Disabled / 6.24
I___ 0553 Pattern group #3 selection #3 0: Skip, 1 to 15 3 Disabled / 6.24
I__H 0554 Pattern group #3 selection #4 0: Skip, 1 to 15 4 Disabled / 6.24
I___ 0555 Pattern group #3 selection #5 0: Skip, 1 to 15 5 Disabled / 6.24
I__( 0556 Pattern group #3 selection #6 0: Skip, 1 to 15 6 Disabled / 6.24
I__ 0557 Pattern group #3 selection #7 0: Skip, 1 to 15 7 Disabled / 6.24
I__( 0558 Pattern group #3 selection #8 0: Skip, 1 to 15 8 Disabled / 6.24
I_(( 0560 Cycle number of pattern group #4 1 254, 255: 1/1 1 Disabled / 6.24
I_( 0561 Pattern group #4 selection #1 0: Skip, 1 to 15 9 Disabled / 6.24
I_(_ 0562 Pattern group #4 selection #2 0: Skip, 1 to 15 10 Disabled / 6.24
I_(_ 0563 Pattern group #4 selection #3 0: Skip, 1 to 15 11 Disabled / 6.24
I_(H 0564 Pattern group #4 selection #4 0: Skip, 1 to 15 12 Disabled / 6.24
I_(_ 0565 Pattern group #4 selection #5 0: Skip, 1 to 15 13 Disabled / 6.24
I_(( 0566 Pattern group #4 selection #6 0: Skip, 1 to 15 14 Disabled / 6.24
I_( 0567 Pattern group #4 selection #7 0: Skip, 1 to 15 15 Disabled / 6.24
I_(( 0568 Pattern group #4 selection #8 0: Skip, 1 to 15 0 Disabled / 6.24
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
1
6
[27] Pattern run (2/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_( 0570
Preset-speed #1 operation
continuation mode
0: Operation time in second after start of operation
1: Operation time in minute after start of operation
2: Operation time in second after attainment of frequency
3: Operation time in minute after attainment of frequency
4: Infinite (continued until stop command is entered)
5: Continue until next step command
0 Disabled / 6.24
I_ 0571 Preset-speed #2 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I__ 0572 Preset-speed #3 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I__ 0573 Preset-speed #4 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_H 0574 Preset-speed #5 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I__ 0575 Preset-speed #6 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_( 0576 Preset-speed #7 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_ 0577 Preset-speed #8 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_( 0578 Preset-speed #9 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I__ 0579 Preset-speed #10 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_(( 0580 Preset-speed #11 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_( 0581 Preset-speed #12 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_(_ 0582 Preset-speed #13 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_(_ 0583 Preset-speed #14 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_(H 0584 Preset-speed #15 operation continuation mode Ditto 0 Disabled / 6.24
I_(_ 0585 Preset-speed #1 operation time
1 8000 [s] / [min]
(The unit depends on I_()
1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I_(( 0586 Preset-speed #2 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I_( 0587 Preset-speed #3 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I_(( 0588 Preset-speed #4 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I_(_ 0589 Preset-speed #5 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I__( 0590 Preset-speed #6 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I__ 0591 Preset-speed #7 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I___ 0592 Preset-speed #8 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I___ 0593 Preset-speed #9 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I__H 0594 Preset-speed #10 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I___ 0595 Preset-speed #11 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I__( 0596 Preset-speed #12 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I__ 0597 Preset-speed #13 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I__( 0598 Preset-speed #14 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
I___ 0599 Preset-speed #15 operation time Ditto 1/1 5 Enabled / 6.24
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
1
7
[28] Protection functions
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I((( 0600 Motor overload protection level #1 10 100 [%] 1/0.01 100 Enabled / / / 5.13
I(( 0601 Stall prevention level 0 199 [%], 200: Disabled 1/0.01 120 Enabled / / / 6.25.2
I((_ 0602 Selection of inverter trip holding
0: Cleared if power is turned off
1: Held even if power is turned off
0 Disabled / / / 6.25.3
I((_ 0603 Emergency stop
0: Coast stop 1: Deceleration stop
2: Emergency DC injection braking stop
3: Coast stop without FL output
4: Deceleration stop without FL output
5: Emergency DC injection braking without FL output
0 Disabled / / / 6.25.4
I((H 0604
Emergency DC injection
braking control time
0.0 10.0 [s] 0.1/0.01 0.1 Enabled / / / 6.25.4
I((_ 0605 Output phase failure detection 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 0 Disabled / / /
I((( 0606 Overload reduction start-up frequency 0.0 30.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 6.0 Enabled / / / 5.13
I(( 0607 Motor 150%-overload time limit 10 2400 [s] 1/1 600 Enabled / / / 5.13
I((( 0608
Relay injection timing for
rush-current suppression
0.3 2.5 [s] 0.1/0.01 0.3 Disabled / / /
I((_ 0609 Mode of rush-current suppression relay 0: Standard, 1: in relation to ST 0 Disabled / / /
I(( 0610 Low current trip 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 0 Disabled / / / 6.25.7
I( 0611 Low current detection level 0 100 [%] 1/0.01 0 Enabled / / / 6.25.7
I(_ 0612 Low current detection time 0 255 [s] 1/1 0 Enabled / / / 6.25.7
I(_ 0613
Detection of output short-
circuit during start-up
0: Standard
1: Only one time at power injection or at first start after reset
0 Disabled / / / 6.25.8
I(H 0614
Adjustment of detection pulse for
output short-circuit during start-up
1 100 [s] 1/1 50 Disabled / / / 6.25.8
I(_ 0615 Over-torque trip 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 0 Enabled / / / 6.25.9
I(( 0616
Over-torque detection level
during power running
0 250 [%] 1/0.01 120 Enabled / / / 6.25.9
I( 0617
Over-torque detection level
during regeneration
0 250 [%] 1/0.01 120 Enabled / / / 6.25.9
I(( 0618 Over-torque detection time 0.0 100.0 [s] 0.1/0.01 0.5 Enabled / / / 6.25.9
I(_( 0620 Cooling fan control mode 0: Automatic, 1: Always ON 0 Enabled / / / 6.2510
I(_ 0621 Cumulative operation time alarm setting 0.1 999.9 [100h] 0.1/0.1 175.0 Enabled / / / 6.25.11
I(__ 0622 Abnormal speed detection filter 0.01 100.0 [s] (*1) 0.01/0.01 10.00 Enabled / / / /
I(__ 0623 Over-speed detection frequency range 0: Disabled, 0.1 30.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / / /
I(_H 0624 Speed drop detection frequency range 0: Disabled, 0.1 30.0 [Hz] 0.01/0.01 0.0 Enabled / / /
I(__ 0625
Over-voltage stall protection
level (high response)
50 250 [%] 1/0.01 135 Enabled / 6.13.5
I(_( 0626 Over-voltage stall protection level 50 250 [%] 1/0.01 130 Enabled / 6.13.5
I(_ 0627 Under-voltage trip mode 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 0 Disabled / / / 6.25.13
I(_( 0628 Under-voltage detection time 0.00 10.00 [s] 0.01/0.01 0.03 Disabled / / / 6.25.14
I(__ 0629 Under-voltage stall level 50 100 [%] 1/0.01 75 Enabled / / / 6.25.15
I(_( 0630 System-supporting sequence(B-timer) 0.0: Invalid, 0.1 10.0 [s] 0.1/0.01 0.0 Enabled / / /
I(_ 0631 Position deviation limit 0.1 6553 0.1/0.1 16 Disabled /
I(__ 0632 Brake release inhibition time after run 0.00: Setting of I(_ is valid, 0.01 2.50 [s] 0.01/0.01 0.00 Disabled / / /
I(__ 0633
The trip selection at the VI/II
low-level input
0 100 1/1 0.00 Enabled / / /
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
(*1): Set a time longer than the acceleration/deceleration time.
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
J
-
1
8
[29] Special analog input
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I(_( 0650
Acceleration/deceleration
base frequency adjustment
0: Invalid1: VI/II2: RR 0 Enabled / 6.26
I(_ 0651 Upper-limit frequency adjustment 0: Invalid1: VI/II2: RR 0 Enabled / 6.26
I(__ 0652 Acceleration time adjustment 0: Invalid1: VI/II2: RR 0 Enabled / 6.26
I(__ 0653 Deceleration time adjustment 0: Invalid1: VI/II2: RR 0 Enabled / 6.26
I(_H 0654 Manual torque boost adjustment 0: Invalid1: VI/II2: RR 0 Enabled 6.26
[30] Over-ride
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I((( 0660
Over-ride addition input
selection
0: Disabled
1: VI (voltage input)/II (current input)
2: RR (volume/voltage input)
3: RX (voltage input)
4: RX2 (voltage input) (optional)
5: Operating panel input
6: Binary/BCD input
7: Common serial communication option(FA01)
8: Serial communication RS485(FA05)
9: Communication add-on cassette option(FA07)
10: Up-down frequency
11: Pulse input #1 (optional)
0 Enabled / 6.27
I(( 0661 Over-ride multiplication input selection 0: Disabled,1: VI/II,2: RR,3: RX,4: RX2,5: I__ 0 Enabled / 6.27
[31] Meter output (1/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I(( 0670 AM terminal meter selection 0 32
2(output
current)
Enabled / / / 5.4
I( 0671 AM terminal meter adjustment Enabled / / / 5.4
I(_ 0672 Optional analog terminal #1 meter selection 0 32 4 Enabled / / /
I(_ 0673 Optional analog terminal #1 meter adjustment Enabled / / /
I(H 0674 Optional analog terminal #2 meter selection 0 32 5 Enabled / / /
I(_ 0675 Optional analog terminal #2 meter adjustment Enabled / / /
I(( 0676 FP terminal meter selection 0 32 0 Enabled / / / 6.28.3
I( 0677 FP terminal meter adjustment 1.00 43.20 0.01/0.001 3.84 Enabled / / / 6.28.3
I(( 0678 Optional analog terminal #1 meter offset -10.0 60.0 0.1/0.1 0.0 Enabled / / /
I(_ 0679 Optional analog terminal #2 meter offset -10.0 60.0 0.1/0.1 0.0 Enabled / / /
I((( 0680 Optional analog terminal sign selection 0 3 0 Enabled / / /
(Reference section): Refer to the inverter's individual manual.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
1
9
[31] Meter output (2/2)
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I(_(
I(_
0690
0697
AM/FM output parameter for adjustment
I(_H
8090
0894
Parameters for options Depend on options 1/1 0 Disabled / / /
I(__ 0899 Reset function 0, 1 0 Disabled / / /
[34] Reservation area
Vector control
Title
Communi
cation No
Function Adjustment range
Min. unit (panel/
communication)
Default
setting
Write during
running
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
Constant
Reference
section
I_(( 0900 Reservation area #1 0 0
I_( 0901 Reservation area #2 0 0
I_(_ 0902 Reservation area #3 0 0
I_(_ 0903 Reservation area #4 0 0
I_(H 0904 Reservation area #5 0 0
: These titles are displayed but unusable. Only the standard default value is displayed.
(reference section): Refer to the designated section of the inverter's individual manual.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor (valid, :invalid)
J
-
2
2
Contents of monitor indications
Communication
number
Function
Communication
unit
Monitor output
selection
Trip holding
Meter output
selection
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
constant
Reference
section
Standard monitor I( (*1)
FE00 Trip frequency monitor 0.01 [Hz] when tripped when tripped / / /
Contents of status monitor indications
FE90 Pattern run group selection at a pattern run hold /
FE91 Number of times to repeat current pattern 1 at a pattern run hold /
FE92 Number of stages for multistage pattern run 1 at a pattern run hold /
FE93 Remaining time of current pattern run 1 at a pattern run hold /
FE01 Status (rotation direction) Fixed hold / / /
Status monitor #1 I (*1)
Status monitor #2 I_ (*1)
Status monitor #3 I_ (*1)
Status monitor #4 IH (*1)
FE06 Input terminal information Fixed hold / / /
FE50 Input terminal information (optional) Fixed hold / / /
FE51 Input terminal information (optional) Fixed hold / / /
FE07 Output terminal information Fixed hold / / /
FE52 Output terminal information (optional) Fixed hold / / /
FE53 Output terminal information (optional) Fixed hold / / /
FE48 Sink/source switching status Fixed not hold / / /
FE47 Type of connected option Fixed not hold / / /
FE54 Standard default value set last 1 Fixed not hold / / /
FE55 Last set automatic control (H(_) 1 Fixed not hold / / /
FE08 CPU version 1 Fixed not hold / / /
FE43 Flush memory version 1 Fixed not hold / / /
FE09 Control EEPROM version 1 Fixed not hold / / /
FE44 Main circuit EEPROM version 1 Fixed not hold / / /
FE10 Past trip #1 Fixed not hold / / /
FE11 Past trip #2 Fixed not hold / / /
FE12 Past trip #3 Fixed not hold / / /
FE13 Past trip #4 Fixed not hold / / /
FE14 Cumulative operation time 1 hour Fixed not hold / / /
8.1
Status in a trip may not be held depending on selected function. Refer to next page.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor: valid, : invalid
J
-
2
3
Monitor FM/AM/pulse output function selection
Communication
number
Function
Communication
unit
Monitor output
selection
Trip holding
Meter output
selection
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
constant
Reference
section
0 FD00 Running frequency 0.01 [Hz] 0 (*3) 0 / / /
1 FE02 Frequency command 0.01 [Hz] 1 hold 1 /
2 FE03 Current 0.01 [%] 2 hold 2 / / /
3 FE04 DC voltage 0.01 [%] 3 hold 3 / / /
4 FE05 Output voltage 0.01 [%] 4 hold 4 / / /
5 FE15 After-compensation frequency 0.01 [Hz] 5 hold 5 / / /
6 FE16 Speed feedback (real-time value) 0.01 [Hz] 6 hold 6 / / /
7 FE17 Speed feedback (1 second filter) 0.01 [Hz] 7 hold 7 / / /
8 FE18 Torque 0.01 [%] 8 hold 8 / / / (*2)
9 FE19 Torque reference 0.01 [%] 9 hold 9 /
10 FE56 Internal torque reference (*1) 0.01 [%] 10 hold 10 / / /
11 FE20 Torque current 0.01 [%] 11 hold 11 / / / (*2)
12 FE21 Exciting current 0.01 [%] 12 hold 12 / / / (*2)
13 FE22 PID feedback value 0.01 [Hz] 13 hold 13 /
14 FE23 Motor overload factor (OL2 data) 0.01 [%] 14 hold 14 / / /
15 FE24 Inverter overload factor (OL1 data) 0.01 [%] 15 hold 15 / / /
16 FE25 PBr overload factor (PBrOL data) 0.01 [%] 16 hold 16 / / /
17 FE28 PBr load factor (pulse duty) 0.01 [%] 17 hold 17 / / /
18 FE29 Input power 0.01 [kW] 18 hold 18 / / /
19 FE30 Output power 0.01 [kW] 19 hold 19 / / /
20 FE31 Peak output current 0.01 [%] 20 hold 20 / / /
21 FE32 Peak DC voltage 0.01 [%] 21 hold 21 / / /
22 FE33 Motor counter dummy PG 1 count 22 hold 22 / / /
23 FE34 Position pulse 1count 23 hold 23 /
24 FE35 PR input 0.01 [%] 24 not hold 24 / / /
25 FE36 VI/II input 0.01 [%] 25 not hold 25 / / /
26 FE37 RX input 0.01 [%] 26 not hold 26 / / /
27 FE38 RX2 input 0.01 [%] 27 not hold 27 / / /
28 FE39 FM output 0.01 [%] 28 not hold 28 / / /
29 FE40 AM output 0.01 [%] 29 not hold 29 / / /
30 FE57 Fixed output for meter adjustment 0.01 [%] hold 30 / / /
31 FE64 Analog output for communication 0.01 [%] not hold 31 / / /
32 FE60 Acc/dec torque removal 0.01 [%] not hold 32 / / /
5.4
(*1): When Pj=7,8,9, / under speed control.
(*2): Reference data
(*3): Trip frequency is displayed in another way.
For details, refer to section 5.4; [Terminal FM-related parameters].
For monitor indications, refer to section 8.2; [Set up values of monitor indication parameters].
Communication number 31(Analog output for communication) outputs analog data of FA51.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor: valid, : invalid
J
-
2
4
Input terminal function setting (1/2)
Positive
logic
Negative
logic
Function
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
constant
(I(_ I((=
Reference
section
0 1 No assignment function / / /
2 3 F: Forward operation command / / /
4 5 R: Reverse operation command / / /
6 7 ST: Standby (Inverse) / / / (*1)
8 9 RES: Reset / / / (*2)
10 11 S1: Preset-speed #1 /
12 13 S2: Preset-speed #2 /
14 15 S3: Preset-speed #3 /
16 17 S4: Preset-speed #4 /
18 19 Jog run /
20 21 Emergency stop / / / (*2)
22 23 DC injection breaking /
24 25 Acc/dec switching #1 /
26 27 Acc/dec switching #2 /
28 29 V/f switching #1 /
30 31 V/f switching #2 /
32 33 Torque limit switching #1 / / / (*3)
34 35 Torque limit switching #2 / / / (*3)
36 37 PID control OFF selection /
38 39 Pattern group #1 /
40 41 Pattern group #2 /
42 43 Pattern group #3 /
44 45 Pattern group #4 /
46 47 Pattern run continuation signal /
48 49 Pattern run trigger signal /
50 51 Forced Jog forward operation /
52 53 Forced Jog reverse operation /
54 55 Reservation area
56 57 Reservation area
58 59 Reservation area
60 61 Reservation area
62 63 Reservation area
64 65 Reservation area
66 67 Reservation area
68 69 Reservation area
7.2.1
(*1): Valid any time
(*2): Independent of (I(_, and all command are valid.
(*3): Dependent on (I(_.
: Reservation area. Do not set at these functions.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor: valid, : invalid
J
-
2
5
Input terminal function setting (2/2)
Positive
logic
Negative
logic
Function
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
constant
(I(_ I((=
Reference
section
70 71 Reservation area
72 73 Reservation area
74 75 Reservation area
76 77 Reservation area
78 79 Reservation area
80 81 Reservation area
82 83 Reservation area
84 85 Reservation area
86 87 Binary data write / /
88 89 Up/down frequency (up) (*1) /
90 91 Up/down frequency (down) (*1) /
92 93 Up/down frequency (clear) /
94 95 PUSH-type run command / / /
96 97 PUSH-type stop command / / /
98 99 Forward/reverse selection / / /
100 101 Run/stop command / / /
102 103 Commercial power/INV switching /
104 105 Frequency reference priority switching /
106 107 VI/II terminal priority /
108 109 Command terminal board priority / / /
110 111 Parameter editing enabling / / /
112 113 Control switching (torque, position) / / / (*2)
114 115 Deviation counter clear /
116 117 Position control forward limit LS /
118 119 Position control reverse limit LS /
120 121 Light load high-speed operation enabling /
122 123 Reservation area
124 125 Preliminary excitation / / /
126 127
System consistent sequence
(BC: Braking command)
/
128 129
System-supporting sequence
(B: Brake release)
/
130 131
System-supporting sequence
(BA: Brake answer)
/
132 133
System-supporting sequence
(BT: Brake test)
/
134 135 Reservation area
7.2.1
(*1): Acceleration/ Deceleration time depend on I_(( or I_(.
(*2): Dependent on (I(_.
: Reservation area. Do not set at these functions.
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor: valid, : invalid
J
-
2
6
Output terminal function setting (1/2)
Positive
logic
Negative
logic
Function
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
constant
Reference
section
0 1 Lower limit frequency(jj) / / /
2 3 Upper limit frequency((j) / / /
4 5 Low speed signal / / /
6 7 Acceleration/deceleration completion /
8 9 Specified speed arrival / / /
10 11 Failure FL (all trip) / / /
12 13 Failure FL (except for (I and ((j) / / /
14 15 Over-current pre-alarm / / /
16 17 Inverter overload pre-alarm / / /
18 19 Motor overload pre-alarm / / /
20 21 Overheat pre-alarm / / /
22 23 Over-voltage pre-alarm / / /
24 25 Main circuit under-voltage (I(II) detected / / /
26 27 Low current detected / / /
28 29 Over-torque detected / / /
30 31 Braking resistor overload ((jr) pre-alarm / / /
32 33 In emergency stop / / /
34 35 In course of retry / / /
36 37 Pattern run switching output /
38 39 PID deviation limit /
40 41 Run/stop / / /
42 43 Serious failure (((H, ((j, (I, phase failure, etc.) / / /
44 45 Light failure ((j, ((, _, _, (P) / / /
46 47 Commercial/INV switching output #1(for inverter operation output) /
48 49 Commercial/INV switching output #2(for commercial operation output) /
50 51 Cooling fan ON/OFF / / /
52 53 In Jog run /
54 55 Panel operation/terminal board operation switching / / /
56 57 Cumulative operation time alarm / / /
58 59 Abnormal communication alarm #1 (caused by scanning) / / /
60 61 Forward/reverse switching / / /
62 63 Ready for operation #1 / / /
7.2.2
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor: valid, : invalid
J
-
2
7
Output terminal function setting (2/2)
Positive
logic
Negative
logic
Function
Speed
control
Torque
control
Position
control
V/f
constant
Reference
section
64 65 Ready for operation #2 / / /
66 67 Poor control power supply (P(II) pre-alarm / / /
68 69 System consistent sequence (BR: Brake release) /
70 71 In (pre-)alarm status / / /
72 73 Forward speed limit (torque control) / /
74 75 Reverse speed limit (torque control) / /
76 77 Inverter healthy output / / /
78 79 Abnormal communication alarm #2 (caused by RS485 logic or message transmission) / / /
80 81 Error code output #1 (6-bit output) / / /
82 83 Error code output #2 (6-bit output) / / /
84 85 Error code output #3 (6-bit output) / / /
86 87 Error code output #4 (6-bit output) / / /
88 89 Error code output #5 (6-bit output) / / /
90 91 Error code output #6 (6-bit output) / / /
92 93 Designated data output #1 (7-bit output) / / /
94 95 Designated data output #2 (7-bit output) / / /
96 97 Designated data output #3 (7-bit output) / / /
98 99 Designated data output #4 (7-bit output) / / /
100 101 Designated data output #5 (7-bit output) / / /
102 103 Designated data output #6 (7-bit output) / / /
104 105 Designated data output #7 (7-bit output) / / /
106 107 Light load signal / / /
108 109 Heavy load signal / / /
110 111 Positive torque limit / / /
112 113 Negative torque limit / / /
114 115 Output for external rush suppression relay / / /
116 117 Over travel / / /
118 119 Completion of positioning / / /
7.2.2
Sensorless vector/vector with sensor: valid, : invalid
J
-
2
8
[Default settings]
Inverter
model
Acc/dec
time
H((/_((
I_((/I_(
I_(/I_
I_H/I__
Torque
boost
_j
I_
I(
I((
Base freq.
voltage
I
I_
I_
I_((
Dynamic
braking
mode
I_(H
Dynamic
braking
resistance
I_((
Dynamic
braking
resister
capacity
I_(_
PWM
carrier
frequ-
ency
I_((
Inverter
side
switching
waiting
time
I__(
Auto-
restart
adjust-
ment
#1
I__
Auto-
restart
adjust-
ment
#2
I__
Auto-
restart
mode
I_H
Current
control
integral
gain
I__
Speed
loop
proportio-
nal gain
I_(
I__
Speed
loop
integral
gain
I_
I__(
Motor
constant #1
(primary
resistance)
IH(_
Motor
constant #2
(secondary
resistance)
IH(_
Motor
constant #3
(exciting
inductance)
IH(H
Motor
constant #5
(leak
inductance)
IH(
Rated
capacity
of motor
(*2)
IH_
Voltage
compen-
sation
coefficient
for dead
time
IH((
VFP7-2185P _(.( _.( _((.( ( ._ (.(( _.( ._ .(( .(( ( _(_.( (_._ __._ _(.__ __._( .( ._H (._( _._(
VFP7-2220P _(.( _.( _((.( ( _._ .( _.( ._ .(( .(( ( _(_.( (_._ __._ HH._( _(.(( _._ .(_ __.(( _._(
VFP7-2300P _(.( _.( _((.( ( _._ ._( _.( ._ .(( .(( ( _(_.( (_._ __._ _H.(H _(._( . (._ _(.(( _._(
VFP7-2370P _(.( _.( _((.( ( _.( _.(( (.( .( .(( .(( _ _(_.( (_._ __._ _H._( _(._( _._ (.(( _.(( (.((
VFP7-2450P _(.( _.( _((.( ( _.( _.(( (.( .( .(( .(( _ _(_.( (_._ __._ (._( __._( .( (._ H_.(( (.((
VFP7-2550P _(.( _.( _((.( ( _.( _.(( _._ .( .(( .(( _ _(_.( (_._ __._ _.__ _.H( (. (._( __.(( (.((
VFP7-2750P ((.( _.( _((.( ( . _.H( _._ _._ ._( ._( _ _(.( _.( __.( (.__ _._( (._ (._( _.(( (.((
VFP7-2900P ((.( _.( _((.( ( . _.H( _._ _._ ._( ._( _ _(.( _.( __.( .H( _._( H.( (.__ _(.(( (.((
VFP7-2110KP ((.( _.( _((.( ( . _.H( _._ _.( ._( ._( _ _(.( _.( __.( _.(( (.(( _. (.__ (.( (.((
VFP7-4185P _(.( _.( H((.( ( _(.( (.(( _.( ._ .(( .(( ( _(_.( (_._ __._ __._ _(._ (.H H._( (._( _._(
VFP7-4220P _(.( _.( H((.( ( _.( .( _.( ._ .(( .(( ( _(_.( (_._ __._ (._ H.( (_. H._( __.(( _._(
VFP7-4300P _(.( _.( H((.( ( _._ ._( _.( ._ .(( .(( ( _(_.( (_._ __._ __._ __. H(.( _.( _(.(( _._(
VFP7-4370P _(.( _.( H((.( ( _._ ._( (.( .( .(( .(( _ _(_.( (_._ __._ _.__ _(. __.( _.(_ _.(( _._(
VFP7-4450P _(.( _.( H((.( ( (.( _.(( (.( .( .(( .(( _ _(_.( (_._ __._ _._( _.(( _._ _.(_ H_.(( (.((
VFP7-4550P _(.( _.( H((.( ( (.( _.(( (.( .( .(( .(( _ _(_.( (_._ __._ __.( H_._( _H.H .__ __.(( (.((
VFP7-4750P ((.( _.( H((.( ( (.( _.(( _._ _._ .( .( _ _(.( _.( __.( H.(_ H(.(( _H. .H_ _.(( (.((
VFP7-4900P ((.( _.( H((.( ( (.( _.(( _._ _._ .(( .(( _ _(.( _.( __.( __.( _._( _.H .( _(.(( (.((
VFP7-4110KP ((.( _.( H((.( ( _. .H( _._ _.( .( .( _ _(.( _.( __.( _(.H __._( H._ .(_ (.( (.((
VFP7-4132KP ((.( _.( H((.( ( _. .H( _._ _.( ._( ._( _ _(.( _.( __.( _.H_ __.(( .( (.(( __.( (.((
VFP7-4160KP ((.( ._ H((.( ( _. .H( _._ _._ .(( .(( _ _(.( _.( __.( _.H_ .(( (._ (.__ ((.( (.((
VFP7-4200KP ((.( ._ H((.( ( ._ (.( _._ _._ (._( (._( _ _(.( _.( __.( _._( (.(( ._ (.H_ _((.( (.((
VFP7-4220KP ((.( ._ H((.( ( ._ (.( _._ _._ (._( (._( _ _(.( _.( __.( _._( (.(( ._ (.H_ __(.( (.((
VFP7-4280KP ((.( .( H((.( ( .HH.(( _._ _._ .H( (._( _ _(.( _.( __.( H.(_ H._( (.( (._H _((.( (.((
VFP7-4315KP ((.( .( H((.( ( .HH.(( _._ _._ .H( (._( _ _(.( _.( __.( _.(_ ._( H.( (._ __.( (.((
(*1): For each inverter model, IH_'s upper limit is rated capacity of one rank larger inverter. (Example: For the model VFP7-2185P, the upper limit is 22.00)
K-1
11. 1 Standard specifications by types
1) Standard specifications by types
Item Description
Voltage class 200 V class
Applicable motor [kW] 18.5 22 30 37 45 55
Model No. VFP7
Type 2185P 2220P 2300P 2370P 2450P 2550P
Output capacity [kVA] (*1) 28 34 46 55 69 84
Output current [A] 73 88 120 144 180 220
Output voltage 3-phase 200 to 230 V (Maximum output voltage corresponds to input supply voltage.)
R
a
t
i
n
g
s
Rated overload current 120% for 1 minutes, 180% for 0.5 second
Dynamic braking circuit
Built-in dynamic braking
drive circuit
Optional
External braking resistor/ braking unit is optionally available.
E
l
e
c
t
r
i
c
b
r
a
k
i
n
g
Dynamic braking
resistor Rating: Refer to 6.13.4.
Main
circuit
3-phase 200-220 V, 50 Hz
3-phase 200-230 V, 60 Hz Voltage,
frequency Control
circuit(*2)
Option
Single phase 200-220 V, 50 Hz
Single phase 200-230 V, 60 Hz
P
o
w
e
r
s
u
p
p
l
y
Allowable fluctuation Voltage: +10% / -15% (*5), Frequency: +/-5%
Protection structure
Enclosed type (JEM1030)
IP20 (*3)
Open type (JEM1030) IP00 (*4)
Cooling system Forced-air cooling
Coating color Munsell 5Y-8/0.5
EMI filter Option to be installed externally
Item Description
Voltage class 400 V class
Applicable motor [kW] 18.5 22 30 37 45 55 75 90
Model No. VFP7
Type 4185P 4220P 4300P 4370P 4450P 4550P 4750P 4900P
Output capacity [kVA] (*1) 28 34 46 55 69 84 110 143
Output current [A] 37 44 60 72 90 110 144 180
Output voltage 3-phase 380 to 400 V (Maximum output voltage corresponds to input supply voltage.)
R
a
t
i
n
g
s
Rated overload current 120 % for 1 minutes, 180 % for 0.5 second (*6)
Dynamic braking circuit
Built-in dynamic
braking drive circuit
Optional
External braking resistor/ braking unit is optionally available.
E
l
e
c
t
r
i
c
b
r
a
k
i
n
g
Dynamic braking
resistor Rating: Refer to 6.13.4.
Main
circuit
3-phase 380-460 V,
50/60 Hz
3-phase 380-440 V, 50 Hz
3-phase 380-460 V, 60 Hz Voltage,
frequency Control
circuit(*2)
Option
Single phase 380-440 V, 50 Hz
Single phase 380-460 V, 60 Hz
P
o
w
e
r
s
u
p
p
l
y
Allowable fluctuation Voltage: +10%/-15% (*5), Frequency: +/-5%
Protection structure
Enclosed type
(JEM1030) IP20 (*3)
Open type (JEM1030) IP00 (*4)
Cooling system Forced-air cooling
Coating color Munsell 5Y-8/0.5
EMI filter Option to be installed externally
(*1): Rated output capacity indicates a value based on the condition that output voltage is 220 V in case of the 200 V class or
440 V in case of the 400 V class.
(*2): The models of 22 kW or lower has no control power supply terminals(R0, S0). Optional control power supply is available
for those types.
(*3): There are three openings for wiring; namely, wiring holes for main circuit input, for main circuit output and for control
circuit. After wiring is complete, close the openings properly.
(*4): The models of 30 kW or higher have neither cover for the wiring hole that has a big aperture nor space for bending
external cables inside the unit. When a protector is installed externally, use an optional cover for the wiring hole.
(*5): Allowable voltage variation is +/-10 % in continuously operation (100 % load).
(*6): 120 % for 1 minutes, 150 % for 0.3 second
11. Specifications by types
K-2
2) Standard specifications by types
Item Description
Voltage class 200 V class
Applicable motor [kW] 75 90 110
Model No. VFP7
Type 2750P 2900P 2110KP
Output capacity [kVA] (*1) 110 133 160
Output current [A] 288 350 420
Output voltage 3-phase 200 to 230 V (Maximum output voltage corresponds to input supply voltage.)
R
a
t
i
n
g
s
Rated overload current 120% for 1 minute, 150% for 0.3 second (*5)
Dynamic braking
circuit
Built-in type dynamic braking drive circuit is optionally available
E
l
e
c
t
r
i
c
b
r
a
k
i
n
g
Dynamic braking
resistor
External braking resistor is available optionally
Main circuit 3-phase 200-230 V, 50/60 Hz
Voltage,
frequency
Control
circuit
Single phase 200-230 V, 50/60 Hz
P
o
w
e
r
s
u
p
p
l
y
Allowable fluctuation Voltage: +10%/-15% (*3), Frequency: +/-5%
Protection structure Open type (JEM1030) IP00 (*2)
Cooling system Forced-air cooling
Coating color Munsell 5Y-8/0.5
EMI filter Option to be installed externally
Item Description
Voltage class 400 V class
Applicable motor [kW] 110 132 160 200 220 280 315
Type VFP7
Form 4110KP 4132KP 4160KP 4200KP 4220KP 4280KP 4315KP
Output capacity [kVA] (*1) 160 194 236 300 320 412 470
Output current [A] 210 255 310 377 420 540 590
Output voltage 3-phase 380-460 V (Maximum output voltage corresponds to input supply voltage.)
R
a
t
i
n
g
s
Rated overload current 120% for 1 minute, 150% for 0.3 second (*5)
Dynamic braking
circuit
Built-in type dynamic braking drive circuit is optionally available
E
l
e
c
t
r
i
c
b
r
a
k
i
n
g
Dynamic braking
resistor
External braking resistor is available optionally
Main circuit 3-phase 380-460 V, 50/60 Hz
Voltage,
frequency
Control
circuit
Single phase 380-460 V, 50/60 Hz
P
o
w
e
r
s
u
p
p
l
y
Allowable fluctuation Voltage: +10%/-15% (*3), Frequency: +/-5%
Protection structure Open type (JEM1030) IP00 (*2)
Cooling method Forced-air cooling
Coating color Munsell 5Y-8/0.5
EMI filter Option to be installed externally
(*1): Rated output capacity indicates a value based on the condition that output voltage is 220 V in case of the 200 V class or
440 V in case of the 400 V class.
(*2): The models of 30 kW or higher have neither cover for the wiring hole that has a big aperture nor space for bending
external cables inside the unit. When a protector is installed externally, use an optional cover for the wiring hole.
(*3): Allowable voltage variation is +/-10 % in continuously operation (100 % load)
(*4): Be sure to attach DC reactor for the models: 200V class 75kW or more and 400V class 110kW or more.
(Not necessary for DC input.)
(*5): This regulation is overload value from the stop state at ambient temperature state within regulation value.
3) Comparison in specifications (different points only)
Item
VFP7-2185P 2550P
VFP7-4185P 4750P
VFP7-2750P 2110KP
VFP7-4900P 4315KP
1. Rated overload
current
120 % for 1 minutes
180 % for 0.5 second
120 % for 1 minutes
150 % for 0.3 second
2. PWM carrier
frequency
Default setting: 12 kHz
If the inverter trips because of overheat ((H), reset it after a considerably long time enough for
cooling it down completely, because overheat is detected based on its internal temperature.
Point!
For quickly recovering inverter from trip status, turn it off once and reset it. However, this
measure is taken frequently, it may cause damage to the motor and other component units.
(1) Cut off power supply (until nothing appears on the LED display).
Note: Refer to the section 6.25.3, Inverter trip holding parameter I((_.
(2) Use external signal (make short-circuit between RES and CC of the control
terminal board).
(3) Operate on the panel.
(4) Clear the trip by communication (refer to "manual for communication" for details).
L-6
12. 3 In the case motor does not run in spite of no trip message appearing ...
When the motor does not run in spite of no trip message appearing on the display, proceed to
troubleshooting according to the following flowchart.
YES :
NO :
Motor does not run.
Is 7-segment LED display
turned on?
Check input power and
MCCB.
Is input power
correct?
Input power
supply correctly.
Make a service call.
Is I(II blinking?
Main circuit power is undervoltage. If input voltage or DC reactor
(DCL) voltage is low, check the connection.
For monitoring input voltage, refer to the section 8.1.
Is P(II blinking? Control power is undervoltage. Check input voltage and connection
of control power supply. (This is an option for the 22 kW or lower
type.)
Is (II blinking?
Circuit between ST and CC is open. Close the circuit between the
terminal assigned as ST (standby) and CC of the control terminal
board, (Refer to 7.2.1)
Change setting value of ST (standby) signal selection parameter
I(_. (Refer to 6.2.1)
Is trip indication appearing?
(Refer to 12.1.)
Investigate the cause of failure and remove the cause before
resetting the inverter. For resetting, refer to the section 12.2.
rjr_ and trip indication
are appearing alternately?
The inverter is in retry operation. Retry operation discontinues if stop
or emergency stop operation is done or power supply is cut off.
Is(.( appearing on
display?
Is LED on
RUN/STOP key
turned on?
Check to see if frequency setting signal is set at "0".
Check setup contents of frequency setting signal parameters
II(_, I_((, I_( and I_((. (Refer to 5.3.)
Check setting of points 1 and 2 of frequency setting signal.
(Refer to 7.3.)
Check to see if operation start frequency is set higher than operation
frequency. (Refer to 6.7.)
Check to see if frequency (preset-speed operation frequency, etc.) is
set at "0".
Check to see if the motor is loaded too heavily or locked. - Reduce
load to the motor.
Check contents of parameters and indications appearing on the monitor.
For table of parameters and monitor indications, refer to the articles 10 and 8 respectively.
In case of control panel operation: Turn on the RUN key to continue operation.
Check to see if control panel operation frequency is set or not. (Refer to 3.2.2)
In other operation mode: Change setting of control device selection parameter
(I(_.(Refer to 3.2.1)
In case of control panel operation: Change setting of control device
selection parameter (I(_ to "1". (Refer to 5.3.)
Setup status of input terminals can be checked by the monitor. (Refer to
8.1.)
In other operation mode: Check to see if external operation command is
input.
Check setup contents of I(H parameter (selection of operation to
which priority is given when forward and reverse run commands are input
simultaneously). (Refer to 6.2.2.)
L-7
12. 4 How to check other troubles
Expected causes of other troubles (abnormal operations and conditions) and measures to settle
those troubles are shown below.
Abnormal
operation/condition
Causes and measures
Motor runs reversely.
Change phase sequence of output terminals U, V and W.
Change forward and reverse signal inputs of external operation signals for
each other. (Refer to 7.2, Control terminal function allotment.)
Motor runs but speed
cannot be varied.
Load to motor is too heavy.
Reduce the load.
Soft stall function is activated.
Switch off soft stall function. (Refer to 5.13.)
Setting values of maximum frequency IH and upper limit frequency (j
are low.
Raise maximum frequency IH and upper limit frequency (j to higher
level.
Frequency setting signal is low (weak).
Check input level of signal, circuit and connection, etc.
Check setup specifications of frequency setting signal (setting of point 1,
point 2). (Refer to 7.3.)
Check to see if stall prevention function is activated at low-speed operation
because of too high torque boost rate.
Adjust manual torque boost (_j) and acceleration time #1 (H((). (Refer
to 5.12 and 5.1.)
Acceleration/deceleration
of motor is rough.
Acceleration time #1 (H(() and deceleration time #1 (_(() are set short.
Increase setting values of acceleration time #1 (H(() and deceleration
time #1 (_(().
Large motor current
Load to motor is too heavy.
Reduce load to motor.
Check to see if torque boost rate is too high at low-speed operation. (Refer
to 5.12.)
Motor speed is high or
low.
Improper voltage setting for the motor.
Set voltage properly to the motor.
Terminal voltage of the motor is low.
Check setting value of base frequency voltage #1 (I_((). (Refer to
6.13.6.) Change the cable for thicker one.
Improper gear ratio for acceleration and deceleration.
Change gear ratio properly for smooth acceleration and deceleration.
Output frequency is set improperly.
Check setup of output frequency range.
Tune basic frequency. (Refer to 5.9.)
Motor speed varies in
operation.
Load to the motor is too heavy or light.
Reduce load fluctuation.
Rating of inverter or motor is improper to load.
Change the motor or inverter for another of higher rating.
Check to see if frequency setting signal input fluctuates.
If V/f control parameter is set at 3 or larger, check setting value and setup
conditions of vector control. (Refer to 5.10.)
Some or all of six keys
on operation panel don't
work.
Access to parameter
results in failure.
Parameter cannot be
changed.
Monitor (display) is
uncontrollable.
Change panel operation prohibition parameter I_(. (Refer to 6.30.14.)
*Parameter is occasionally set for key operation prohibition mode. Cancel
key operation prohibition mode according to the following procedure.
Press the [] key twice while pressing the [ENT] key.
1: If parameter setting prohibition parameter I(( is set at ""(prohibited),
change the setting to "(" (allowed).
2: If there is an input terminal that is set for "(" (or "") (parameter
editing enabling) by input terminal function parameter, turn on the terminal.
Measures against trouble with parameter setting
How to check the
parameters that have
been changed.
Changed parameters can be searched and reset.
For details, refer to 4.1.3.
How to reset changed
parameters to default
values
Parameters whose values have been changed can be reset to their
respective default values in bulk.
For details, refer to 4.1.5.
M-1
Danger
Mandatory
Be sure to inspect the inverter regularly.
If the inverter is used without regular inspection, it may cause trouble or accident because
sign of disorder or failure is missed.
Complete the following steps before proceeding to inspection.
1 Cut off power supply (turn off the inverter).
2 10 minutes or more after power cutoff, check to see if the charge indicator lamp is turned
off.
3 Make sure that voltage in the DC main circuit (between PA and PC) is 45 V or lower by
use of a tester capable of measuring high DC tension (800 V DC or more).
If the above-mentioned steps are skipped before inspection, it may cause an electricshock.
To prevent the inverter from failure caused by operating environment such as influence of
temperature, humidity, dust and so on, vibration, and aging of component parts, and end of
estimated service life, execute daily or regular inspection without fail.
13.1 Regular inspection
Since electronic parts are easily affected by heat, install the inverter in a cool, well-ventilated,
dust-free place for making it demonstrate its original performance for a long time.
Purpose of regular inspection is to find sign of failure or malfunction by comparing current data
on operation with recorded data on past operation.
Gist of inspection Subject of
inspection Inspection item Inspection cycle Inspection method
Criteria of judgment
1. Indoor
environment
1) Dust,
humidity, gas
2) Dropping of
water and
other liquid
3) Room
temperature
1) Eye-check,
thermometer,
sense of smell
2) Eye-check
3) Thermometer
1) Improve bad points.
2) Pay heed to trace left of
water drop.
3) Maximum 40C (50C inside
cabinet)
2. Component
parts and
units
1) Vibration,
noise
By feel (touch) of
outside of the
board
If something feels abnormal, open the
door and check transformer, reactor,
contactor, relay, cooling fan, etc.
Stop the inverter as occasion
demands.
3. Operation
data (output
side)
1) Load current
2) Voltage*
3) Temperature
As occasion
demands
Moving-iron type
AC ammeter
Rectifier type AC
voltmeter
Thermometer
Within the rating
Little difference from data on
normal status
Voltage is differently read depending on the measuring instrument used. Use the same tester
or voltmeter for every inspection and record measurement result each time.
Check points
1. Something unusual in the installation environment
2. Something unusual in the cooling system
3. Unusual vibration and noise
4. Overheat, discoloration
5. Unusual smell
6. Unusual motor vibration, noise and overheat
13. Regular inspection and maintenance
M-2
13. 2 Periodical inspection
Make periodical inspection at intervals of three or six months depending on operating conditions.
Danger
Mandatory
Complete the following steps before proceeding to periodical inspection.
1 Cut off power supply (turn off the inverter).
2 10 minutes or more after power cut off, check to see if the charge indicator lamp is turned
off.
3 Make sure that voltage in the DC main circuit (between PA and PC) is 45 V or lower by
use of a tester capable of measuring high DC tension (800 V DC or more).
If the above-mentioned steps are skipped before inspection, it may cause an electric shock.
Prohibited
Don't replace any component part.
Replacement of a component part by user may cause electric shock, fire or injury. Ask the
dealer for replacement of part.
Points of inspection
1. Check to see if there is some wire terminal screw getting loose. If any, tighten it with a
screwdriver.
2. Make sure by eye-check that there is neither poorly clinched part nor overheated clinch in
wire terminals.
3. Check to see by eyes if there is any damage on wire or cable.
4. Clean up dust and soil. Absorb dust by a vacuum cleaner. Carefully clean the vents, printed
circuit boards and so on. If those parts get dusty, it may cause an unexpected accident.
Keep them clean always.
5. If the inverter won't be used for a long time, turn it on once every another year to check
operation. Furthermore, disconnect the motor and supply power to the inverter for five hours
or more. For turning on the inverter very seldom, it is recommended not to supply
commercial mains power directly to the inverter but to use a step-up transformer to supply
power at a low voltage first and to raise the voltage gradually.
6. If insulation test is needed, conduct it for the main circuit terminal board and control power
terminal board using a 500 V insulation resistance tester only. Don't conduct insulation test
for control terminals and circuit terminals on printed circuit boards except of the main circuit.
For insulation test of motor, disconnect output terminals of U, V and W and conduct test for
the motor only.
Note: Disconnect all cables from terminals of the main circuit terminal board, and conduct
insulation test with the inverter only.
7. Make no pressure test, because it may cause damage to internal parts.
8. Voltage and temperature check
Recommended voltmeter:
For input side: Moving-iron type voltmeter
For output side: Rectifier type voltmeter
If ambient temperature is measured at start time, during operation, and at stop time usually,
recorded data will be helpful to find sign of failure or malfunction.
500 V insulation
resistance
tester
//////
M-3
Replacement of expendable parts
The inverter incorporates a great deal of electronic parts such as semiconductors, etc. The
following parts deteriorate because of their constructions, physical characteristics and aging.
If those parts are used as they have aged, it may cause the inverter to deteriorate in
performance and to become faulty. Such being the case, the inverter needs periodical
inspection for preventing itself from failure and deterioration.
Note: Service life of part is affected by ambient temperature and operating conditions. Service life of
main parts shown below is just standard when the inverter is used in the usual environmental
conditions.
1) Cooling fan
Service life of the cooling fan to cool down heat generation parts is 30000 hours (2 to 3
years under continuous operation) approximately. If it generates unusual noise or
vibration, it is a sign of replacement.
2) Aluminum electrolytic capacitor
The aluminum electrolytic capacitor of the DC main circuit deteriorates in characteristic
because of influence of ripple current, etc. If the inverter is used in the usual operating
condition, the capacitor needs to replace every five years. For the inverter that applicable
motor output is 3.7 kW or less, replace the capacitor together with the printed circuit
board.
<Criteria of external inspection>
No liquid leak
Proper setting of safety valve
Measurement of electrostatic capacity and insulation resistance
Aim of replacement time of each component part can be fixed by checking operation hours
of the inverter. For the replacement of parts, contact Toshiba branch office printed on the
back cover of this manual. (Operation hours can be known by alarm output, if it is set.)
Standard period of years to replace main component parts
If the inverter is used under the standard operating conditions (ambient temperature: 30 on
average, load factor: 80 % or less, 12-hours operation a day), standard period of years to
replace main component parts is as shown below. The following period does not indicate the
estimated end of service life of the part but indicates the period that failure rate of the part
becomes sharply high thenceforth.
Part name
Standard period
for replacement
Replacement method, others
Cooling fan 2 to 3 years Replace with new one.
Main circuit capacitor 5 years
Replace with new one (depending on
inspection result).
Contactor, Relay, etc. Depending on inspection result
Timer Depending on operation hours
Fuse 10 years Replace with new one.
Aluminum electrolytic capacitor
on printed circuit board
5 years
Change together with printed circuit
board for new board (depending on
inspection result).
Note: Service life of part differs depending on operating environment.
M-4
13. 3 When making a service call
For the Toshiba service network, refer to the back cover of this instruction manual. If defective
conditions are encountered, please contact the Toshiba service section in charge via your
Toshiba dealer.
When making a call for servicing, let us know the contents of the rating plate on the right side of
the inverter and connection of options besides details of the trouble.
13. 4 When retaining the inverter out of operation
When retaining the inverter out of operation temporarily or for a long time, pay heed to the
following points.
1. Keep the inverter in a well-ventilated place that is free from high temperature, high humidity,
dust and metallic particles.
2. For the inverter whose printed circuit boards are covered with the charge-proof cover (black),
don't remove the cover throughout retention. However, be sure to remove the cover before
the inverter is turned on.
3. If the large-capacity electrolytic condenser mounted in the inverter is left without power supply
for a long time, it deteriorates in the characteristic.
If the inverter won't be used for a long time, turn it on for 5 hours or more once every another
years in order to recover the characteristic of the electrolytic condenser. At the same time,
check operation status of the inverter. For turning on the inverter very seldom, it is
recommended to use a step-up transformer to supply power at a low voltage first and to raise
the voltage gradually.
N-1
The inverter is warranted by Toshiba for repair and adjustment free of charge based on the
following conditions.
1. Warranty is limited to the inverter's main body only.
2. If the inverter becomes out of order or damaged under the usual operating condition within 12
months after delivery, it will be repaired free of charge by Toshiba.
3. Even in the term of the warranty, repair/adjustment service will be charged for the following
cases.
Fault or damage resulting from misuse, unauthorized modification or repair.
Fault or damage resulting from falling down of the product or traffic accident during
transportation.
Fault or damage originating from fire, salt water/salty breezes, some kind of gas, arthquake,
storm and flood, lightning, abnormal supply voltage, other natural disasters.
Fault or damage caused by improper use of the inverter as it is used for a purpose out of its
original application.
4. If field inspection of the inverter is carried out at the spot of installation, all travelling expenses
incurred will be charged. If there is another special warranty contracted for the inverter, the
special warranty has priority over this warranty.
14. Warranty
O-1
Warning
Mandatory
When disposing an inverter, do it as an industrial waste following regulations
and local rules concerned.
If it is disposed otherwise, it may cause injury to persons.
When disposing a used inverter, pay heed to the following points.
Blasting during incineration: There is a danger that electrolytic condensers used in the
inverter may burst if it is burnt in an incinerator, because
electrolyte inside the condenser expands with heat. Be careful
of blasting of electrolytic condensers.
Plastics: Plastics used as covers of the inverter and so on generate
poisonous gas when the inverter is burnt. When burning the
inverter, be careful of such poisonous gas.
Disposing manner: Be sure to dispose the inverter properly as an industrial waste.
15. When disposing the inverter